Home
        Model 42i-TL - User Manual
         Contents
1.             Figure 3   5  Pin Out of Rear Panel Connector in Dual Range Mode    Table 3 3  Default Analog Outputs in Dual Range Mode                      Channel Connector Pin 1 0 Terminal Pin Description   1 14 1 NO High Range  2 33 3 NO Low Range   3 15 5 NO  High Range  4 34 7 NO Low Range  5 17 9 NO  High Range  6 36 11 NO  Low Range  Ground 16  18  19  35  37 2 4  6  8  10  12 Signal Ground       Note All channels are user definable  If any customization has been made  to the analog output configuration  the default selections my not apply  A    3 10 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Range Menu    Auto Range Mode The auto range mode switches the NO  NO    and NO  analog outputs  between high and low ranges  depending on the NO  concentration level   The high and low ranges are defined in the Range menu     For example  suppose the low range is set to 50 ppb and the high range is  set to 100 ppb  Figure 3   6   Sample concentrations below 50 ppb are  presented to the low ranges analog outputs and sample concentrations  above 50 ppb are presented to the high ranges analog outputs  When the  low range is active  the status output is at 0 volts  When the high range is  active  the status output is at half of full scale     When the high ranges are active  the NO concentration must drop to 85   of the low NO range for the low ranges to become active     In addition to each channel having two ranges  each channel has two span  c
2.          Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 61    Operation  Diagnostics Menu    Set Analog Outputs The Set Analog Outputs screen contains three choices  Set to full scale  set  to zero  or reset to normal  Full scale sets the analog outputs to the full   scale voltage  zero sets the analog outputs to 0 volts  and normal operation   The example below shows the selected output state    ALL    is set to normal     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Diagnostics  gt  Test Analog Outputs  gt  ALL   Voltage Channel 1 6  or Current Channel 1 6        Instrument The Instrument Configuration screen displays information on the  Configuration hardware configuration of the instrument     Note If the analyzer is in service mode  pressing on the item will  toggle it yes or no  with the exception of purchased options such as  dilution and auto calibration   A    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Diagnostics  gt  Instrument Configuration     EH Guided  PLP       Contact Information The Contact Information screen displays the customer service information     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Diagnostics  gt  Contact Information     3 62 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Alarms Menu       Alarms Menu The alarms menu displays a list of items that are monitored by the analyzer   If the item being monitored goes outside the lower or upper limit  the  status of that item will go from    OK    to either    LOW    or    HIGH      respectively  If the alarm is not a level
3.       AC 24VPWR J1           wo N       AC INTF BD PJ3         Table 6   4  Measurement Interface Board Connector Pin Descriptions    Connector Reference Pin Signal Description  Label Designator    DATA IPJ8 1 Ground   RS485 from Motherboard   RS485 from Motherboard    w N            PRES MJ3 Pressure Sensor Input  Ground    15V    15V     15V    FP WO N    INPUT BD MJ8         Ground   15V   5V  Ground    Measurement Frequency Output    YN ooN Aa O N    Amplifier Zero Adjust Voltage    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 6 13    Troubleshooting  Connector Pin Descriptions    6 14 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Connector  Label    Reference  Designator    Pin    Signal Description    SPI Output  SPI Clock  SPI Board Select       AMB TEMP    MJ9    Ambient Temperature Thermistor    Ground       HVPS    MJ10           YN oOo nm FP WO N    HV Power Supply Voltage Adjust  Ground   HV Power Supply On Off   Ground   HV Power Supply Voltage Monitor  Ground    Ground       FLOW SW    MJ14           w N    NC  Ground    Ozonator Flow OK Switch       FLOW    MJ15            on A WO N    Flow Sensor Input  Ground    15V    15V    Ground       TEMP CTRL    OZONATOR    MJ17    0J1          o oO A WO N    Bench Temperature Input  Ground    15V   Converter Heater On Off  Converter Temperature Input   15V_PWR   Ozonator Output A   Ozonator Output B       24V IN     24V    Ground       PROV INPUT       Spare Voltage Input  Ground  Ground    Ground   
4.      Send  set format 01  Receive  set format 01 ok    Table B 8  Reply Termination Formats       Format Reply Termination  00  lt CR gt   01  lt NL gt  sum xxxx  lt CR gt     where xxxx   4 hexadecimal digits that represent the sum of all the  characters  bytes  in the message    host name  This command reports the host name string     Send  host name  Receive  host name analyzero1    set host name string  This command sets the host name string  where string is 1 13 alphanumeric    characters    Send  set host name analyzero1  Receive  set host name analyzero1 ok  instr name    This command reports the instrument name     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Communications Configuration    Send  instr name   Receive  instr name  NO NO2 NOx Analyzer  NO NO2 NOx Analyzer    instrument id  This command reports the instrument id     Send  instrument id  Receive  instrument id 42    set instrument id value  This command sets the instrument id to value  where value is a decimal  number between 0 and 127 inclusive     Note sending this command via RS 232 or RS 485 will require the host to  use the new id for subsequent commands  5    Send  set instrument id 50  Receive  set instrument id 50 ok  mode    This command reports what operating mode the instrument is in  local   service  or remote  The example below shows that the instrument is in the  remote mode     Send  mode  Receive  mode remote    set mode local   set mode remote   These 
5.      The instrument includes one power fail relay on motherboard and ten  digital output relays on the digital output board  These are reed relays rated  for at least 500 mA   200VDC     The power fail relay is Form C  both normally opened and normally closed  contacts   All other relays are Form A  normally opened contacts  and are  used to provide alarm status and mode information from the analyzer  as  well as remote control to other devices  such as for controlling valves during  calibration  The user may select what information is sent out each relay and  whether the active state is opened or closed     Sixteen digital inputs are available which may be programmed to signal  instrument modes and special conditions including     e NO Measure Mode  e NO  Measure Mode  e Zero Gas Mode  e Span Gas Mode    The actual use of these inputs will vary based on analyzer configuration     Thermo Fisher Scientific    System Description  1 0 Components    The digital inputs are TTL level compatible and are pulled up within the    analyzer  The active state can be user defined in firmware     Serial Ports Two serial ports allow daisy chaining so that multiple analyzers may be  linked using one PC serial port     The standard bi directional serial interface can be configured for either RS   232 or RS 485  The serial baud rate is user selectable in firmware for  standard speeds from 1200 to 19 200 baud  The user can also set the data  bits  parity  and stop bits  The following protocols a
6.      Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual D 7    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Appendix E  Standards for Trace Level Analyzers    The development of ultra sensitive analytical analyzers for the measurement  of trace quantities of pollutants such as NO  NO   or SO  has raised a  number of questions concerning proper calibration procedures and  equipment  Analyzers that in theory have detection limits below 1 ppb   may not in practice be useful due to inadequate and or inaccurate  calibration practices     Thermo Fisher Scientific has in its development of Trace Level  instrumentation used the same basic principles for calibration as for  standard analyzers  However  enhanced emphasis on the zero air supply  used for dilution of standard gases and for establishing a zero background  signal is made     Chemiluminescence NO No  and fluorescence SO  analyzers  when  properly designed  have bee shown in numerous research studies and  compliance monitoring situations to be inherently linear over a wide  dynamic range  Calibration is normally done using firs a zero gas then a  span gas generated by dilution of a calibration gas cylinder  Dilution is  done by dynamic mixing of accurately known flows of span gas and zero  gas  For Trace Level analyzers  mass flow controllers that are NIST  traceable are required  Nitric oxide and sulfur dioxide calibration standards  between 1 and 10 ppm are readily available in specially treated cylinders   and have been sho
7.      to scroll to Flow Calibration  gt  and press  e      The Flow Sensor Cal menu appears     Note If Service Mode is not displayed  refer to    Accessing the Service  Mode    on page 7 4   then return to the beginning of this step  A    4  At the Flow Sensor Cal menu  press to select Zero     The Calibrate Flow Zero screen appears     5  Wait at least 10 seconds for the zero reading to stabilize  then press    to save the zero flow value     6  Reconnect the pump cable to the AC PUMP connector on the  measurement interface board     7  Connect a calibrated flow sensor at the SAMPLE bulkhead on the rear    panel     8  Press        to return to the Flow Sensor Cal menu     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 47    Servicing  Front Panel Board Replacement    9  At the Flow Sensor Cal menu  press          to select Span   The Calibrate Flow Span screen appears     10  Wait at least 10 seconds for the reading to stabilize  use __      and        to enter the flow sensor reading  and press to    save the value     11  Install the cover     Front Panel Board Use the following procedure to replace the front panel board  Figure 7       Replacement       Equipment Required     Front panel board    f Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small    amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    1  Turn instrument OFF  unplug the power cord  and remove the cover     2  Remov
8.     Align the diaphragm head correctly as noted in Step 2  and secure with  the four socket head screws     Place the new Teflon gasket over the pump head so that the eight  screws holes are aligned     Replace the top plate and secure with the eight screws and washers  being sure that the Teflon gasket stays in place     Reconnect the plumbing to the instrument and plug in the pump  power cord     Check that the reaction chamber pressure reads between 200 and 450  mmHg     Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual 5 7    Safety Precautions    Troubleshooting    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Guides    Chapter 6  Troubleshooting    This instrument has been designed to achieve a high level of reliability  In  the event of problems or failure  the troubleshooting guidelines  board level  connection diagrams  connector pin descriptions  and testing procedures  presented in this chapter should be helpful in isolating and identifying  problems     For additional fault location information refer to the    Preventive  Maintenance    chapter in this manual     The service mode in the    Operation    chapter includes parameters and  functions that are useful when making adjustments or diagnosing  problems     The Technical Support Department at Thermo Fisher Scientific can also  be consulted in the event of problems  See    Service Locations    on page 6   22 for contact information  In any correspondence with the factory  please  note both the serial number and program number of the inst
9.     B 34 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    meas mode   This command reports which measurement mode  NO NO   NO  NO    or prereactor  is active  The example below reports that the measurement  mode is set to NO     Send  meas mode  Receive  meas mode no    set meas mode mode  mode     no nox   no   nox   pre      This command sets the instrument to NO NO   auto  mode  manual NO  mode  manual NO  mode  or manual prereactor mode  The example below  sets the instrument to the manual NO mode     Send  set meas mode no  Receive  set meas mode no ok  pres comp    This command reports whether pressure compensation is on or off  The  example below shows that pressure compensation is on     Send  pres comp  Receive  pres comp on    set pres comp onoff  These commands turn the pressure compensation on or off  The example  below turns pressure compensation off     Send  set pres comp off  Receive  set pres comp off ok    temp comp  This command reports whether temperature compensation is on or off   The example below shows the temperature compensation is off     Send  temp comp  Receive  temp comp off    set temp comp onoff  These commands turn the temperature compensation on or off  The  example below turns temperature compensation off     Send  set temp comp off  Receive  set temp comp off ok  contrast    This command reports the screen   s level of contrast  The example below  shows the screen contrast is 50   according to Table B   7     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo F
10.     DANGER A hazard is present that will result in death or serious  personal injury if the warning is ignored  A    WARNING A hazard is present or an unsafe practice can result in  serious personal injury if the warning is ignored  A   CAUTION The hazard or unsafe practice could result in minor to  moderate personal injury if the warning is ignored  A    Equipment Damage The hazard or unsafe practice could result in property  damage if the warning is ignored  A    Thermo Fisher Scientific    About This Manual  Safety and Equipment Damage Alerts    Safety and Equipment damage Alerts in this Manual    Alert Description  WARNING If the equipment is operated in a manner not specified by  the manufacturer  the protection provided by the    equipment may be impaired  A    The service procedures in this manual are restricted to  qualified service personnel only  A    The Model 42i Trace Level is supplied with a three wire  grounding cord  Under no circumstances should this  grounding system be defeated  A    CAUTION If the LCD panel breaks  do not to let the liquid crystal  A N contact your skin or clothes  If the liquid crystal contacts  your skin or clothes  wash it off immediately using soap  and water  A    Equipment Damage Do not attempt to lift the analyzer by the cover or other  external fittings  A    Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded  antistatic wrist strap must be worn while handling any  internal componen
11.    36 SAMPLE MODE   37 PURGE MODE   38 NOT USED   39 ZERO CHECK CAL ALARM   40 SPAN CHECK CAL ALARM    Table C 2  Read Registers for 42i Trace Level       Register Number Variable  40001 amp 40002 NO  40003 amp 40004 N02    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual C 9    MODBUS Protocol  MODBUS Parameters Supported    C 10 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual                                                                                                          Register Number Variable  40005 amp 40006 NOx   40007 amp 40008 NOT USED  40009 amp 40010 NOT USED  40011 amp 40012 LOW NO   40013 amp 40014 LOW N02  40015 amp 40016 LOW NOx  40017 amp 40018 NOT USED  40019 amp 40020 NOT USED  40021 amp 40022 HIGH NO   40023 amp 40024 HIGH N02  40025 amp 40026 HIGH NOx  40027 amp 40028 NOT USED  40029 amp 40030 NOT USED   40031  amp 40032 RANGE  NOx   40033 amp 40034 NOT USED  40035 amp 40036 INTERNAL TEMPERATURE  40037 amp 40038 CHAMBER TEMPERATURE  40039 amp 40040 COOLER TEMPERATURE  40041  amp 40042 NO2 CONVERTER TEMP  40043 amp 40044 NOT USED  40045 amp 40046 PERM OVEN GAS  40047 amp 40048 PERM OVEN HEATER  40049 amp 40050 CHAMBER PRESSURE  40051  amp 40052 SAMPLE FLOW  40053 amp 40054 PMT VOLTS  40055 amp 40056 ANALOG IN 1  40057 amp 40058 ANALOG IN 2  40059 amp 40060 ANALOG IN 3   40061  amp 40062 ANALOG IN 4  40063 amp 40064 ANALOG IN 5  40065 amp 40066 ANALOG IN 6  40067 amp 40068 ANALOG IN 7  40069 amp 40070 ANALOG IN 8  40071 amp 40072 OZONATO
12.    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    Turn instrument OFF  unplug the power cord  and remove the cover     Disconnect plumbing from the pressure transducer assembly  Note the  P g P y  plumbing connections to facilitate reconnection     Disconnect the pressure transducer cable     Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 35    Servicing  Pressure Transducer Calibration    Pressure Transducer  Calibration    7 36 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual       Retaining Screws  2     Pressure Transducer Assembly    Figure 7   17  Replacing the Pressure Transducer    4  Remove the two pressure transducer assembly retaining screws and  remove the pressure transducer assembly     5  To install the pressure transducer assembly  follow previous steps in  reverse     6  Calibrate the pressure transducer  Refer to the    Pressure Transducer  Calibration    procedure that follows     Use the following procedure to calibrate the pressure transducer   Equipment Required     Vacuum pump    WARNING The service procedures in this manual are restricted to qualified    service representatives  A    If the equipment is operated in a manner not specified by the  manufacturer  the protection provided by the equipment may be  impaired  A    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  Pressure Transducer Calibra
13.    MODBUS Protocol  MODBUS Parameters Supported    MODBUS Parameters  Supported    C 8 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Here is an example of a request to write Coil 5 ON     Request   Field Name  Hex   Function 05  Output Address Hi 00  Output Address Lo 05  Output Value Hi FF  Output Value Lo 00  Response   Field Name  Hex   Function 05  Output Address Hi 00  Output Address Lo 05  Output Value Hi FF  Output Value Lo 00    The following Table C   1 through Table C   3 lists the MODBUS  parameters supported for the Model 42i Trace Level     Table C 1  Read Coils for 427 Trace Level                                     Coil Number Status   1 AUTORANGE  NOx   2 LOCAL REMOTE   3 SERVICE   4 UNITS   5 ZERO MODE   6 SPAN MODE   7 NO MODE   8 NOx MODE   9 NOT USED   10 PRE MODE   11 GEN ALARM   12 NO CONC MAX ALARM       Thermo Fisher Scientific    MODBUS Protocol  MODBUS Parameters Supported                                                                                     Coil Number Status   13 NO CONC MIN ALARM   14 NO2 CONC MAX ALARM   15 NO2 CONC MIN ALARM   16 NOx CONC MAX ALARM   17 NOx CONC MIN ALARM   18 NOT USED   19 NOT USED   20 NOT USED   21 NOT USED   22 INT TEMP ALARM   23 CHAMB TEMP ALARM   24 COOLER TEMP ALARM   25 NO2 CONVERTER TEMP ALARM  26 NOT USED   27 PERM OVEN GAS TEMP ALARM  28 PRESSURE ALARM   29 FLOW ALARM   30 OZONE FLOW ALARM   31 MOTHERBOARD STATUS ALARM  32 INTERFACE BD STATUS ALARM  33 1 0 EXP BD STATUS ALARM   34 NOT USED   35 CONC ALARM
14.    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Measurement  Calculations    Output Communication    Thermo Fisher Scientific    System Description  Software    stabilize  After those three seconds  it accumulates the signal counts for  seven seconds before again switching the solenoid     The calculation of the NO and NO  concentrations is lengthy and uses the  high level processor to provide the most accurate readings  The calculation  egins by subtracting the appropriate electronic offset from the seven   second count accumulation  Following this correction  the raw  accumulated counts are scaled according to the gain setting of the input    board     Next  the uncorrected NO and NO  values are determined according to a  unique averaging algorithm which minimizes errors resulting from rapidly  changing gas concentrations  This algorithm results in NO and NO  values  which are stored in RAM in a circular buffer that holds all the ten second  data from the previous five minutes  This data is averaged over the selected  time interval  which can be any multiple of ten between 10 and 300  the  manual modes have additional intervals of 1  2  and 5 seconds      The background values for NO and NO  which are corrected for  temperature  are subtracted from their respective averages  The NO reading  is corrected by the stored span factor and by the temperature factor  The  NO  reading is partially corrected by the span factor  temperature factor   and balance factor  The corrected NO value is subtra
15.    User Value    Temperature  Compensation    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu    The Volts screen allows the user to set the input voltage for the selected  table point in the conversion table  from 0 00 to 10 50  The default table is  a two point table with point 1  0 00 V   000 0 U and point 2  10 00 V    10 0 U     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration  gt   Analog Input Config  gt  Select Channel  gt  Select Point  gt  Volts        ERED CH  Pi Tit    Wi mid  PS PHP ESE Py AG Lf bie       The User Value screen allows the user to set the output value for the  corresponding input voltage for the selected table point in the conversion  table  from  9999999 to 99999999  The default table is a two point table  with point 1  0 00 V   000 0 U and point 2  10 00 V   10 0 U     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration  gt     Analog Input Config  gt  Select Table Point  gt  User Value        CH mtb       Temperature compensation provides compensation for any changes to the  instrument s output signal due to internal instrument temperature  variations  The effects of internal instrument temperature changes on the  analyzer s subsystems and output have been empirically determined  This  empirical data is used to compensate for any changes in temperature     When temperature compensation is on  the display shows the current  internal instrument temperature  measured by a thermistor on the Interf
16.    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Communication  Settings  gt  TCP IP Settings  gt  Gateway        Host Name The host name screen is used to edit the host name  When DHCP is  enabled  this name is reported to the DHCP server     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Communication  Settings  gt  TCP IP Settings  gt  Host Name        1 0 Configuration The I O Configuration menu deals with configuration of the analyzer   s    I O system  The analog input configuration is displayed only if the I O  expansion board option is installed     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration     Note The digital outputs may take up to one second after the assigned  state occurs to show up on the outputs  A    3 42 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu       Output Relay Settings The Output Relay Settings menu displays a list of the 10 digital output  relays available  and allows the user to select the logic state or instrument  parameter for the relay selected     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration  gt   Output Relay Settings        Pra es Cu Ctr    Saal wows  EE fee PEE SEE          Logic State The Logic State screen is used to change the I O relay to either normally  open or normally closed     e Press to toggle and set the logic state open or closed           Instrument State The Instrument State submenu allows the user to select t
17.    set alarm trig conc no2 value  set alarm trig conc nox value  set alarm trig conc pre value    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Diagnostics    Datalogging    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Diagnostics    These commands set the NO  NO2  NO  and prereactor concentration  alarm minimum value  where value is set to either floor or ceiling   according to Table B   3  The example below sets the NO concentration  minimum alarm trigger to ceiling     Send  set alarm trig conc no 1  Receive  set alarm trig conc no 1 ok    Table B 3  Alarm Trigger Values       Value Alarm Trigger  00 Floor  01 Ceiling   diag volt mb    This command reports the diagnostic voltage measurements on the  motherboard  The sequence of voltages is  Positive 24  positive 15  positive  5  positive 3 3  and negative 3 3  Each voltage value is separated by a space     Send  diag volt mb  Receive  diag volt mb 24 1 14 9 4 9 3 2  3 2    diag volt mib   This command reports the diagnostic voltage measurements on the  measurement interface board  The sequence of voltages is  Positive 24   positive 15  negative 15  positive 5  positive 3 3  positive 18 IR  positive 18  MOT  and VBIAS  Each voltage value is separated by a space     Send  diag volt mib  Receive  diag volt mib 24 1 14 9  14 9 4 9 3 2 17 9 17 9  diag volt iob    This command reports the diagnostic voltage measurements on the I O  expansion board  The sequence of voltages is  Positive 24  positive 5   positive 3 3  and negative 3 3  Eac
18.    tt    Bs EEE TE Sanat Bone mo          The Analog Output Calibration menu is a selection of 6 voltage channels  and 6 current channels  if I O expansion board option is installed  to  calibrate  and allows the user to select the calibration action zero or span   The analog output calibration is visible only when the instrument is in  service mode  For more information on the service mode  see    Service  Mode    earlier in the chapter     Note This adjustment should only be performed by an instrument service  technician  A    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Analog Out Calibration     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 81    Operation  Service Menu    DH Guided  Ce a a                DH Guided  fot PEL ETE SEE          Analog Output Calibrate The Analog Output Calibrate Zero screen allows the user to calibrate the  Zero zero state of the selected analog output  The operator must connect a meter  to the output and adjust the output until it reads 0 0 V on the meter     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Analog Out Calibration  gt  Select  Channel  gt  Calibrate Zero        Analog Output Calibrate The Analog Output Calibrate Full Scale screen allows the user to calibrate  Full Scale the full scale state of the selected analog output  The operator must connect    a meter to the output and adjust output until it reads the value shown in  the set output to  field     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Analog Out Calibration  gt  Select    Channel  gt  Cali
19.   11  0x00  Register value Hi  12  0x00  Register value Lo  12  0x64  Register value Hi  13  0x00  Register value Lo  13  0x64    The contents of register 10 are shown as the two byte values of 0x02 0x2B   Then contents of registers 11   13 are 0x00 0x00  0x00 0x64 and 0x00 0x64  respectively     The force  write  single coil function simulates the activation of the digital  inputs in the instrument  which triggers the respective action     This function code is used to set a single action to either ON or OFF  The  request specifies the address of the action to be forced  Actions are  addressed starting at zero  Therefore  action number 1 is addressed as 0   The requested ON OFF state is specified by a constant in the request data  field  A value of 0xFF00 requests the action to be ON  A value of 0x0000  requests it to be OFF  All other values are illegal and will not affect the  output  The normal response is an echo of the request  returned after the  state has been written     Request   Function code 1 Byte 0x05   Starting Address 2 Bytes 0x0000 to maximum allowed by instrument  Output Value 2 Bytes 0x0000 or OxFFOO   Response   Function code 1 Byte 0x05   Starting Address 2 Bytes 0x0000 to maximum allowed by instrument  Output Value 2 Bytes 0x0000 or OxFFOO   Error Response   Function code 1 Byte Function code   0x80   Exception code 1 Byte 01 IIlegal Function  02 IIlegal Address     03 IIlegal Data  04 Slave Device Failure    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual C 7 
20.   For details  see the following topics     e    Display    on page 3 1   e    Pushbuttons    on page 3 2   e    Software Overview    on page 3 4   e    Averaging Time    on page 3 15   e    Calibration Factors Menu    on page 3 16  e    Calibration Menu    on page 3 20   e    Instrument Controls Menu    on page 3 25  e    Diagnostics Menu    on page 3 56   e    Alarms Menu    on page 3 63   e    Service Menu    on page 3 73    e    Password Menu    on page 3 86    Display The 320 x 240 graphics liquid crystal display  LCD  shows the sample  concentrations  instrument parameters  instrument controls  help  and error  messages  Some menus contain more items than can be displayed at one  time  For these menus  use _     and     to move the cursor up and  down to each item     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 1    Operation  Pushbuttons     gt          3  0       Figure 3 1  Front Panel Display    CAUTION If the LCD panel breaks  do not to let the liquid crystal contact  your skin or clothes  If the liquid crystal contacts your skin or clothes  wash  it off immediately using soap and water  A    Pushbutto nS The Pushbuttons allow the user to traverse the various screens menus        Figure 3 2  Front Panel Pushbuttons    3 2 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation    Pushbuttons  Table 3   1 lists the front panel pushbuttons and their functions   Table 3 1  Front Panel Pushbuttons  Key Name Function       
21.   The Geysitech Commands that are implemented are explained in detail in  this document  The Geysitech protocol support for the   Series enables the  user to perform the functions of reading the various concentrations and to  trigger the instrument to be in sample zero span mode if valid for that  instrument  This is achieved by using the supported Geysitech commands  listed below     For details of the Model 427 Trace Level Geysitech Protocol specification   see the following topics        Serial Communication Parameters    on page D 1     TCP Communication Parameters    on page D 2     Instrument Address    on page D 2   Abbreviations Used    on page D 2      Basic Command Structure    on page D 2      Block Checksum    on page D 3      Geysitech Commands    on page D 3    The following are the communication parameters that are used to configure  the serial port of the   Series to support Geysitech protocol     Number of Data bits  8   Number of Stop bits 1   Parity   None   Data rate   from 1200 115200 Baud  9600 is default     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual D 1    Geysitech  Bayern Hessen  Protocol  TCP Communication Parameters    TCP Communication  Parameters    Instrument Address    Abbreviations Used    Basic Command  Structure    D 2 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    iSeries Instruments support the Geysitech TCP protocol over TCP IP  The  register definition is the same as for the serial interface     TCP connection port for Geysitech  9882    The 
22.   Use the following procedures to calibrate the analog inputs after replacing  the optional I O expansion board  These procedures include selecting  analog input channels  calibrating them to zero volts  and then calibrating  them to full scale using a known voltage source     Use the following procedure to calibrate the input channels to zero volts     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 33    Servicing  Analog Input Calibration    Calibrating the Input  Channels to Full Scale    7 34 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    1  From the Main Menu  press     to scroll to Service  press  gt         to scroll to Analog Input Calibration  and press        The Analog Input Cal screen displays     Note If Service Mode is not displayed  refer to    Accessing the Service  Mode    on page 7 4  then return to the beginning of this step  A    2  At the Analog Input Cal screen  press  _   _  to scroll to a channel  and  press          3  With the cursor at Calibrate Zero  press         The screen displays the input voltage for the selected channel     4  Make sure that nothing is connected to the channel input pins and  press to calibrate the input voltage on the selected channel to    zero volts     The screen displays 0 00 V as the voltage setting     5  Press  a   gt      to return to the Analog Input Cal screen and  repeat Steps 2 through 4 to calibrate other input channels to zero as  necessary     6  Continue with the    Calibrating the Input Channels to Full Scale     p
23.   alarm chamber temp min  Receive  alarm chamber temp min 47 0 deg C    set alarm chamber temp min value   set alarm chamber temp max value   These commands set the chamber temperature alarm minimum and  maximum values to value  where value is a floating point number  representing chamber temperature alarm limits in degrees C  The example  below sets the chamber temperature alarm maximum value to 50 0   C     Send  set alarm chamber temp max 50 0  Receive  set alarm chamber temp max 50 0 ok    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 13    C Link Protocol Commands  Alarms    B 14 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    alarm conc no min   alarm conc no2 min   alarm conc nox min   alarm conc pre min   alarm conc no max   alarm conc no2 max   alarm conc nox max   alarm conc pre max   These commands report the NO  NO2  NO  and prereactor concentration  alarm minimum and maximum values current setting  The example below  reports that the NO concentration minimum is 62 7 ppb     Send  alarm conc no min  Receive  alarm conc no min 62 7 ppb    set alarm conc no min value   set alarm conc no2 min value   set alarm conc nox min value   set alarm conc pre min value   set alarm conc no max value   set alarm conc no2 max value   set alarm conc nox max value   set alarm conc pre max value   These commands set the NO  NO2  NO  and prereactor concentration  alarm minimum and maximum values to value  where value is a floating   point representation of the conce
24.   and variables B 45  low avg time Reports sets low averaging time B 9    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Accessing Streaming Data                                                                                     Command Description Page  low no Reports NO concentration calculated with low range B 10  coefficients  low no coef Reports sets low range NO coefficient B 26  low no gas Reports sets low range NO span gas concentration B 27  low no2 Reports NO  concentration calculated with low range B 10  coefficients  low no2 coef Reports sets low range NO  coefficient B 26  low no2 gas Reports sets low range NO  span gas concentration B 27  low nox Reports NO  concentration calculated with low range B 10  coefficients  low nox coef Reports sets low range NO  coefficient B 26  low nox gas Reports sets low range NO  span gas concentration B 27  low pre Reports prereactor concentration calculated with low range B 10  coefficients  low range no Reports sets current NO low range B 31  low range no2 Reports sets current NO  low range B 31  low range nox Reports sets current NO  low range B 31  Ir Outputs long records in the format specified in the command B 19  Irec Outputs long records B 20  Irec format Reports sets output format for long records  ASCII or binary  B 21  Irec layout Reports current layout of Irec data B 22  Irec mem size Reports maximum number of long records that can be stored B 22  Irec per Reports sets long record 
25.   e    Replacement Parts    on page 5 2   e    Cleaning the Outside Case    on page 5 2   e    Ozonator Air Feed Drying Column Replacement    on page 5 2   e    Capillaries Inspection and Replacement    on page 5 2   e    Thermoelectric Cooler Fins Inspection and Cleaning    on page 5 4  e    Fan Filters Inspection and Cleaning    on page 5 4    e    Pump Rebuilding    on page 5 5    Read the safety precautions before beginning any procedures in this  chapter     WARNING If the equipment is operated in a manner not specified by the  manufacturer  the protection provided by the equipment may be impaired  Do not attempt to lift the instrument by the cover or other external  fittings  A    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  For more  information about appropriate safety precautions  see the    Servicing     chapter  A    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 5 1    Preventative Maintenance  Replacement Parts    Replacement Parts    Cleaning the Outside  Case    A    Ozonator Air Feed  Drying Column  Replacement    Capillaries Inspection  and Replacement    A    5 2 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    See the    Servicing    chapter for a list of replacement parts     Clean the outside case using a damp cloth being careful not to damage the  labels on the case     Equipment Damage Do not use solvents or other cle
26.   numbered 1   16 are addressed as 0 15  The register data in the response  message are packed as two bytes per register  with the binary contents right  justified within each byte  For each register  the first byte contains the high  order bits and the second contains the low order bits     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual C 5    MODBUS Protocol  Function Codes    C 6 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    Request   Function code  Starting Address  Quantity of Registers    Response  Function code  Byte count    Register value     N   Quantity of Registers    Error Response  Function code    Exception code    1 Byte  2 Bytes  2 Bytes    1 Byte  1 Byte  N  x 2 Bytes    1 Byte  1 Byte    0x03 or 0x04    0x0000 to maximum allowed by instrument    1 to maximum allowed by instrument    0x03 or 0x04  2 x N   N  N or N 1    Function code   0x80    01 IIlegal Function  02 IIlegal Address     03 Illegal Data  04 Slave Device Failure    Here is an example of a request and response to read registers 10 13     Request   Field Name  Function   Starting Address Hi  Starting Address Lo  No  of Registers Hi    No  of Registers Lo    Response   Field Name   Function   Byte Count   Register value Hi  10   Register value Lo  10     Register value Hi  11      Hex   0x03  0x00  0x09  0x00  0x04     Hex   0x03  0x06  0x02  0x2B  0x00    Thermo Fisher Scientific     0x05  Force  Write     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Single Coil    MODBUS Protocol  Function Codes       Register value Lo
27.   on page 7 26     Input Board Replacement    on page 7 27      Input Board Calibration    on page 7 28      DC Power Supply Replacement    on page 7 29      Analog Output Testing    on page 7 30      Analog Output Calibration    on page 7 32      Analog Input Calibration    on page 7 33      Pressure Transducer Assembly Replacement    on page 7 35     Pressure Transducer Calibration    on page 7 36     Temperature Control Board Replacement    on page 7 38     Ambient Temperature Calibration    on page 7 39      Fuse Replacement    on page 7 40      Scrubber Replacement    on page 7 40      I O Expansion Board  Optional  Replacement    on page 7 41     Digital Output Board Replacement    on page 7 43     Motherboard Replacement    on page 7 43      Measurement Interface Board Replacement    on page 7 44     Flow Transducer Replacement    on page 7 45      Flow Transducer Calibration    on page 7 46      Front Panel Board Replacement    on page 7 48      LCD Module Replacement    on page 7 49       Service Locations    on page 7 50    Read the safety precautions before beginning any procedures in this  chapter     WARNING The service procedures in this manual are restricted to qualified  service representatives  A    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  Safety Precautions    If the equipment is operated in a manner not specified by the    manufacturer  the protection provided by the equipment may be  impaired  A    CAUTION Carefully observe the in
28.   ranges  and push the AVG soft key to  display the Averaging Time screen  It is recommended that a higher  averaging time be used for best results  For more information about the  ranges or averaging time  see the    Operation    chapter     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Calibration    Connect GPT Apparatus  to the Analyzer    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Calibration  Calibration    Note The averaging time should be less than the zero duration and less  than the span duration  A    5  Set the calibration pressure to the current reactor pressure   a  Press      choose  gt  Calibration Factors  gt  Cal Pressure     b  Use       to increment decrement the value to match the  current reactor pressure  and press to save the new    calibration pressure value     6  Verify that any filters used during normal monitoring are also used  during calibration     7  If required  connect the analog digital outputs to a strip chart  recorder s  or PC s      The following procedure calibrates the analyzer using the gas phase titrator  and zero gas generator described previously in this manual  It is suggested  that a calibration curve have at least seven points between the zero and full  scale NO concentrations  Although the seven point curve is optional  two  of whatever number of points is chosen should be located at the zero and  90  levels and the remaining points equally spaced between these values     Note When the instrument is equipped with internal zero span and sample  valves  the ZER
29.   unplug the power cord  and remove the cover   2  Disconnect the two PMT high voltage supply cables     3  Loosen the two retaining screws securing the assembly bracket to the  floor plate and slide the assembly towards the rear slightly and lift it off  the base screws     4  Loosen two screws on the input box assembly and lift the input box  assembly off the power supply     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  PMT Voltage Adjustment    5  Remove the four screws securing the power supply to the bracket and  remove the power supply           lt           Assembly Bracket    HVPS    Input Box Screws  2   Assembly Bracket Screws  2     Figure 7   9  Replacing the PMT HVPS  6  To install the power supply  follow the previous steps in reverse     7  Recalibrate the instrument  Refer to the calibration procedures in the     Calibration    chapter     PMT Voltage Use the following procedure to adjust the PMT voltage after switching  Ad ju stment from standard to extended ranges or vice versa     f WARNING The service procedures in this manual are restricted to qualified    service representatives  A    1  Select the NO  NO   and NO  ranges  Refer to    Range Menu    in the     Operation    chapter     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 19    Servicing  Reaction Chamber Cleaning or Removal    Reaction Chamber    Cleaning or Removal    7 20    A    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Set the NO BKG and NO  BKG calibration factors to 0 0  R
30.  0  and SO  Activated Charcoal    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Calibration  Equipment Required    Gas Phase Titrator A gas phase titrator  GPT   such as is included in the Thermo Scientific  Model 146 Series Multigas Calibration System is used to generate NO2  concentrations from NO concentrations  Figure 4 1 shows the suggested  placement of the component parts of a gas phase titration apparatus     Equipment Damage All connections between components in the system  should be made with glass  Teflon     or other non reactive material  A    Flow Controllers The airflow controllers should be devices capable of maintaining constant  airflows within  2  of the required flow rate  The NO flow controller  should be capable of maintaining constant NO flows within  2  of the  required flow rate     Pressure Regulator The pressure regulator for the standard NO cylinder must have a non   reactive diaphragm and internal parts  and a suitable delivery pressure     F C   FLOW CONTROLLER  F M   FLOW METER     Fo    MIXING CHAMBER       Figure 4 1  GPT System    Ozone Generator The ozone generator must be capable of generating sufficient and stable  levels of ozone for reaction with NO to generate NO  concentrations in the  range required     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 4 3    Calibration  Equipment Required    Diverter Valve    Reaction Chamber    Mixing Chamber    Output Manifold    Reagents    Note Ozone generators of the electric discharge type may p
31.  0 intt  80 0 rctt 80 0 convt 61 smplf 0 500 ozonf 0 000 pmtv    116   11 07 02 22 03 flags 54089100 no 8442E 1 nox 8383E 1  lono 6494E 1 lonox 6449E 1 pres 131 5 pmtt 53 1 intt  80 0 rctt 80 0 convt 61 smplf 0 500 ozonf 0 000 pmtv    116       where     pmtv   PMT Voltage   pmtt   PMT Temperature   intt   Internal Temperature   rctt   Reaction Chamber Temperature  convt   NO   Converter Temperature  smplf   Sample Flow   ozonf   Ozonator Flow   pres   Pressure    erec format   lrec format   srec format   These commands report the output format for long and short records  and  dynamic data in various formats such as ASCII without text  ASCII with  text  or binary  The example below shows the output format for long  records is ASCII with text  according to Table B   4     Send  lrec format  Receive  lrec format 01    set erec format format  set lrec format format  set srec format format    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 21    C Link Protocol Commands  Datalogging    These commands set the output format for long and short records  and  dynamic data  according to Table B   4  The example below sets the long  record output format to ASCII with text     Send  set lrec format 1  Receive  set lrec format 1 ok    Table B 4  Record Output Formats       Format Output Format  0 ASCII no text   1 ASCII with text  2 Binary data    erec layout   lrec layout   srec layout   These commands report the layout  string indicating the data formats  for  data that is sent out in respon
32.  3 Pin ee  e POAERSUPPLY  REAR PANEL     AC 24VDC  acinput Leong PI  2 Pin       his  FRONT PANEL  POWER SW  nee ee PJ6    1 TRANSFCRVER we 3 Pin  figs Soe Sod cae coe eee e  OVAC o 240VAC oe  I PTS fl    6 6 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Figure 6   1  Board Level Connection Diagram   Common Electronics    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    DATA  I lt   PI8    3 Pin    PJ3    24 DC    Troubleshooting  Board Level Connection Diagrams    J2 eae nr  _  PMT ANODE  10 Pin 2 Cond    PMT HVPS     7 Pin 2 Cond    SAMPLEFLOW  5 Pin               L  Zaonw  3 Pin      Zaar  2 Pin  4 Pin L     _  AMBIENT TEVP  THERM   2 Pin  Pe eas we Se a a ee me DS i  2 Pin Hostem PERM OVEN i  HATER 15V  1W  PTa i  4 Pin      amp ONTHEM O LLL i    C  NON  a  2 Pin     amme  2 Pin       _  MPNA  Pin  zP    a   sa  in  SPL  PEA  2 Pin PANI    FAN2  2 Pin 2 Pin  i HP ipm ACT   BENCHHEATER  60w   ONA i DL  CONNERTERHEATER OW  AC 2 Pin 2 eine  C  CONVERTER THEAVIOCOLALE  3 Pin       Figure 6   2  Board Level Connection Diagram   Measurement System    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 6 7    Troubleshooting  Connector Pin Descriptions    Connector Pin  Descriptions    6 8 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    The connector pin descriptions in Table 6 3 through Table 6   9 can be  used along with the board level connection diagrams to troubleshoot  board level faults        Motherboard Connector Pin Descriptions    on page 6 8     Measurement Interface Board Con
33.  7   2  Model 42i Trace Level Cables                                           Part Number Description  101036 00 DC Power Supply 24V Output  01037 00 115VAC Supply to Interface Board  01048 00 RS 485 Data  01038 00 Power Switch to Motherboard  01364 00 DC Power Supply Status Monitor  01054 00 Motherboard to Front Panel Board  01035 00 DC Power Supply AC Input  101033 00 AC from Receptacle  01377 00 AC to Power Switch  01267 00 Fan Power Cable  01346 00 Temperature Control  01355 00 Signal Output Ribbon  01050 00 Heater Power  01055 00 Main AC Receptacle Assembly  102057 00 AC to External Pump       External Device    able 7 3 lists the standard and optional cables and components used for  Connection connecting external devices such as PCs and data loggers to an iSeries    Components Table 7 3  External Device Connection Components    instrument           Part Number Description   101562 00 Terminal Block and Cable Kit  DB25   optional   101556 00 Terminal Block and Cable Kit  DB37   optional   102645 00 Cable  DB37M to Open End Cable  Six Feet  optional   102646 00 Cable  DB37F to Open End  Six Feet  optional        7 6 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Part Number    Servicing  External Device Connection Components    Description       102659 00    Cable  DB25M to Open End  Six Feet  optional        6219    Cable  RS 232  optional        102888 00    Terminal Board PCB Assembly  DB37F  standard with all  instruments        102891 00    Ter
34.  Check temperature  less than    2   C at Tamb   25   C         Non linear response    Incorrect calibration source    Leak in sample probe line    Verify accuracy of multipoint  calibration source gas     Check for variable dilution        Excessive response  time    Partially blocked sample  capillary    Hang up blockage in sample  filter    Unplug power cord  Clean or  replace capillary     Change element        Improper converter  operation    Questionable calibration gas  Converter temperature too high  or too low    Low line voltage    Molybdenum consumed    Verify accuracy     Temperature should be  approximately 325   C     Check to see if line voltage is  within specifications     Replace Molybdenum converter  cartridge     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 6 3    Troubleshooting  Troubleshooting Guides    Table 6 2  Troubleshooting   Alarm Messages    Alarm Message    Alarm   Internal Temp    Possible Cause    Check fan operation    Check fan filter    Action    Replace fan if not operating  properly    Clean or replace foam filter   refer to    Preventive  Maintenance    chapter in this  manual        Alarm   Chamber Temp    Chamber temperature below set  point of 50   C    Check 10K ohm thermistor   replace if bad     Check temperature control  board to insure the LEDs are  coming on  If not  temperature  control board could be  defective        Alarm   Cooler Temp    Cooler reads 80   C    Check fan operation  Check fan filter  Bad cooler    Cooler does no
35.  Connector Pin Descriptions i viissdscnssscsevesssstoassnetrutessdede dawisntasibutacines 6 8  DEP VICS Locations anneni a a depres T R deeds 6 22  SOMVICING iann a a n iai 7 1  Safety  Precautions aenur E a ee rE AOE 7 2  Firmware Updates  c 2 scyecsseiy  cia  betas dita cost eeaectuagledidin ace atea 7 4  Accessing the Service Mode ss egestas treads anata eeeds aia 7 4  Replacement Parts Wists   6 di ceengeet ot cd caceeccs Sats i end ote RESE Tie 7 4  Cable listna n feast de cae uate ste hie ciate E y 7 6  External Device Connection Components           sccssseeecseeteeeeneeeeeeeeees 7 6  Removing the Measurement Bench and Lowering the Partition Panel 7 8  Pump Replacements esti en nie EA e Eia a KSA 7 9  Vacuum Pump Diaphragm and Valve Replacement    cesses  7 10  Diaphragm Replacement  Giese eG e oe hese iee ecue 7 11  Valve Replacement ainneoin aiina iiia 7 12  Fan Replacement  isisisi insi ie nia iaaa 7 14  PMT Cooler and Reaction Chamber Assembly Replacement             7 15  Photomultiplier Tube Replacement      sseeeeeeerrrsrsrsse 7 17  PMT High Voltage Power Supply Replacement   s sessccereeeeeeeeeeee 7 18  PMT Voltage Adjustment 2 442404  co Sai tie ee Etta 7 19  Reaction Chamber Cleaning or Removal 22    cscc usesieee nnn 7 20  NO gt  to NO Converter Replacement         scccsssesccseeseeeeeseeeeneeeeneeaees 7 22  Solenoid Valve Replacement 2  sisccacitaccticiweeeencatabeeieiaccciinnees  7 23  Ozonator Assembly Replacement o cii hcc seesdvicieciedet neat teeedeeee
36.  Description  1 Analog1 13 Power_Fail_NC   2 Analog ground 14 Power_Fail_COM  3 Analog2 15 Power_Fail_NO  4 Analog ground 16 TTL_Input1   5 Analog3 17 TTL_Input2   6 Analog ground 18 TTL_Input3   7 Analog4 19 TTL_Input4   8 Analog ground 20 Digital ground   9 Analog5 21 TTL_Input5   10 Analog ground 22 TTL_Input6   11 Analog6 23 TTL_Input7   12 Analog ground 24 Digital ground       Thermo Fisher Scientific    D O Terminal Board    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Installation    Connecting External Devices    identifies the connector pins and associated signals     See Detail    A        d  Assembled Connector       See Detail    B       Detail    A       Figure 2   6  D O Terminal Board Views    Table 2 2  D O Terminal Board Pin Descriptions    Figure 2   6 shows the recommended method for attaching the cable to the  terminal board using the included tie down and spacer  Table 2   2    Detail    B                                        Pin Signal Description Pin Signal Description  1 Relay1_ContactA 13 Relay7_ContactA  2 Relay1_ContactB 14 Relay7_ContactB  3 Relay2_ContactA 15 Relay8_ContactA  4 Relay2_ContactB 16 Relay8_ContactB  5 Relay3_ContactA 17 Relay9_ContactA  6 Relay3_ContactB 18 Relay9_ContactB  7 Relay4_ContactA 19 Relay10_ContactA  8 Relay4_ContactB 20 Relay10_ContactB  9 Relay5_ContactA 21  not used    10 Relay5_ContactB 22  24V   11 Relay6_ContactA 23  not used    12 Relay6_ContactB 24  24V       Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 2 7    Installation  Connecti
37.  Dioxide        In addition  the procedure for the certification of a NO working standard  against an NIST traceable NO standard and determination of the amount  of NO  impurity in the working standard is reproduced here  The cylinder  should be re certified on a regular basis as determined by the local quality  control program     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Assaying a Working NO  Standard Against a NIST   traceable NO Standard    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Calibration  Equipment Required    Use the NIST traceable NO standard and the GPT calibration procedure  to calibrate the NO  NO   and NO  responses of the instrument  Also  determine the converter efficiency of the analyzer  Refer to the calibration  procedure in this manual and in the Code of Federal Regulations  Title 40   Part 50  Appendix F for exact details     Note Ignore the recommended zero offset adjustments  A    Use the following procedure to calculate the NO concentration standard    and NO  impurity          Generate several NO concentrations by dilution of the NO working  standard     Use the nominal NO concentration   NO nom  to calculate the diluted  concentrations     Plot the analyzer NO response  in ppm  versus the nominal diluted  NO concentration and determine the slope  Snom     Calculate the  NO  concentration of the working standard   NO srp   from      NO stp   INO Inom X SNoM  If the nominal NO concentration of the working standard is unknown   generate several NO concentrations to give on scal
38.  EAER cae  2 2  Connecting External Devices        ssseeseeeeeeeisieteerererereisisisesesesesesseseses 2 5  Terminal Board PCB Assemblies         s ssssesseseseeessesesseseseesesesssseseseee 2 5  VO Terminal Bear taco vectate foe tee sirrini 2 5  D O Terminal Board sles  tsa cata e a Mem oa otal 2 7  25 Pin Terminal Bard ass2 cs ccsetevclvaiatQocasiace sents cdevetty tienda takes 2 8  SUIT UES esd  as sonnei dial a etiam tedens eae d isin ode hang secemuniateiss 2 9  Operationissnirissrininannrina avec avesiedhsteuasay edn A eu dvawonadl 3 1  Displayen hanna aed dieters eniii neal aad 3 1  P  shbuttonssisnsanninitir tcl a atte suels red R RRON 3 2  Soft Rvs a a A E E R N A RS 3 3  Software OVervViEW o eee sre E a AE T ees cae a R 3 4  PO Werte  PSC lee ica sates eves ennan ari ias 3 6  R  n SCree tis seis caycidscodaesevoda tas audios stout nape cacucesitiadederedetut sedan R 3 6  Mam TST etess eheto eoa ee nest EE a sa enntny E tyre aah E eines 3 7  Range Menu eroris aa n A N ER 3 8  Single Range Modessa aiae Ba eei eaa REEERE eds 3 8  Dual Range Wades fc de Met aiaa a its  A RA 3 9  Auto Range Moderates aee a a a 3 11  Gas IAIN sos ienen cane date snes a acy R a aa a des 3 13  NO  NO   and NO  Ranges     essesessseeseseeeeeeesesssrsrterreerererersesre 3 13  Set CSG RANGES cope anaetoa a a a deie 3 14  Custom Ranges  icisiweniatsschedeidsoivatisclivinsteonaedsdode daniel btlanieatd 3 15  Ayeraging TIME 16h casioded diesen tara eananias E E das 3 15  Calibration Factors Menu 
39.  Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 2 3    Installation  Setup Procedure    2  Connect the air dryer to the DRY AIR bulkhead     3  Connect the pump vacuum port  inlet  to the EXHAUST bulkhead   figure 2 4      4    Figure 2   4  Twin Head Vacuum Pump Installation    4  Connect the pump exhaust to a suitable vent or charcoal scrubber     A N Equipment Damage DO NOT connect the pump exhaust port to the  EXHAUST bulkhead  This can cause permanent damage to both the    cooler and the photomultiplier tube  A    5  Connect a suitable recording device to the rear panel connector  For  detailed information about connecting to the instrument  refer to        Connecting External Devices    on page 2 5      External Device Connection Components    on page 7 6     Terminal Block and Cable Kits    on page 9 2     Instrument Controls Menu    on page 3 25    For detailed information about troubleshooting a connection  refer to     Analog Output Testing    on page 7 30     2 4 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    A    Connecting  External Devices    Terminal Board PCB  Assemblies    1 0 Terminal Board    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Installation  Connecting External Devices    6  Plug the instrument into an outlet of the appropriate voltage and  frequency     WARNING The Model 427 Trace Level is supplied with a three wire  grounding cord  Under no circumstances should this grounding system be  defeated  A    Several components are avail
40.  Input 2  Ground   TTL Input 5  TTL Input 7  TTL Input 8  TTL Input 10  10 Ground   TTL Input 13  TTL Input 15    Ground    oOo a N on A WW N     a           a a a  e w N    Analog Voltage 1    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual 6 9    Troubleshooting  Connector Pin Descriptions    6 10 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual                   Connector Reference Pin Signal Description  Label Designator  15 Analog Voltage 3  16 Ground  17 Analog Voltage 5  18 Ground  19 Ground  20 Power Fail Relay COM  21 Power Fail Relay N O  Contact  22 Ground  23 TTL Input 3  24 TTL Input 4  25 TTL Input 6  26 Ground  27 TTL Input 9  28 TTL Input 11  29 TTL Input 12  30 TTL Input 14  31 TTL Input 16  32 Ground  33 Analog Voltage 2  34 Analog Voltage 4  35 Ground  36 Analog Voltage 6  37 Ground  SER EN J7 Serial Enable Jumper  2  3 3V  24V IN J10  24V  2 Ground  DIGITAL 1 0 J14  5V  2  24V  3  24V  4 Ground  5 Ground  6 Ground  7 SPI Reset    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Connector  Label    Reference  Designator    Pin    Troubleshooting  Connector Pin Descriptions    Signal Description    SPI Input   SPI Output   SPI Board Select  SPI Clock       EXT  RS485    J15    5  gt  co loo  N o  Sz P o N  gt       oO    a  a a a  ol P w N     RS485 to Rear Panel   RS485 to Rear Panel   5V    5V    5V   Ground   Ground   Ground   NC   NC    24    24    24    24    24       24 MONITOR    J17    24V Power Monitor    Ground       FRONT PANEL  B
41.  Measurement Interface Board  100856 00 Temperature Control Board  Molybdenum Converter   101167 00 Input Board Assembly  9973 Ozonator Assembly  101419 00 Ozonator Transformer  101023 00 Pressure Transducer  101021 00 Flow Transducer  Sample   101620 00 Flow Switch  Ozone   9367 Photomultiplier Tube  PMT   101024 00 PMT High Voltage Power Supply  101324 00 PMT Base Socket Assembly  101390 00 Solenoid Valve  101020 00 Cooler Assembly  02648 01 Reaction Chamber Assembly  101009 00 NO2 to NO Converter Assembly  Molybdenum 110VAC   9269 Molybdenum Converter Cartridge  9456 Pump 120VAC  60Hz  8079 Pump 110VAC  50Hz  9457 Pump 220VAC  50Hz  8500 Pump 220VAC  60Hz  8080 Pump 100VAC  50 60Hz  9464 Pump Repair Kit  101055 00 AC Receptacle Assembly  101681 00 Power Supply Assembly  24VDC  w Base Plate and Screws  100907 00 Fan  24VDC  8630 Fan Filter  101905 00 Fuse  250VAC  4 0 Amp  SlowBlow  for 100VAC and 110VAC models   101904 00 Fuse  250VAC  2 0 Amp  SlowBlow  for 220 240VAC models   101688 00 Ambient Temperature Connector with Thermistor  4121 Capillary 0 010 inch ID  4126 Capillary 0 020 inch ID       Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 5    Servicing          Cable List  Part Number Description  6556 Optical Filter Kit  Red Filter  Quartz Window  Rubber Washer   6998 DriRite    Cable List Table 7   2 describes the Model 427 Trace Level spare cables  See the     Troubleshooting    chapter for associated connection diagrams and board  connector pin descriptions     Table
42.  Outputs    System Description  1 0 Components    voltage range of OV to 1OVDC   Six current outputs are provided with a  normal operating range of 0 to 20 mA     The front panel connector board interfaces between the motherboard and  the front panel mounted function key panel and Graphics display  It serves  as central location to tie the three connectors required for the function key  panel  the graphics display control lines  and the graphics display backlight  to a single ribbon cable extending back to the motherboard  This board  also includes signal buffers for the graphics display control signals and a  high voltage power supply for the graphics display backlight     External I O is driven from a generic bus that is capable of controlling the  following devices     e Analog output  voltage and current   e Analog input  voltage    e Digital output  TTL levels    e Digital input  TTL levels     The instrument has spare solenoid valve drivers and I O support for future  expansion  5    Note The instrument has spare solenoid valve drivers and I O support for  future expansion  A    The instrument provides six analog voltage outputs  Each may be software  configured for any one of the following ranges  while maintaining a  minimum resolution of 12 bits     e 0 100mV  e 0 1V   e 0 5V   e 0 10V    The user can calibrate each analog output zero and span point through  firmware  At least 5  of full scale over and under range are also supported     The analog outputs may be assi
43.  The Gas Units screen defines how the NO  NO    and NO  concentration  readings are expressed  Gas units of parts per billion  ppb  and micrograms  per cubic meter  pg m   are available  The g m  gas concentration mode is  calculated using a standard pressure of 760 mmHg and a standard  temperature of 20   C     When switching from ppb to pg m     the analog ranges all default to the  highest range in that mode  For example  when switching from pg m  to  ppb  all the ranges default to 200 ppb  Therefore  whenever you change  units  you should also check the range settings     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Range  gt  Gas Units     Note If the units change from ppb to pg m  or vice versa  the instrument  should be re calibrated  particularly if the user   s standard temperature is  different from 20   C  A display warning will appear that ranges will be  defaulted and calibration parameters reset  A       The NO  NOs  and NO  Ranges screen defines the concentration range of  the analog outputs  For example  a NO   range of 0   50 ppb restricts the  NO  analog output to concentrations between 0 and 50 ppb     The display shows the current NO  NO   or NO  range  The next line of  the display is used to change the range  The range screen is similar for the  single  dual  and auto range modes  The only difference between the  screens are the words    High    or    Low    displayed to indicate which range is  displayed  The example below shows the NO range screen in single mode   For mo
44.  Thermo Fisher Scientific    Connector  Label    Reference  Designator    Pin    oOo co N wm wo    Troubleshooting  Connector Pin Descriptions    Signal Description    Ground  Ground  Spare Frequency Input  Ground    Ground       AC PUMP    PJ1         AC HOT  AC NEUT  AC Ground       FAN 1    PJ4     24V    Ground       FAN 2    PJ5     24V    Ground       AC IN    PJ6       AC HOT  AC NEUT  AC Ground       COOLER    AC TEMP    NO NOX SOL     PJ7    PJ8    PJ9    FP Wo N  gt          Cooler Thermistor   Ground    15V_PWR   Cooler On Off Control  AC HOT   AC NEUT   AC Ground    24V   NO NOX Solenoid Control       SAMPLE SOL     PJ10     24V    Sample Solenoid Control       Z S SOL      24V  Zero Span Solenoid Control       SPARE1 SOL      24V    Spare 1 Solenoid Control       SPARE2 SOL               24V  Spare 2 Solenoid Control       PERM OVEN  THERM    Thermo Fisher Scientific    PQJ1       Perm Oven Gas Thermistor    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 6 15    Troubleshooting  Connector Pin Descriptions       Connector Reference Pin Signal Description  Label Designator  2 Ground  PERM OVEN POJ3 1 Perm Oven Heater On Off  2  15V_PWR  3 Perm Oven Thermistor  4 Ground    Table 6   5  Front Panel Board Connector Pin Diagram    Connector Reference  Label Designator    MOTHER BOARD J1    6 16 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Pin    oOo co N oon A wo N  gt        a    oO              a    gt       co co N lop  ol A w N    N N N N N   gt e wo N   O    Signal Descr
45.  You should generate a new  calibration curve when zero and span checks indicate a shift in instrument  gain of more than 10 percent from that determined during the most recent  multipoint calibration  You can adjust the frequency of calibration and  even zero and span checks appropriately as you gain confidence with the  instrument     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Calibration  Zero and Span Check    You should have a quality control plan where the frequency and the  number of points required for calibration can be modified on the basis of  calibration and zero and span check data collected over a period of time   Note however  that the EPA requires a minimum of one multipoint  calibration per calendar quarter  Such a quality control program is essential  to ascertain the accuracy and reliability of the air quality data collected and  to alert the user if the accuracy or reliability of the data should become  unacceptable  A compilation of this kind might include items such as dates  of calibration  atmospheric conditions  calibration factors  and other  pertinent data     Use the following procedure to perform a zero and span check     1  Connect the zero gas to the SAMPLE bulkhead in a standard  instrument or to the ZERO bulkhead in a Model 427 Trace Level  equipped with the zero span and sample solenoid valve option     2  Allow the instrument to sample zero gas until a stable reading is  obtained on the NO  NO2  and NO  channels then record the 
46.  alarm  the status will go from    OK     to    FAIL     The number of alarms detected is displayed to indicate how  many alarms have occurred  If no alarms are detected  the number zero is    displayed     To see the actual reading of an item and its minimum and maximum    limits  move the cursor to the item and press  e     Items displayed are determined by the options installed  The zero span  check and auto calibration screens are visible only if the zero span check or  auto calibration options are enabled  The motherboard status  interface  board status  and I O Expansion board status  if installed  indicate that the  power supplies are working and connections are successful  There are no  setting screens for these alarms     e In the Main Menu  choose Alarms        Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 63    Operation  Alarms Menu       Internal Temperature The Internal Temperature screen displays the current internal temperature    Min and Max Internal  Temperature Limits    Chamber Temperature    3 64 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    and sets the minimum and maximum alarm limits  Acceptable alarm limits  range from 8 to 47   C  If the internal temperature reading goes beyond  either the minimum or maximum alarm limit  an alarm is activated  The  word    ALARM    appears in the Run screen and in the Main Menu     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Internal Temp        The Minimum Internal Temperature alarm limit screen is use
47.  an alarm is activated  The word     ALARM    appears in the Run screen and in the Main Menu     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Pressure        Min and Max Pressure The Minimum Pressure alarm limit screen is used to change the minimum    Limits temperature alarm limit  The minimum and maximum pressure screens  function the same way     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Pressure  gt  Min or Max        Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 67    Operation  Alarms Menu    Flow    Min and Max Flow Limits    Ozonator Flow    3 68 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    The Flow screen displays the current sample flow reading and sets the  minimum and maximum alarm limits  Acceptable alarm limits range from  0 to 2 LPM  If the sample flow reading goes beyond either the minimum  or maximum limit  an alarm is activated  The word    ALARM    appears in  the Run screen and in the Main Menu     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Flow        EH pieri  ETEO hed    Ehhe EE EE          The Minimum Flow alarm limit screen is used to change the minimum  sample flow alarm limit  The minimum and maximum flow screens  function the same way     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Flow  gt  Min or Max        Cu ied  Pa i       The Ozonator Flow screen  read only  is used to display the ozonator flow  readings  If the ozonator flow reading is 0 050 LPM  50 cc  or below  an  alarm is activated  and an alarm condition screen appears as    LOW     If t
48.  and the ozonator is  turned off  This is done to prevent the ozonator from overheating  which  will result in permanent damage to the ozonator  or if the converter  temperature drops below the minimum limit  which reduces the  effectiveness of the ozone destruct     It is possible  however  to override the ozonator shut off due to converter  temperature being out of range  by setting the ozonator safety    OFF    in the     Service Mode        Note The ozonator must be    ON    to obtain NO  NOz  and NO   readings  As an additional safety precaution  a lit LED mounted on the  measurement interface board indicates that the ozonator is on  A    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Ozonator        PMT Supply The PMT Supply screen is used to turn the PMT power supply on or off     This is useful in a troubleshooting situation     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  PMT Supply     3 26 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu       ERED CH  perm    WH mht  PS PHP ESE Pi AG Lf bi       Auto Manual Mode The Auto Manual Mode screen allows selection of the automatic mode   NO NO    NO mode  manual NO   NO  mode  manual NO   or  prereactor mode  manual prereact   The auto cycle mode switches the  mode solenoid valve automatically on a 10 second cycle so that NO  NOs   and NO  concentrations are determined  The manual NO mode puts the  mode solenoid valve into the open position so that the samp
49.  are visible only if the auto calibration option is  enabled and function the same way     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Zero or Span Autocal        rip gules  Piet          NO  NO2  and NOx The NO Concentration screen displays the current NO concentration and  Concentration sets the minimum and maximum alarm limits  Acceptable alarm limits   range from 0 to 200 ppb and 0 to 500 pg m     The minimum alarm may be  programmed as a floor trigger  alarm is triggered when the concentration  falls below the minimum value  or a ceiling trigger  alarm is triggered when  the concentration goes above the minimum value   If the NO  concentration goes beyond either the minimum or maximum limit  an  alarm is activated  The word    ALARM    appears in the Run screen and in  the Main Menu  The NO  and NO  concentration screens function the    same way   e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  NO  NO2  or NOx  Concentration        Min and Max NO  NO2  and NO  The Minimum NO Concentration alarm limit screen is used to change the  Concentration Limits minimum NO concentration alarm limits  The minimum and maximum  NO  NO   and NO  concentration alarm limit screens function the same  way     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Select Concentration  gt  Min or    Max     3 70 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Alarms Menu       Min Trigger The Minimum Trigger screen allows the user to view and set the NO   NOs  and NO  concentration alarm trig
50.  at an elevated pressure to allow accurate and  reproducible flow control and to aid in subsequent operations such as  drying  oxidation  and scrubbing  An air compressor that gives an output of  10 psig is usually sufficient for most applications     Several drying methods are available  Passing the compressed air through a  bed of silica gel  using a heatless air dryer  or removing water vapor with a  permeation dryer are three possible approaches     NO is usually oxidized to NO  in order to ease its scrubbing  Oxidation  can be accomplished by either ozonation or chemical contact  During  ozonation  the air is passed through an ozone generator  The O  that is  produced reacts with the NO to form NO gt   Care must be taken to allow  sufficient residence time for the ozonation reaction to go to completion     Chemical oxidation is accomplished by passing the air stream through a  reacting bed  Such agents as CrO  on an alumina support or Purafil   are  very efficient at oxidizing NO to NO2  The chemical contact approach has  the advantage of needing no electrical power input for its application     Fixed bed reactors are commonly used in the last step of zero air generation  to remove the remaining contaminants by either further reaction or  absorption  Table 4 1 lists materials that can be effective in removing  contaminants     Table 4 1  Scrubbing Materials          To Remove Use   NO  Soda Lime  6 12 mesh   Purafil  Hydrocarbons Molecular Sieve  4A   Activated Charcoal 
51.  auto calibrates high range NO coefficient B 26  cal high no2 coef Sets auto calibrates high range NO  coefficient B 26  cal high nox coef Sets auto calibrates high range NO  coefficient B 26  cal low no coef Sets auto calibrates low range NO coefficient B 26  cal low no2 coef Sets auto calibrates low range NO  coefficient B 26  cal low nox coef Sets auto calibrates low range NO  coefficient B 26  cal no bkg Sets auto calibrates NO background B 25  cal no coef Sets auto calibrates NO coefficient B 26  cal no2 coef Sets auto calibrates NO  coefficient B 26  cal nox bkg Sets auto calibrates NO  background B 25  cal nox coef Sets auto calibrates NO  coefficient B 26  cal pre bkg Sets auto calibrates prereactor background B 25  cal pres Sets current measured pressure as pressure during B 28  calibration  for pressure compensation   clr recs Clears away only long records that have been saved B 18  clr records Clears away all logging records that have been saved B 17  clr srecs Clears away only short records that have been saved B 18  contrast Reports sets current screen contrast B 34  conv set temp Reports sets temperature setpoint for NO   converter B 35  conv temp Reports current NO  converter temperature B 11  cooler temp Reports temperature of PMT cooler  same as PMT B 11  temperature    copy Irec to sp Sets copies current Irec selection into the scratch pad B 24  copy sp to Irec Sets copies current selections in scratch pad into Irec list B 24  copy sp to srec Sets copies cur
52.  averaging time  For more information about  calibration  see Chapter 4     Calibration        e Inthe Main Menu  choose Calibration  gt  Cal NO  NO2 or NOx  Coefficient     D Snood       Calibrate Pressure The Calibrate Pressure screen is used to set the calibration pressure     The Calibration pressure should be set only when calibrating the  instrument     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Calibration  gt  Calibrate Pressure        3 22 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Calibration Menu    Zero Span Check The Zero Span Check menu is available with the zero span valve option  when in NO or NO  measurement modes  It is used to program the  instrument to perform fully automated zero and span check or adjustments   Total Duration Hour is the sum of zero  span  and purge duration minutes   Zero and Span Calibration Reset are toggle items that change between yes  or no when selected  and displayed if auto calibration is installed     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Calibration  gt  Zero Span Check        Next Time The Next Time screen is used to view and set the next zero span check date  and time  Once the initial zero span check is performed  the date and time  of the next zero span check is calculated and displayed     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Calibration  gt  Zero Span Check  gt  Next  Time        Period Hours The Zero Span Period Hours screen defines the period or interval between  zero span checks  Periods between 0 and 999 hours are accept
53.  copy stream to sp   These commands copy the current contents of the long record  short  record  or streaming data list into the scratch pad  sp   These commands  are useful in easy modification of current long record  short record  or  streaming data lists  The example below copies the current list of long  records into the scratch pad     Send  set copy lrec to sp  Receive  set copy lrec to sp ok  sp field number    This command reports the variable number and name stored at index in the  scratch pad list  The example below shows that the field 5 in the scratch  pad is set to index number 13  which is for the variable pressure     Send  sp field 5  Receive  sp field 5 13 pres    set sp field number value   number   1 32 is the maximum number of fields in long and short record  lists    number   1 18 is for streaming data lists     This command sets the scratch pad field number  item number in scratch  pad list  to value  where value is the index number of a variable in the  analog out variable list  Available variables and their corresponding index  numbers may be obtained using the command    list var aout     The    set sp  field    command is used to create a list of variables which can then be  transferred into the long record  short record  or streaming data lists  using  the    set copy sp to lrec        set copy sp to srec     or    set copy sp to stream     commands     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Calibration    C Link Protocol Commands  
54.  cscs nstutainincncteicncteadoactece vonnct a  caeits 7 45  Flow Transducer Calibrationisii 03 ateeceineccianetiiaeidia eats 7 46  Front Panel Board Replacement ta  cso hee tear 7 48  LCD Module Replacement sit steak ceca Senet nate tue acess ute ss cccadteact Stes cau 7 49  Service Locations asie e ena e a aus E K EAEE SOES 7 50  System Description             ssssssssnnsssssssssnnnnnessnnnnnnnnnnounnunnnnneounnnnnnnnnennnnnnnnennnnnnnnnenns 8 1  Par Ware ies ai ied case lad tart eee T Ln date cle 8 1  NOwto NO Converter siisasstiisntect eann a a Gi cdaa exter R 8 2  Mode Solenoid snen dieas ana eseina a a EaI aisat 8 2  Reaction  Chambers  atun ainni ea iA RiEs E 8 2  Optical Filters aac sinnis anker Dp se iak Ea E ATE ENa ENEE iasa 8 3  Pressure Transducer vee u i en a nance e E ol oat E 8 3  Sample Plows Sensor nanessienig hirion aiat estate 8 3  OZOMAtO toe i i o aaia ata 8 3  Ozonator Flow Switch    eseseseseseseseessssesssssssssssssesessstesreeereererersesrersees 8 3  Photomultiplier Tube     ssssseeseeeeeeeeeseesesesssssssssssrsrsrsrsrseseseseseseseseses 8 3  Photomultiplier Tube Cooler      ssssssseseeeesesesesesrerersrsrsrsrsrsrsesrsesrsessrses 8 3  External Pumipi in aa ch AAR seth ceca 8 3  Sample Cap LET a aigen a e e e a a 8 3  Diy Ai Capillary onna eeaeee ata 1 Eaa Rea E aaRS 8 4  Software inhoa eRe aeie a ENa EAEE ENNET ao Ra ATARE NEESS 8 4  Tnstrament Controlisiiesto inace esinin eiiiai aT 8 4  Monitoring Signals      esseseeeeseseseseseseseseresrsrsesrststs
55.  flow through the system  If flow  is interrupted  even for a short period  a reconditioning time of up to 24  hours may be required     The Model 427 Trace Level analyzer has zero air diagnostic capability built  within the instrument  The monitor has three channels  a NO  Nos  and  prereactor channel  The prereactor channel mixes the sample with a high  concentration of ozone prior to the detection chamber  This effectively  creates a dynamic zero by removing any NO from the gas stream  If the  zero air source being used is truly a good zero air  the background signals in  the NO  Nox  and prereactor modes are virtually identical  within 0 1 to  0 2 ppb due to pneumatic differences   If the background in the no and or  No  channels are enhanced relative to the prereactor channel  the zero air  source being used is inadequate  When calibrating the zero in the Model  42i Trace Level  the background levels are calculated and available in the  Calibration Factors menu  Normal background levels are in the 0 5 to 1 5    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Standards for Trace Level Analyzers  Geysitech Commands    ppb range  primarily due to the dark current of the photomultiplier tube   note due to impurities in the zero gas source     In conclusion  tests by the United States Environmental Agency  Tennessee  Valley Authority  Battelle National Labs  and THERMO FISHER  SCIENTIFIC   s Engineering Department have demonstrated that Trace  Level analyzers are readily calibrated at the low co
56.  following pre calibration procedure before calibrating the  Model 427 Trace Level  For detailed information about the menu  parameters and the icons used in these procedures  see the    Operation     chapter     Note The calibration and calibration check duration times should be long  enough to account for the transition  purge  process when switching from  sample to zero and from zero to span  This transition time is the time  required to purge the existing air  A    Depending on the plumbing configuration and the instrument  data from  approximately the first minute of a zero calibration or check should be  disregarded because of residual sample air  Also  data from approximately  the first minute of a span calibration or check should be disregarded  because the span is mixing with the residual zero air  A    1  Allow the instrument to warm up and stabilize     2  Be sure the ozonator is ON  If the ozonator is not ON     a  Press       to display the Main Menu  then choose Instrument  Controls  gt  Ozonator     b  Press to toggle the ozonator ON   c  Press   gt    to return to the Run screen     3  Be sure the instrument is in the auto mode  that is  NO  NO   and  NO  measurements are being displayed on the front panel display  If  the instrument is not in auto mode     a  Press     to display the Main Menu  then choose Instrument  Controls  gt  Auto Manual Mode     b  Select NO NO   and press        c  Press   gt   to return to the Run screen     4  Select NO  NO2  and NO
57.  for pins 1 25 are for 25 pin cables  color codes for  pins 1 37 are for 37 pin cables  A    Table 9 1  Cable Options             Description Cable Length  DB37M to open end Six feet  DB37F to open end Six feet  DB25M to open end Six feet  RS 232    Table 9 2  Color Codes for 25 Pin and 37 Pin Cables                                  Pin Color Pin Color   1 BLACK 20 RED BLACK   2 BROWN 21 ORANGE BLACK   3 RED 22 YELLOW BLACK   4 ORANGE 23 GREEN BLACK   5 YELLOW 24 GRAY BLACK   6 GREEN 25 PINK BLACK   7 BLUE End color codes for 25 pin cables  continue for 37 pin cables    8 VIOLET 26 PINK GREEN   9 GRAY 27 PIND RED   19 WHITE 28 PINK VIOLET   11 PINK 29 LIGHT BLUE       Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual 9 3    Optional Equipment  Mounting Options                         Pin Color Pin Color   12 LIGHT GREEN 30 LIGHT BLUE BROWN  13 BLACK WHITE 31 LIGHT BLUE RED   14 BROWN WHITE 32 LIGHT BLUE VIOLET  15 RED WHITE 33 LIGHT BLUE BLACK  16 ORANGE WHITE GRAY GREEN   17 GREEN WHITE GRAY RED   18 BLUE WHITE GRAY VIOLET   19 VIOLET WHITE LIGHT GREEN BLACK          Mounting Options The analyzer can be installed in the configuration described in Table 9 3  and shown in Figure 9 2 through Figure 9 5     Table 9 3  Mounting Options    Mounting Type Description    Bench Positioned on bench  includes mounting feet  and front panel  side trim handles     EIA rack Mounted in an ElA style rack  includes mounting slides  and front  panel ElA rack mounting handles     Retrofit rack Mounted i
58.  from 0 255 inclusive  separated by             Send  set addr dns 192 168 1 1   Receive  set addr dns 192 168 1 1 ok   addr gw   This command reports the default TCP IP gateway address   Send  addr gw   Receive  addr gw 192 168 1 1   set addr gw address    This command sets the default gateway address  where address consists of    four numbers ranging from 0 255 inclusive  separated by             Send  set addr gw 192 168 1 1   Receive  set addr gw 192 168 1 1 ok   addr ip   This command reports the IP address of the analyzer   Send  addr ip   Receive  addr ip 192 168 1 15   set addr ip address    This command sets the analyzer   s IP address  where address consists of four       9    numbers ranging from 0 255 inclusive  separated by             Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Communications Configuration    Send  set addr ip 192 168 1 15  Receive  set addr ip 192 168 1 15 ok  addr nm   This command reports the IP netmask   Send  addr nm   Receive  addr nm 255 255 255 0    set addr nm address  This command sets the nm address  where address consists of four numbers      lt a gt      ranging from 0 255 inclusive  separated by             Send  set addr nm 255 255 255 0  Receive  set addr nm 255 255 255 0 ok  baud    This command reports the current baud rate for the serial port   RS232 RS485   The example below reports that the current baud rate is  9600 baud     Send  baud  Receive  baud 9600    set baud rate    rate     12
59.  in the single  dual  and  auto range modes  The following averaging times are available  10  20  30   60  90  120  180  240  and 300 seconds  Additional averaging times are  available in NO and NO  mode  see    Auto Manual Mode    later in this  chapter     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Averaging Time        DH pikor  Eii ERE i    eal          Calibration factors are used to correct the NO  NO   and NOx  concentrations readings that the instrument generates using its own  internal calibration data  The Calibration Factors menu displays the  calibration factors  The screens below show the calibration factors menu in  single mode and dual auto range modes  The only difference between the  screens are the words    HI    and    LO    to indicate which range is displayed     Normally  the instrument is calibrated automatically using the Calibration  menu described in    Calibration Menu    later in this chapter  However  the  instrument can also be calibrated manually using the Calibration Factors  menu     To manually calibrate the instrument  see    NO  NOx  and Prereactor  Backgrounds        NO  NO2  and NOx Coefficients    and    Calibration    Pressure    below for more information     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Calibration Factors     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Calibration Factors Menu       NO  NO   and Prereactor    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Backgrounds    The NO  NO  and Prereactor background corrections are determined  during zero calibration  The NO background
60.  inch  Wrench  9 16 inch  Nut driver  1 4 inch  Philips screwdriver    Wire cutters    amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap    f Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small    must be worn while handling any internal component  A    1  Refer to    Removing the Measurement Bench and Lowering the  Partition Panel    in this chapter to lower the partition panel  then  proceed to the next step below     2  Disconnect the reaction chamber connector from the temperature  control board     3  Snap off the temperature control board from the board mounts     4  Remove the four screws securing the cooler shroud to the rear panel  and remove the shroud     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 15    Servicing    PMT Cooler and Reaction Chamber Assembly Replacement    7 16 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual                  Temperature Control Board    Cooler Shroud    Reaction Chamber    To COOLER on Measurement  Interface Board      To BENCH on  Temp  Control Board    Captive Screws  4      Two Not Shown  To PMT HVPS    BNC Connector to Input Board    Figure 7   7  PMT Cooler and Reaction Chamber  5  Disconnect plumbing connections from the reaction chamber     6  Disconnect the cables from the PMT high voltage power supply  the  input board  and the measurement interface board  Remove all tie   wraps securing the cables     7  Loosen four captive screws holding cooler to floor plate and remo
61.  instant  For details on how to interpret  the status bytes refer to Table D 1 and Table D 2 below      lt SFKT gt   is the space provided for future use for special function  it  currently contains a string of ten 0   s i e   lt 0000000000 gt      Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual D 5    Geysitech  Bayern Hessen  Protocol  Geysitech Commands    Measurements reported in  response to DA command    Single Range Mode    Dual Auto Range Mode    D 6 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    Example     Geysitech Protocol with transmission of three concentrations  Instrument  ID is 1  Operation Status is 03  Error Status is 04      Data Query String   lt STX gt DA lt CR gt     Reply String    lt STX gt MDO3 lt SP gt 001 lt SP gt  2578 01 lt SP gt 03  lt SP gt 04 lt SP gt 0000000000  lt SP gt 002  lt SP gt   t T T  Address First Concentration E format  25 78 Address 1     5681 00 lt SP gt 03 lt SP gt 04 lt SP gt 0000000000 lt SP gt 003 lt SP gt  1175 01 lt SP gt 03 lt SP gt 04 lt SP    T t T  Second Concentration   5 681 Address 2 Third Concentration 11 75  0000000000 lt SP gt  lt CR gt     The attached concentrations are in the selected gas units  The  measurements that are attached to the response if not valid in a particular  mode then a value of 0 0 will be reported     The following measurements reported in response to DA command are for  the Model 427 Trace Level     The 4 measurements reported in single range mode include     e NO    e NO   e NO   e PRE    The 8 meas
62.  is terminated with  lt CR gt  and if the command was terminated  with a  lt ETX gt  lt BCC gt  the response is terminated with lt ETX gt  and the  computed checksum  lt BCC gt      The 02 after the MD indicates  that two measurements are present in the  reply string   a 03 for three measurements and so on  this will also  determine the length of the reply string       lt address gt  is the Instrument Address  Each subsequent measurement  attached to the response will have the  lt address   X gt  where X keeps  incrementing by 1 for each measurement included      lt measured value gt  is the concentration value in currently selected gas units  represented as exponential representation with 4 characters mantissa and 2  characters exponent  each with sign     Mantissa  sign and 4 digits  The decimal point is assumed to be after the  first digit and is not transmitted     Exponent  sign and 2 digits    Example     5384000 0 is represented as  5384 06   0 04567 is represented as  4567 02     lt status gt   is formed by  lt  operating status  gt  and  lt  error status  gt  and  separated by a space i e      lt operating status gt  lt SP gt  lt error status gt     Each of the two   lt operating status gt  and  lt error status gt   are formed by two  characters each representing a 2 digit hex number which is one byte  8 Bits   operation status and one byte  8 Bits  error status     These two bytes contain the information about the main operating  conditions of the instrument at that
63.  is the amount of signal read  by the analyzer in the NO channel while sampling zero air  The NOx  background is the amount of signal read by the analyzer in the NO   channel while sampling zero air  The Prereactor background is the amount  of signal read by the analyzer when the sample is routed through the  prereactor  The background signal is the combination of electrical offsets     PMT dark currents  and trace substances undergoing chemiluminescence   Before the analyzer sets the NO  NO  and Prereactor readings to zero  it  stores these values as the NO  NO   and Prereactor background corrections   respectively  The NO  background correction is determined from the NO  and NO  background corrections and is not displayed  The background  corrections are typically below 1 5 ppb     The NO  NO  and Prereactor Background screens are used to perform a  manual zero calibration of the instrument  Before performing a zero  calibration  allow the analyzer to sample zero air until stable readings are  obtained  The NO channel should be calibrated first  The NO  NO   and  Prereactor Background screens operate the same way  Therefore  the  following description of the NO background applies to the NO  and  Prereactor background screens as well  The first line of the display shows  the current NO reading  The second line of the display shows the NO  background correction that is stored in memory  The NO background  correction is a value  expressed in the current gas units  that is subt
64.  min value   set alarm pressure max value   These commands set the pressure alarm minimum and maximum values to  value  where value is a floating point number representing pressure alarm  limits in millimeters of mercury  The example below sets the pressure alarm  maximum value to 215 mmHg     Send  set alarm pressure max 215  Receive  set alarm pressure max 215 ok    alarm sample flow min   alarm sample flow max   These commands report the sample flow alarm minimum and maximum  value current settings  The example below reports that the sample flow  alarm minimum value is 0 300 LPM     Send  alarm sample flow min  Receive  alarm sample flow min 0 3 1 min    set alarm sample flow min value   set alarm sample flow max value   These commands set the sample flow alarm minimum and maximum  values to value  where value is a floating point number representing sample  flow alarm limits in liters per minute  The example below sets the sample  flow alarm maximum value to 2 LPM     Send  set alarm sample flow max 2  Receive  set alarm sample flow max 2 ok    alarm trig conc no   alarm trig conc no2   alarm trig conc nox   alarm trig conc pre   This command reports the NO  NO  NO  and prereactor concentration  alarm trigger action for minimum alarm  current setting  to either floor or  ceiling  The example below shows the NO concentration minimum alarm  trigger to ceiling  according to Table B   3     Send  alarm trig conc no  Receive  alarm trig conc no 1    set alarm trig conc no value
65.  number variable name active state  The active  state for digital outputs is open or closed  The active state for digital inputs    is high or low   Send  list dout  Receive  list dout    output index variable state  1 35 CONC ALARM open   3 4 UNITS open   4 11 GEN ALARM closed   7 7 NO MODE open   8 8 NOX MODE open    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Datalogging    list Irec   list srec   list stream   list sp   These commands report the list of current selections for long record  logging data  short record logging data  streaming data output  or the  scratch pad  sp  list  The example below shows the list for streaming data  output        Send  list stream  Receive  list stream  field index variable  x x time  11 no  2 2 no2  3 3 nox  4 18 intt  5 25 pres  6 26 smplf  er xy  Ir xy  sr xy  x  0 1         Reply termination format  see    set format format     command     y  0 1  2     Output format  see    set erec lrec srec format format     command     These commands report the last long and short records stored or the  dynamic data record  In the example below  the command requests a long  record with no checksum  in ASCII format with text  For details on how to  decode the flag fields within these records  see the    flags    command     Send  lro1   Receive  lro1  12 31 02 22 03 flags 54089100 no  8413E 1 nox  8485E 1  lono  6471E 1 lonox  6527E 1 pres 130 9 pmtt 53 2 intt  80 0 rctt 80 0 convt 61 smplf 0 500 ozonf 0 000 p
66.  over Ethernet     The MODBUS Commands that are implemented are explained in detail in  this document  The MODBUS protocol support for the iSeries enables the  user to perform the functions of reading the various concentrations and  other analog values or variables  read the status of the digital outputs of the  analyzer  and to trigger or simulate the activation of a digital input to the  instrument  This is achieved by using the supported MODBUS commands  listed below     For details of the Model 42i Trace Level MODBUS Protocol specification   see the following topics     e    Serial Communication Parameters    on page C 1  e    TCP Communication Parameters    on page C 2  e    Application Data Unit Definition    on page C 2  e    Function Codes    on page C 3   e    MODBUS Parameters Supported    on page C 8    Additional information on the MODBUS protocol can be obtained at  http   www modbus org  References are from MODBUS Application  Protocol Specification V1 1a MODBUS IDA June 4  2004        The following are the communication parameters that are used to configure    the serial port of the iSeries to support MODBUS RTU protocol     Number of Data bits  8   Number of Stop bits 1   Parity   None   Data rate   from 1200 115200 Baud  9600 is default     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual C 1    MODBUS Protocol  TCP Communication Parameters    TCP Communication  Parameters    Application Data  Unit Definition    Slave Address    MBAP Header    C 2 Model 42  Trace Lev
67.  over TCP IP because the  higher level protocols include device addressing  The unit identifier is not  used by the instrument     The function code is a single byte in length  The following function codes  are supported by the instrument     Read Coils   0x01  Read Inputs 0x02  Read Holding Registers 0x03  Read Input Registers 0x04  Force  Write  Single Coil 0x05   0x06    Read Exception Status    If a function code is received that is not in this list  an invalid function  exception is returned     The data field varies depending on the function  For more description of  these data fields  see    Function Codes    below     In MODBUS over Serial an error check is included in the message  This is  not necessary in MODBUS over TCP IP because the higher level protocols  ensure error free transmission  The error check is a two byte  16 bit  CRC  value     This section describes the various function codes that are supported by the  Model 42i Trace Level     Read Coils   Inputs read the status of the digital outputs  relays  in the  instrument  Issuing either of these function codes will generate the same  response     These requests specify the starting address  i e  the address of the first  output specified  and the number of outputs  The outputs are addressed  starting at zero  Therefore  outputs numbered 1   16 are addressed as 0 15     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual C 3    MODBUS Protocol  Function Codes    C 4 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    The outpu
68.  pressure is the actual pressure reading being  measured  If pressure compensation is on  then both pressure readings are  the same  If pressure compensation is off  a pressure of 300 mmHg is used  as default pressure even though the actual pressure is 306 3 mmHg  The  example below shows that the actual reaction chamber pressure is 306 3  mmHg     Send  pres  Receive  pres 753 4 mm Hg  actual 306 6  react temp    This command reports the current reaction chamber temperature  The  example below reports that the current reaction temperature is 49 0   C     Send  react temp  Receive  react temp 49 0 deg C  flags    This reports 8 hexadecimal digits  or flags  that represent the status of the  ozonator  PMT  pressure and temperature compensation status  gas units   gas mode  and alarms  To decode the flags  each hexadecimal digit is  converted to binary as shown in the Figure B   1  It is the binary digits that  define the status of each parameter  In the example below  the instrument is  reporting that the ozonator and PMT are both on  and that the instrument  is in the span gas mode     Send  flags  Receive  flags 80028000    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Alarms    Il                Figure B 14  Flags    Alarm alarm chamber temp min  arms  alarm chamber temp max  These commands report the chamber temperature alarm minimum and  maximum value current settings  The example below reports that the  chamber temperature alarm minimum value is 47 0   C     Send
69.  screen  For  more information about selecting ranges  see    NO  NO2  and NOx  Ranges    above     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Range  gt  Set Custom Ranges  gt  Custom  range 1  2  or 3        The Averaging Time defines a time period  10 to 300 seconds  over which  NO  NOsz  and NO  measurements are taken  The average concentration of  the NO  NOs  and NO  readings are calculated for that time period  The  front panel display and analog outputs are updated every 10 seconds for  averaging times between 10 and 300 seconds  An averaging time of 10  seconds  for example  means that the average concentration of the last 10  seconds will be output at each update  An averaging time of 300 seconds  means that the moving average concentration of the last 300 seconds will  be output at each update  Therefore  the lower the averaging time the faster  the front panel display and analog outputs respond to concentration  changes  Longer averaging times are typically used to smooth output data     The Averaging Time screen for the single range mode is shown below  In  the dual and auto range modes  an Averaging Time Menu is displayed  before the averaging time screens  This additional menu is needed because    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 15    Operation  Calibration Factors Menu    Calibration Factors  Menu    3 16 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    the dual and auto range modes have two averaging times  high and low    The Averaging Time screen functions the same way
70.  set cal no bkg    will be    can   t  wrong settings     The example below shows a  successful auto calibration of the NO background     Send  set cal no bkg  Receive  set cal no bkg ok    set cal no coef   set cal no2 coef   set cal nox coef   set cal high no coef   set cal high no2 coef   set cal high nox coef   set cal low no coef   set cal low no2 coef   set cal low nox coef   These commands will auto calibrate NO  NO   and NO  coefficients based  on NO  NO   and NO  span gas concentrations  The high and low  commands are only available in dual and auto range mode  If the mode is  incorrect  the instrument responds with    can   t  wrong settings     The  example below shows a successful auto calibration of the low NO  coefficient     Send  set cal low no coef  Receive  set cal low no coef ok    no coef   no2 coef   nox coef   high no coef   high no2 coef   high nox coef   low no coef   low no2 coef   low nox coef   These commands report NO  NO   and NO  coefficients in single range  mode  or the high and low range coefficients in dual or auto range mode  If  the mode is incorrect  the instrument responds with    can   t  wrong  settings     The example below reports that the NO coefficient is 1 000     Send  no coef  Receive  no coef 1 000    set no coef value   set no2 coef value   set nox coef value   set high no coef value  set high no2 coef value    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Calibration    set high nox coef val
71.  sets high range NO  span gas concentration B 27  high nox Reports NO  concentration calculated with high range B 10  coefficients  high nox coef Reports sets high range NO  coefficients B 26  high nox gas Reports sets high range NO  span gas concentration B 27  high pre Reports prereactor concentration calculated with high range B 10  coefficients  high range no Reports selects current NO high range B 31  high range no2 Reports selects current NO  high range B 31  high range nox Reports selects current NO  high range B 31  host name Reports sets host name string B 40  instr name Reports instrument name B 40  instrument id Reports sets instrument id B 40  internal temp Reports current internal instrument temperature B 11  isc  iscreen  Retrieves framebuffer data used for the display B 29  layout ack Disables stale layout layout changed indicator           B 41  le  left  Simulates pressing left pushbutton B 29  list din Lists current selection for digital input B 18  list dout Lists current selection for digital output B 18  list Irec Lists current selection Irec logging data B 19  list sp Lists current selection in the scratchpad list B 19  list srec Lists current selection srec logging data B 19  list stream Lists current selection streaming data output B 19  list var aout Reports list of analog output  index numbers  and variables B 45  list var din Reports list of digital input  index numbers  and variables B 45  list var dout Reports list of digital output  index numbers
72.  tana darted sae B 49  Selection bap lesa R neanue ds bat daaca a Aai B 49  Button  Desienatot sneis e B 49  Examples aniier indians artaciepa twa pda S B 50  MODBUS Protocols eee einen ae C 1  Serial Communication Parameters             0sccssessscsssssssssscssetecssssecsseeees C 1  TCP Communication Parameters            cccsessccscececeeeessssceececeesesenseaees C 2  Application Data Unit Demir ante 23 cocecdatcaiies ence taecsehtajscacelesed ceeaes C 2  Slave Address   amuse snc sadoetds E EAEE E EE E E E EEES C 2  Ay BFE Eales  se  c  cl cee RRR CRED DEPT RAE APE RARER aa COREE RR PDR PS RE C 2  PUICUON COC Gini Ades So iehtag tsb aaNet A Stole  C 3  Daitaivecatevcecetseigevesiets dost ees totes getec ces E N EE E E T C 3  POC ke yei ae wuyct ania a aati N antes tte ese C 3  F  nction Codeseira ienien cree natura n a aaa C 3   0x01 0x02  Read Coils   Read Inputs     wi taacercie econ eeces C 3   0x03 0x04  Read Holding Registers   Read Input Registers            C 5   0x05  Force  Write  Single Coil wcsissis   decsatelcasetedecgucaherdelonieebvanlees C 7  MODBUS Parameters Supported so c dcecatesciedie dewnieadishees C 8  Geysitech  Bayern Hessen  Protocol               ssssssssesseceeseeseessesseseeseeneenees D 1  Serial Communication Parameters visi  csssacsevndsnieneiadelascterdsincs D 1  TCP Communication Parameters            cccsessccscecececeesssscceseceesssenseaees D 2  Instrument Address      ssesssseseeesseeeseeesereseesriessrreesersstessressrreseresesersseese 
73.  temporary list of items for  the selected record type that must be committed via the datalogging menu  before the changes will apply  Note that committing any changes to this list  will erase all currently logged data  as the format of the stored data is  changed     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Datalogging Settings   gt  Select Content     3 30 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu       aa pe  a i    T      i   i    ai CIES Ed  he EEE NEE       Concentrations The Concentrations screen allows the user to select the output signal that is  tied to the selected field item  The selected item is shown by     lt       after it   Note that at this point  pressing indicates that these are proposed  changes as opposed to implemented changes  To change the selected record  format and erase record log file data  see    Commit Content    below  Range   NO   is visible only in auto range mode     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Datalogging Settings   gt  Select Content  gt  Select Field  gt  Concentrations        RCRUSE Ci  Bs EEE TE ueet Bone ie          Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 31    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu       Other Measurements The Other Measurements screen allows the user to select the output signal  that is tied to the selected field item  The selected item is shown by     lt        after it  Items displayed are det
74.  the ST command     lt STX gt ST lt address gt  lt control command gt  lt ETX gt  lt BCC gt    OR    lt STX gt ST lt address gt  lt control command gt  lt CR gt    OR    lt STX gt ST lt address gt  lt SP gt  lt control command gt  lt CR gt    OR    lt STX gt ST lt address gt  lt SP gt  lt control command gt  lt ETX gt  lt BCC gt     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual D 3    Geysitech  Bayern Hessen  Protocol  Geysitech Commands    The  lt address gt  is optional  which means it can be left out completely  The   lt address gt  if present must match the Instrument Address  Additional space  can be present after the  lt address gt      If the received command does not satisfy the above formats or if the   lt address gt  does not match the Instrument Address the command is ignored     This is a sample command to switch the instrument to zero mode   instrument id 5      lt STX gt STO05 lt SP gt N lt CR gt     Data Sampling Data This command DA initiates a data transfer from the instrument  The  Query Command instrument responds with measurement data  which depends on the range  DA  mode and is listed in    Measurements reported in response to DA    command    below     The command structure for a data query command is as follows    lt STX gt DA lt address gt  lt ETX gt  lt BCC gt     The  lt address gt  is optional  which means it can be left out completely  The   lt address gt  if present must match the Instrument Address  Additional space  can be present after the  lt addr
75.  the coaxial cable with BNC connector and the ribbon  cable     3  Loosen the two screws holding the assembly bracket to the floor plate   move the assembly towards the rear  and lift the assembly off the  screws     4  Loosen the two screws holding the input box to the assembly bracket  and lift the input box off the screws     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 27    Servicing  Input Board Calibration          Input Box  Assembly Bracket Screws  2     Figure 7   14  Replacing the Input Board    5  Remove the four screws holding the input board to the input box and  remove the input board     6  Install the input board by following the previous steps in reverse     7  Re install the measurement bench  Refer to    Removing the  Measurement Bench and Lowering the Partition Panel    in this chapter     8  Perform an input board calibration  See the    Input Board Calibration     procedure that follows     Input Board Afer replacing the input board  use the following procedure to calibrate the  Calibration 1P  o t    service representatives  A    f WARNING The service procedures in this manual are restricted to qualified    1  From the Main Menu  press  _   to scroll to Service  gt  press       gt   to scroll to Input Board Calibration  gt  and press        The Input Board Calibration screen appears     7 23 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    DC Power Supply  Replacement    Thermo Fisher Scientific    A    Servicing  DC Power Supply Repl
76.  third element of the data response  and interpreted  as a string       NO 18sBd ddd set no coef  s n     This is a line which also appears slightly indented  The next field is also   NO   but the value is taken from the eighteenth element of the data  response  again interpreted as a string  A button appears on this line which   when pressed  pops up an input dialog which will state  Please enter a new  value for NO using a d ddd format   The string entered by the user is used  to construct the output command  If the user enters  for example   1 234    the constructed command will be  set no coef 1 234        NO 21f Code_0 Code 1 Code 2 Code 3 Code 4 Code 5 Code 6  Code_7 Code _8 Code_9 Code_10 Code 11 Lset range no  d n     This is a line which appears slightly indented  the title is again  NO   and  the value the twenty first element of the data response  interpreted as a  floating point number  There is a no translation button which creates a  selection list of twelve  Code nn  options  The number of the user  selection is used to create the output command     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Record Layout Definition     Mode 6 12 13x local remote service service  0 1 Tset mode   s n     This is a line which has a title of  Mode   and value taken from the sixth  field of the data response  There is a bitfield extraction of bits 12 through  13 from the source  the value type is not important here because the value  is being 
77.  to Service  gt  press       gt     to scroll to Temperature Calibration  gt  and press         The Calibrate Ambient Temperature screen appears     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 39    Servicing  Fuse Replacement    Note If Service Mode is not displayed  refer to    Accessing the Service  Mode    on page 7 4  then return to the beginning of this step  A    4  Wait at least 10 seconds for the ambient reading to stabilize  use  e    gt    Jand   t     to enter the known temperature  and    press to save the temperature value     5  Install the cover     Fuse Replacement Use the following procedure to replace the fuse   Equipment Required   Replacement fuses   250VAC  4 Amp  SlowBlow  for 100VAC and 110VAC models   250VAC  2 Amp  SlowBlow  for 220 240VAC models     1  Turn instrument OFF and unplug the power cord   2  Remove fuse drawer  located on the AC power connector   3  Ifeither fuse is blown  replace both fuses     4  Insert fuse drawer and reconnect power cord     Scrubber Use the following procedure to replace the ammonia scrubber  Figure 7       Replacement       Equipment Required     Ammonia scrubber    Nut driver  3 16 inch    amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap    f Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small    must be worn while handling any internal component  A  1  Turn instrument OFF  unplug the power cord  and remove the cover     2  Unscrew the Teflon tubing at 
78. 00   2400   4800   9600   19200   38400   57600   115200      This command sets the instrument baud rate  The example below sets the  instrument   s baud rate to 9600     Note After the command is sent  the baud rate of the sending device must  be changed to agree with the instrument  A    Send  set baud 9600  Receive  set baud 9600 ok  dhcp    This command reports the current state of use of DHCP on or off  DHCP  is used to assign an IP address to the analyzer automatically  The example  below shows that DHCP is on     Send  dhcp  Receive  dhcp on  set dhcp onoff    These commands enables and disables the DHCP service by either on or  off  Changes to this parameter will only take effect when the analyzer is  powered up  The example below sets the DHCP service on     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 39    C Link Protocol Commands  Communications Configuration    B 40 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Note When DHCP is set to on  the user supplied addr gw  addr dns  addr    ip  and addr nm parameters are not used  A    Send  set dhcp on  Receive  set dhcp on ok  format    This command reports the current reply termination format  The example  below shows that the reply format is 00  which means reply with no  checksum  according to Table B 8     Send  format  Receive  format 00    set format format   This command sets the reply termination format  where format is set  according to Table B   8  The example below sets the reply termination  format to checksum
79. 10 seconds for the zero reading to stabilize  then press  to save the zero pressure value     6  Disconnect the pump from the pressure transducer     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 37    Servicing  Temperature Control Board Replacement    7  Press       to return to the Pressure Sensor Cal menu     8  At the Pressure Sensor Cal menu  press         to select Span     The Calibrate Pressure Span screen appears     9  Wait at least 10 seconds for the ambient reading to stabilize  use   e    gt  Jand    i    to enter the known barometric pressure   and press     to save the pressure value           10  Reconnect the instrument tubing to the pressure transducer     11  Install the cover     Tem pe rature Control Use the following procedure to replace the temperature control board    Board Replacement 08 77  Equipment Required     Temperature control board    Small flat blade screwdriver    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component   amp     1  Turn instrument OFF  unplug the power cord  and remove the cover     2  Disconnect all connectors from the temperature control board  Use a  small flat blade screwdriver to loosen the two screws securing the  CONV TC cable  Note that the red wire is towards the rear and the    yellow wire is towards the front   3  Snap off the board from the board mounts     4  To install the tempe
80. 12 Signal Ground       Note All channels are user definable  If any customization has been made  to the analog output configuration  the default selections my not apply  A    Dual Range Mode In the dual range mode  there are two independent analog outputs  These  are labeled simply as the    High Range    and the    Low Range     Each  channel has its own analog output range  averaging time  and span  coefficient     This enables the sample concentration reading to be sent to the analog  outputs at two different ranges  For example  the low NO analog output  can be set to output concentrations from 0 to 50 ppb and the high NO  analog output set to output concentrations from 0 to 100 ppb     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 9    Operation  Range Menu    In addition to each channel having two ranges  each channel has two span  coefficients  There are two span coefficients so that each range can be  calibrated separately  This is necessary if the two ranges are not close to one  another  For example  the low NO range is set to 0   50 ppb and the high    NO range is set to 0 200 ppb     By default  in the dual range mode  the analog outputs are arranged on the  rear panel connector as shown in Figure 3   5  See Table 3   3 for channels  and pin connections  Dual range mode may be selected from the    Range    Mode Select    on page 3 74                      oTololeTololelelelelelolelolelololo   lelolololololelolelolelelelelelelels               
81. 32st  Alcea lei ty cadenesnsede oes 3 16  NO  NO  and Prereactor Backgrounds 3  02 jce scien sea 3 17  NO  NO   and NO  Coeticients   702 s2  occctesaec bal escpctde Meese meee  3 18  Calibration Pressures   12   scictpecstitasiiaeeerthaviintanitinttaaeeiy 3 19  Reset User Calibration D  efilt  acinnd  oa Gael otto 3 20  Calibration Menun eedan aanse ance lta anda eaa a 3 20   Calibrate NO  NO  and Prereactor Backgrounds      sseeeeeeeeeeeeeeee 3 21    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual v    Contents    Calibrate NO  NO   or NO  Coefficients          ccccecececccecececececececeees 3 22  KCAL Rate P le seule ssed snide celeste T AEEA 3 22  Zero S Pat  Check otica iea iieiea Eia ost 3 23  NE Aa KE T E A ating dates A E T 3 23  PeriGd  m KSET ETE SAE EE EEE E E EEN EEE EE 3 23  Zero Span Purge Duration Minutes   ssssssssesersseeresrrersreeresrsreees 3 24  Zero Span Averaging Time  seesesseeesesrsresresrrerssrsrrsreserreseerrssrsreees 3 24  Zero S pan Rati  eii eitie aea niise iis ES iain 3 25  Instrument Controls Menu      ssssesssseesresseresreesrrereressreesseessreerreesreessees 3 25  OZOMALOE i vp E AA E AEE EE E E T E A E SS 3 26  PME Suppen pene Pere etree e A R a a has 3 26  Auto Manual Mode siscasedtncccitetsardtidea tianlian deur 3 27  Da  talopging Settings ninen caudate lata  cect clase dee Daas 3 27  Select SRECHL REG mitta a a dati aiwnas 3 28  View Logged  Dataaratin ii een aia E A ER 3 28  Number of Records       sseeeseeeseeeseeesreessreesseresersseeesressrr
82. 4  Receive  set date 12 01 04 ok    set default params  This command sets all the parameters to their default values  This does not  affect the factory calibrated parameters     Send  set default params  Receive  set default params ok  ozonator    This command reports the ozonator is on or off  The example below  reports that the ozonator is on     Send  ozonator  Receive  ozonator on    set ozonator onoff  These commands set the ozonator on or off  The example below sets the  ozonator off     Send  set ozonator off  Receive  set ozonator off ok    ozonator flow  This command reports the current ozonator flow  The example below  reports that the current ozonator flow is 0 010 LPM     Send  ozonator flow  Receive  ozonator flow 0 050 l m    ozonator safety  This command reports the status of the ozonator safety on or off  The  example below reports that the ozonator safety is on     Send  ozonator safety  Receive  ozonator safety on    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Hardware Configuration    set ozonator safety onoff  These commands set the ozonator safety on or off  The example below sets  the ozonator safety off     Send  set ozonator safety off  Receive  set ozonator safety off ok    ozonator status  This command reports the status of the ozonator and safety  The example  below reports that the ozonator is off     Send  ozonator status  Receive  ozonator status off  pmt status    This command reports the status of the PMT o
83. 44  channel   en  enter  Simulates pressing enter pushbutton B 29   er Returns a brief description of the main operating conditions B 19  in the format specified in the commands   erec Returns a brief description of the main operating conditions B 19  in the format specified in the command   erec format Reports sets erec format  ASCII or binary  B 21   erec layout Reports current layout of erec data B 22   flags Reports 8 hexadecimal digits  or flags  that represent the B 12  status of the ozonator  PMT  gas mode  and alarms   flow Reports current measured sample flow in LPM B 11   format Reports sets current reply termination format B 40   gas mode Reports current mode of sample  zero  or span B 32   gas unit Reports sets current gas units B 33   he  help  Simulates pressing help pushbutton B 29   high avg time Reports sets high range averaging time B 9    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 5    C Link Protocol Commands  Accessing Streaming Data    B 6 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual                                                                                        Command Description Page  high no Reports NO concentration calculated with high range B 10  coefficients  high no coef Reports sets high range NO coefficients B 26  high no gas Reports sets high range NO span gas concentration B 27  high no2 Reports NO  concentration calculated with high range B 10  coefficients  high no2 coef Reports sets high range NO  coefficients B 26  high no2 gas Reports
84. 90  of the high NO concentration determined in the    Calibrate High  NO     procedure     2  From the Main Menu  choose Calibration  gt  Cal Hi NO2 Coefficient     The Hi NO  field displays the current NO  concentration  The Hi  NO  Span Conc field is where you enter the high NO  calibration gas    concentration     3  Set the high NO  calibration gas concentration to reflect the sum of the  NO  concentration generated by GPT and any NO  impurity     Use      gt   to move the cursor left and right and use           to increment and decrement the numeric character at the cursor     4  Press to calculate and save the new high NO  coefficient based    on the entered span concentration     You can change the calibration factors by using the Calibration Factors  menu  This is often useful in a troubleshooting situation  However  after  the above calibration procedure is completed  all subsequent data reduction  depends on the calibration parameters remaining the same as during the  initial calibration     Therefore never change any calibration factor without first recording the  value so that after any troubleshooting procedure is completed  the initial  value can be re entered thereby not altering the multipoint calibration     The analyzer requires initial and periodic calibration according to the  procedures outlined in this manual  Initially  the frequency of the  calibration procedure should be determined by the stability of the zero and  span checks  which may be run daily 
85. Be sure the analyzer samples zero air until the  readings stabilize  The NO  NO   and Prereactor Background screens  operate the same way  Therefore  the following description of the NO  background applies to the NO  and Prereactor background screens as well   The first line of the display shows the current NO reading     It is important to note the averaging time when calibrating  The longer the  averaging time  the more accurate the calibration will be  To be most  accurate  use the 300 second averaging time  For more information about  calibration  see Chapter 4     Calibration        e Inthe Main Menu  choose Calibration  gt  Cal Prereactor Zero  Cal  NO  or Cal NOx Background              Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 21    Operation  Calibration Menu    Calibrate NO  NQ2 or The Calibrate NO Coefficient screen is used to adjust the NO span  NO  Coefficients concentration while sampling span gas of known concentration  All  calibration screens operate the same way  Therefore  the following  description of the NO calibration screen applies to the NO  and NO     calibration screens as well     The display shows the current NO concentration reading and the current  NO range  The next line of the display is where the NO calibration gas  concentration is entered     It is important to note the averaging time when calibrating  The longer the  averaging time  the more accurate the calibration will be  To be most  accurate  use the 300 second
86. Calibration    Send  set sp field 1 34  Receive  set sp field 1 34 ok  stream per    This command reports the currently set time interval in seconds for  streaming data     Send  stream per  Receive  stream per 10    set stream per number value  number value     1   2  5  10  20  30   60   90  120   180   240   300      This command sets the time interval between two consecutive streaming  data strings to number value in seconds  The example below sets the  number value to 10 seconds     Send  set stream per 10  Receive  set stream per 10 ok    stream time  This command reports if the streaming data string will have a time stamp  attached to it or not  according to Table B   5     Send  stream time  Receive  stream time 0    set stream time value   This command enables value  where value is to attach or disable time stamp  to streaming data string  according to Table B   5  The example below  attaches a time stamp to streaming data     Send  set stream time O  Receive  set stream time O ok    Table B   5  Stream Time Values       Value Stream Time  00 Attaches time stamp to streaming data string  01 Disables time stamp to streaming data string  set cal no bkg  set cal nox bkg  set cal pre bkg    These commands will auto calibrate the NO  NO   and prereactor  backgrounds  If the instrument is set to manual NO  mode  the response to    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 25    C Link Protocol Commands  Calibration    B 26    Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual      
87. D    J18       Oo a N on A OO N    Ground    Ground   LCLK     LCD Signal  Ground   Ground   LLP     LCD Signal  LFLM     LCD Signal  LD4      LCD Signal  LDO     LCD Signal  LD5      LCD Signal  LD1     LCD Signal  LD6     LCD Signal    Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual 6 11    Troubleshooting  Connector Pin Descriptions    6 12 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual             Connector Reference Pin Signal Description  Label Designator  13 LD2    LCD Signal  14 LD7    LCD Signal  15 LD3     LCD Signal  16 LCD Bias Voltage   17  5V  18 Ground  19 Ground  20 LCD_ONOFF     LCD Signal  21 Keypad Row 2 Input  22 Keypad Row 1 Input  23 Keypad Row 4 Input  24 Keypad Row 3 Input  25 Keypad Col 2 Select  26 Keypad Col 1 Select  27 Keypad Col 4 Select  28 Keypad Col 3 Select  29 Ground  30 Ground  31 Ground  32 Ground  33  24V  34  24V  RS232 RS485 A P1 A 1 NC  2 Serial Port 1 RX   RS485 IN   3 Serial Port 1 TX   RS485 OUT   4 NC  5 Ground  6 NC  7 Serial Port 1 RTS   RS485 OUT   8 Serial Port 1 CTS   RS485 IN   9 NC  RS232 RS485 B P1 B 1 NC  Serial Port 2 RX   RS485 IN   3 Serial Port 2 TX   RS485 OUT     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Troubleshooting  Connector Pin Descriptions    Connector Reference Pin Signal Description  Label Designator    NC   Ground   NC   Serial Port 2 RTS   RS485 OUT   Serial Port 2 CTS   RS485 IN   NC   AC HOT   AC NEUT   AC Ground   AC HOT   AC NEUT   AC Ground   AC HOT   2 AC NEUT   3 AC Ground    oOo aoa N O oO  gt        AC IN PJ1         wo N 
88. D 2  Abbreviations Used       ssssesseesessessseeereesserssetssressrressressreesserssressreesrresers D 2  Basic Command Structure     ssssessssesseesssresereeeseessttssressriesereesreesseessresse D 2  Block Checksum  lt BCOC gt     ssssesssseeseseeesseessseessrrssressressreesereesrereseessresse D 3  Ge  ysitech Commands sssini a A ar kets D 3  Instrument Control Command  ST        ccccccccesssscecssssssccessssceseessees D 3  Data Sampling Data Query Command  DA     cceeeeseeteeeereeeeees D 4  Measurements reported in response to DA command    D 6  Single Range Mod etic  850s S00 cos tatiana tii Al il eda D 6  Dual Auto Range Modesccierin ina ee endintuheteeoee D 6    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual xiii    Contents    Operating and Error Status at a cae cate  teaheceaatee tite shee cteucadacetiasececanste D 7    Appendix E Standards for Trace Level Analyzers                 ssssssssssssssssssseesesseeseeseeaees E 1    xiv Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Figures    Figures   Figure 1 1  Model 42i Trace Level Flow SchematiC         0 0 ccccccccceceteeeneeee 1 3  Figure 2 1  Remove the Packing Material 0 00 0    ccccccccscecesesesteteesesteteseseees 2 2  Figure 2 2  Model 42i Trace Level Rear Panel          c cccccccecesescetesesesteteseseees 2 3  Figure 2 3  Atmospheric Dump Bypass Plumbing            c ccc ceteteesteteeseees 2 3  Figure 2   4  Twin Head Vacuum Pump Installation    ccc cccececeeeceteeseee
89. DHCP The Use DHCP screen is used to specify whether to use DHCP or not   When DHCP is enabled  the network dynamically provides an IP address  for the instrument     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Communication  Settings  gt  TCP IP Settings  gt  Use DCHP     3 40 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu       IP Address The IP Address screen is used to edit the IP address  The IP address can    only be changed when DHCP is OFF  For more information on DHCP   see    Use DHCP    above     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Communication  Settings  gt  TCP IP Settings  gt  IP Address        Netmask The Netmask screen is used to edit the netmask  The netmask is used to  determine the subnet for which the instrument can directly communicate  to other devices on  The netmask can only be changed when DHCP is  OFF  For more information on DHCP  see    Use DHCP    above     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Communication  Settings  gt  TCP IP Settings  gt  Netmask        Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 41    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu    Default Gateway The Default Gateway screen is used to edit the gateway address  The  default gateway can only be changed when DHCP is OFF  For more  information on DHCP  see    Use DHCP    above  Any traffic to addresses  that are not on the local subnet will be routed through this address  
90. Figure 7 2 and Figure 7 7     4  Blow off the cooler fins using clean pressurized air  It may be more  convenient to vacuum the cooler fins  In either case  make sure that any  particulate accumulation between the fins has been removed    5  If necessary  use a small brush to remove residual particulate  accumulation    6  Replace the cover    7  Connect the power cord and turn the instrument ON     Use the following procedure to inspect and clean the fan filters     l     Remove the two fan guards from the fans and remove the filters     Flush the filters with warm water and let dry  a clean  oil free purge will  help the drying process  or blow the filters clean with compressed air     Re install the filters and fan guards     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Pump Rebuilding    Thermo Fisher Scientific    A    Preventative Maintenance  Pump Rebuilding    Use the following procedure to rebuild the pump  Figure 5 2   To replace  the pump  see    Pump Replacement    in the    Servicing    chapter     Equipment Required   Pump Repair Kit  two repair kits required per pump   Allen Wrench  3 mm and 4 mm  Wrench  9 16 inch    Needlenose Pliers    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  For more  information about appropriate safety precautions  see the    Servicing     chapter  A    1  Turn instrument off  unplug the power cord  and d
91. Geysitech instrument address has a value between 0 and 127 and is  represented by 3 digit ASCII number with leading zeros or leading spaces if  required  e g  Instrument address of 1 is represented as 001 or  lt SP gt  lt SP gt 1     The instrument Address is the same as the Instrument ID used for C Link  and MODBUS commands  This can be set via the front panel     The Instrument Address is represented by  lt address gt  in the examples  throughout this document     Note Device IDs 128 through 247 are not supported because of  limitations imposed by the C Link protocol  A    The following is a list of abbreviations used in this document    lt CR gt  is abbreviation for Carriage Return  ASCII code 0x0D    lt STX gt  is abbreviation for Start of Text  ASCII code 0x02    lt ETX gt  is abbreviation for End of Text  ASCII code 0x03    lt SP gt  is abbreviation for space  ASCII code 0x20     The following is the basic structure of a Geysitech command    lt STX gt Command text lt ETX gt  lt BCC gt    OR    lt STX gt Command text lt CR gt     Each Command is framed by control characters   lt STX gt  at the start and  terminated with either  lt ETX gt  or  lt CR gt      If a command is terminated with  lt ETX gt  then additional two characters     lt BCC gt  is attached after  lt ETX gt   this is the block checksum     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Block Checksum     lt BCC gt     Geysitech Commands    Instrument Control Command    Thermo Fisher Scientific     ST     Geysitech  Bayern H
92. Hi NO Coefficient     The Hi NO field displays the current NO concentration  The Hi NO  Span Conc field is where you enter the high NO calibration gas  concentration     Use      gt   to move the cursor left and right and use    C      to increment and decrement the numeric character at the cursor     Press to calculate and save the new high NO coefficient based on    the entered span concentration     Use the following procedure to calibrate the NO  channel to the NO     calibration gas     l     Press     to return to the Calibration menu  and choose Cal Hi  NOx Coefficient     Verify that the high NO  calibration gas concentration is the same as  the high NO calibration gas concentration plus any known NO   impurity     Use  _        to move the cursor left and right and use          to increment and decrement the numeric character at the cursor     Press to calculate and save the new high NO  coefficient based    on the entered span concentration     Press   gt    to return to the Run screen     Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual 4 19    Calibration  Zero and Span Check    Zero and Span Check    4 20    Calibrate High NO     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Use the following procedure to calibrate the NO  channel to the NO     calibration gas     1  Adjust the O  generator in the GPT system to generate sufficient O  to  produce a decrease in the high NO concentration equivalent to about  80  of the URL of the high NO  range  The decrease must not exceed  
93. Level Instruction Manual          The Analog Input Readings screen  read only  displays the 8 current user   scaled analog readings  if the I O expansion board option is installed      In the Main Menu  choose Diagnostics  gt  Analog Input Readings        The Analog Input Voltages screen  read only  displays the 8 raw analog  voltage readings  if the I O expansion board option is installed      In the Main Menu  choose Diagnostics  gt  Analog Input Voltages        The Digital Inputs screen  read only  displays the state of the 16 digital  inputs     In the Main Menu  choose Diagnostics  gt  Digital Inputs     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Relay States    Test Analog Outputs    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Diagnostics Menu       ERED CH  MP Tit    WH hid  PS PEP L Pi AG Lf bi       The Relay States screen displays the state of the 10 digital outputs and  allows toggling of the state to either on  1  or off  0   The relays are  restored to their original states upon exiting this screen     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Diagnostics  gt  Relay States     e Press to toggle and set the relay state open or closed        i mri   iL PPG i       The Test Analog Outputs menu contains a number of digital to analog  converter  DAC  calibration items  Channel choices include all analog  outputs  6 voltage channels  and 6 current channels  if the I O expansion  board option is installed      e Inthe Main Menu  choose Diagnostics  gt  Test Analog Outputs        ao pH Te ied    OPEL a EE 
94. Level Instruction Manual B 27    C Link Protocol Commands  Calibration    B 28    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    no bkg   nox bkg   pre bkg   bkg no   bkg nox   bkg pre   These commands report the current NO  NO   and prereactor    backgrounds  The example below reports that the NO background is 5 5  ppb     Send  no bkg  Receive  no bkg 5 5 ppb    set no bkg value  set nox bkg value  set pre bkg value  set bkg no value  set bkg nox value  set bkg pre value    These commands are used to set NO  NO   and prereactor backgrounds to  user defined values to value  where value is a floating point representation  of the background in current selected units  The example below sets the    NO background to 5 5 ppb     Send  set no bkg 5 5  Receive  set no bkg 5 5 ok  pres cal    This command reports the pressure recorded at the time of calibration  The  example below shows that the pressure at calibration is 85 5 mmHg     Send  pres cal  Receive  pres cal 85 5 mmHg  set pres cal    This command automatically sets the current pressure as the calibration  pressure  The example below successfully sets the calibration pressure to  120 5 mmHg     Send  set pres cal 120 5  Receive  set pres cal 120 5 ok  set cal pres    This command automatically sets the current pressure as the calibration  pressure  The example below successfully sets the calibration pressure     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Keys Display    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Keys Display    S
95. Main Menu  choose Calibration Factors  gt  NO  NOx  or  Prereactor Bkg              pm pH pipiri  Hiet Piim PEPRLE i          The NO  NO   and NO  span coefficient are usually calculated by the  instrument processor during calibration  The span coefficients are used to  correct the NO  NO    and NO  readings  The NO and NO  span  coefficients normally has a value near 1 000  The NO  span coefficient  normally has a value between 0 95 and 1 050     The NO  NOz  and NO  Coefficient screens allow the NO  NO    and  NO  span coefficients to be manually changed while sampling span gas of  known concentration  The NO  NO   and NO  Coefficient screens operate  the same way  Therefore  the following description of the NO coefficient  screen applies to the NO  and NO  coefficient screens as well     The display shows the current NO concentration reading  The next line of  the display shows the NO span coefficient that is stored in memory and is  being used to correct the NO concentration  Notice that as the span  coefficient value is changed  the current NO concentration reading on the  above line also changes  However  no real changes are made to the value    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Calibration Factors Menu    stored in memory until is pressed  Only proposed changes  as  indicated by a question mark prompt  are displayed until is pressed     In dual or auto range modes     HIGH    or    LOW    is displayed to indicate  the calibration of the high or low coefficient  Th
96. Maintaining the same Fro  Fo  and Fp  adjust the ozone generator to  obtain several other concentrations of NO   over the NO  range  at least  five evenly spaced points across the remaining scale are suggested      Record the stable responses and plot the analyzer s NO  responses  versus the corresponding calculated  using the above equation for   NOz  our  concentrations and draw or calculate the NO  calibration  curve     Note It is important that the curve be linear within  1   FS over the NO2  range  If the curve is nonlinear  the analyzer is not operating correctly    possible leak  or converter failure  etc    and should be serviced  Assuming  the curve is linear  subsequent data should be reduced using this NO2  calibration curve response   amp     Using the Calibration Factors menu can change the calibration factors   This is often useful in a troubleshooting situation  However  after the above  calibration procedure is completed  all subsequent data reduction depends  on the calibration parameters  remaining the same as during the initial  calibration  A    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 4 15    Calibration  Calibration in Dual Range and Auto Range Mode    Alternative Calibration  Procedure Using NO   Permeation Tube    Calibration in Dual  Range and Auto  Range Mode    Set Background Readings  to Zero    4 16 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Therefore  never change any calibration factor without first recording the  value so that after any troub
97. Manual 3 7    Operation  Range Menu    Range Menu The Range menu allows the operator to select the gas units  NO NO  NO   ranges  and to set the custom ranges  The screens below show the range  menu in single range mode and dual auto range modes  The only  difference between the screens are the words    HI    and    LO    to indicate  which range is displayed  For more information about the single  dual and  auto range modes  see    Single Range Mode        Dual Range Mode     and     Auto Range Mode    below     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Range    a ee is ST moc Mp pibot  A i i i L 1 TEI    4 PU  Piri i       Single Range Mode Inthe single range mode  the NO  NO2  and NO  channels each have one    range  one averaging time  and one span coefficient     By default  the three analog outputs are arranged on the rear panel  connector as shown in Figure 3   4  See Table 3 2 for channels and pin  connections  Single range mode may be selected from the    Range Mode    Select    on page 3 74     3 8 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation                                               Range Menu   0   37 O 19   Figure 3   4  Pin Out of Rear Panel Connector in Single Range Mode  Table 3 2  Default Analog Outputs in Single Range Mode   Channel Connector Pin 1 0 Terminal Pin Description   1 14 1 NO Analog Output   2 33 3 NO  Analog Output   3 15 5 NO  Analog Output   4 34 7 None   5 17 g None   6 36 11 None   Ground 16  18  19  35  37 2 4 6 8  10  
98. Mode The Service Mode screen is used to turn the service mode on or off  The  service mode locks out any remote actions and includes parameters and  functions that are useful when making adjustments or diagnosing the  Model 427 Trace Level  For more information about the service mode  see     Service Menu    later in this chapter     Note The service mode should be turned off when finished  as it prevents  remote operation  A    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Service Mode           Pr aT cA    mith  a Taic Mii       Date Time The Date Time screen allows the user to view and change the system date  and time  24 hour format   The internal clock is powered by its own  battery when instrument power is off     e In the Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Date Time     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 55    Operation  Diagnostics Menu       Diagnostics The Diagnostics menu provides access to diagnostic information and  Menu functions  This menu is useful when troubleshooting the instrument  The    analog input readings and analog input voltages are only displayed if the  I O expansion board option is installed     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Diagnostics        Program Version The Program Version screen  read only  shows the version number of the  program installed  Prior to contacting the factory with any questions  regarding the instrument  please note the product model name and  program version number     e Inthe Main Me
99. Model 42i   Trace Level   Instruction Manual   Chemiluminescence NO NO2 NO   Analyzer  Part Number 102855 00    20Dec2007       CE Thermo       2007 Thermo Fisher Scientific Inc  All rights reserved     Specifications  terms and pricing are subject to change  Not all products are available in all countries  Please  consult your local sales representative for details     Thermo Fisher Scientific  Air Quality Instruments  27 Forge Parkway  Franklin  MA 02038  1 508 520 0430    www thermo com aqi    Thermo Fisher Scientific    WEEE Compliance    This product is required to comply with the European Union   s Waste  Electrical  amp  Electronic Equipment  WEEE  Directive 2002 96 EC  It is  marked with the following symbol     Thermo Fisher Scientific has contracted with one or more  recycling disposal companies in each EU Member State  and this product  should be disposed of or recycled through them  Further information on  Thermo Fisher Scientific   s compliance with these Directives  the recyclers  in your country  and information on Thermo Fisher Scientific products  which may assist the detection of substances subject to the RoHS Directive  are available at  www thermo com WEEERoHS     WEEE Compliance    Thermo Fisher Scientific    About This Manual    This manual provides information about operating  maintaining  and    servicing the analyzer  It also contains important alerts to ensure safe    operation and prevent equipment damage  The manual is organized into    the followi
100. Multimeter    7 32 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Analog Input    Calibrating the Input    Calibration    Channels to Zero    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Volts    Servicing  Analog Input Calibration    1  Connect a meter to the channel to be adjusted and set to voltage or  current as appropriate  Figure 7   16 shows the analog output pins and  Table 7   4 identifies the associated channels     2  From the Main Menu  press      to scroll to Service  gt  press        gt        to scroll to Analog Output Calibration  gt  and press           The Analog Output Cal screen appears     Note If Service Mode is not displayed  refer to    Accessing the Service  Mode    on page 7 4   then return to the beginning of this step  A    3  At the Analog Output Cal screen  press      to scroll to the desired  voltage channel or current channel corresponding to the rear panel  terminal pin where the meter is connected  then press  e     4  With the cursor at Calibrate Zero  press  e    The Analog Output Cal line displays Zero    Note When calibrating the analog output  always calibrate zero first and  then calibrate full scale  A    5  Use        until the meter reads 0 0V  or 0 0 or 4 0 mA for a  current channel   then press to save the value     6  Press aw to return to the previous screen     7  Press          to select Calibrate Full Scale     8  Use  _      until the meter reads the value shown in the Set  Output To line  then press to save the value   
101. NO   dual mode  Ozonator Flow Analog Input 8       HI NO  dual mode     Range  NO    auto range mode        Prereactor  single auto range mode        LO Prereactor  dual mode        HI Prereactor  dual mode     Analog Input The Analog Input Configuration menu displays a list of the 8 analog input   Configuration channels available for configuration  This screen is only displayed if the I O  expansion board option is installed  Configuration includes entering  descriptor  units  decimal places  choice of 1 10 points in the table  and  corresponding number of points selected     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration  gt     Analog Input Config        DH vided  POPLAR              lt  QORN  Ce a E SO a E          Descriptor The Descriptor screen allows the user to enter the descriptor for the  selected analog input channel  The descriptor is used in datalogging and    3 50 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu    streaming data to report what data is being sent out  The descriptor may be  from 1 to 3 characters in length  and defaults to IN1 to IN8  user input  channel number      e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration  gt   Analog Input Config  gt  Select Channel  gt  Descriptor        ERED    EN EEE TE Sanat Bone          Units The Units screen allows the user to enter the units for the selected analog  input channel  The units are displayed on the di
102. O  expansion board is not detected     Send  set analog iout range 4 1  Receive  set analog iout range 4 1 ok    Table B 9  Analog Current Output Range Values          Range Output Range  1 0 20 mA   2 4 20 mA   0  cannot be set to this  but may report  Undefined    analog vin channel   This command retrieves the analog voltage input channel data  both the  calculated value and the actual voltage  In the example below  the     calculated    value of channel 1 is 75 325 degrees F  volts are 2 796  This  command responds with    feature not enabled    if the I O expansion board  is not detected     Send  analog vin 1  Receive  analog vin 1 75 325 2 796    analog vout range channel  This command reports the analog voltage output channel range  where  channel is between 1 and 6 inclusive  according to Table B   10     Send  analog vout range 2  Receive  analog vout range 2 3    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  1 0 Configuration    set analog vout range channel range   This command sets analog voltage output channel to the range  where  channel is between 1 and 6 inclusive  and range is set according to Table B   10  The example below sets channel 2 to the 0 10 V range     Send  set analog vout range 2 3  Receive  set analog vout range 2 3 ok    Table B 10  Analog Voltage Output Range Values                Range Output Range   1 0 1V   2 0 100 mV   3 0 10 V   4 0 5 V   0  cannot be set to this  but may report  Undefined  dig in    T
103. O and SPAN ports should give identical responses to the  SAMPLE port when test gases are introduced  The user should calibrate the  instrument using the SAMPLE port to introduce the zero and span gas  sources  A    After calibration  the zero and span sources should be plumbed to the  appropriate ports on the rear panel of the instrument  and then  reintroduced to the instrument  The instrument should give identical  responses to the test gases whether they are introduced via the SAMPLE  port or the ZERO or SPAN ports  If not  the plumbing and or valves    should be serviced     Use the following procedure to connect the GPT apparatus to the analyzer     1  Assemble a dynamic calibration system such as the one shown in Figure    4 1     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 4 9    Calibration  Calibration    Adjust Instrument Gain    2  Ensure that all flow meters are calibrated under the conditions of use  against a reliable standard  such as a soap bubble meter or wet test  meter  All volumetric flow rates should be corrected to 25   C and 760  mmHg     3  Precautions should be taken to remove O  and other contaminants  from the NO pressure regulator and delivery system prior to the start of  calibration to avoid any conversion of NO to NO    Failure to do so can  cause significant errors in calibration  This problem can be minimized    by     a  Carefully evacuating the regulator after the regulator has been  connected to the cylinder and before opening the cylinder val
104. Oo a N on A O N       Relay 2 Contact a  Relay 3 Contact a  Relay 4 Contact a  Relay 5 Contact a  Relay 6 Contact a  Relay 7 Contact a  Relay 8 Contact a    Oo a N O o A      N    Relay 9 Contact a   10 Relay 10 Contact a   11 NC   12 Solenoid Drive Output 1  13 Solenoid Drive Output 2    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 6 19    Troubleshooting  Connector Pin Descriptions       Connector Reference Pin Signal Description  Label Designator  14 Solenoid Drive Output 3  15 Solenoid Drive Output 4  16 Solenoid Drive Output 5  17 Solenoid Drive Output 6  18 Solenoid Drive Output 7  19 Solenoid Drive Output 8  20 Relay 1 Contact b  21 Relay 2 Contact b  22 Relay 3 Contact b  23 Relay 4 Contact b  24 Relay 5 Contact b  25 Relay 6 Contact b  26 Relay 7 Contact b  27 Relay 8 Contact b  28 Relay 9 Contact b  29 Relay 10 Contact b  30  24V  31  24V  32  24V  33  24V  34  24V  35  24V  36  24V  37  24V    Table 6 8  Input Board Connector Pin Descriptions       Connector Reference Pin Signal Description  Label Designator  PMT IN J1 1 PMT Input  2 Ground  INTF BD J2 1  15V  2 Ground  3  15V    6 20 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Connector  Label    Reference  Designator    oOo aoa N O oO  gt A    ES  oO    Troubleshooting  Connector Pin Descriptions    Signal Description     5V   Ground   Measurement Frequency Output  Amplifier Zero Adjust Voltage  SPI Input   SPI Clock   SPI Board Select    Table 6 9  Temperature Contro
105. PLE     mode  Other modes appear in the same area of the display as    ZERO    or     SPAN     For more information about the optional solenoid valves  see    Chapter 9     Optional Equipment        When operating in dual or auto range mode two sets of coefficients are  used to calculate the NO NO  NO     High    and    Low    concentrations   Also  two averaging times are used   one for each range  The title bar  indicates which range concentrations are displayed  The words    LOW  RANGE CONCENTRATION     on the top of the display indicates that  the low concentration is displayed  In dual range mode  pressing the  and    arrows will toggle between high and low concentrations  The  example below shows the Run screen in single range mode     3 6 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Software Overview       Main Menu The Main Menu contains a number of submenus  Instrument parameters  and settings can be read and modified within the submenus according to  their function  The concentration appears above the main menu and  submenus in every screen  The Service menu is visible only when the  instrument is in service mode  For more information on the service mode   see    Service Mode    later in this chapter     e Use  t Jand     to move the cursor up and down   e Press to select a choice     e Press        to return to the Main Menu or     _  to return to the Run    screen        Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction 
106. Password The Change Password is used to change the password used to unlock the    instrument s front panel  The change password is shown if the instrument  is unlocked     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Password  gt  Change Password                    Remove Password    The Remove Password screen is used to erase the current password and  disable password protection  The remove password is shown if the  instrument is unlocked and the password set     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 87    Operation  Unlock Instrument    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Password  gt  Remove Password       ihe EE EE          Unlock Instrument The Unlock Instrument screen is used to enter the password to unlock the    front panel  The unlock instrument is shown if the instrument is locked     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Password  gt  Unlock Instrument       3 88 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Equipment Required    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Chapter 4  Calibration    This chapter describes procedures for performing a multipoint calibration  of the Model 427 Trace Level  The information described here is considered  be adequate to perform the calibration  However  if greater detail is desired   the user is referred to the Code of Federal Regulations  Title 40  Part 50   Appendix F     The calibration technique is based on the rapid gas phase reaction between  NO and O  which produces stoichiometric quantities of NO  in  accordance with th
107. R FLOW       Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    MODBUS Protocol  MODBUS Parameters Supported                                                       Register Number Variable   40073 amp 40074 PREREACTOR   40075 amp 40076 LOW PREREACTOR  40077 amp 40078 HIGH PREREACTOR  40079 amp 40080 NO CORRECTION CONC    40081  amp 40082 NO2 CORRECTION CONC   40083 amp 40084 NOx CORRECTION CONC   40085 amp 40086 NOT USED   40087  amp 40088 NOT USED   40089 amp 40090 LOW NO CORRECTION CONC   40091  amp 40092 LOW NO2 CORRECTION CONC   40093 amp 40094 LOW NOx CORRECTION CONC   40095 amp 40096 NOT USED   40097 amp 40098 NOT USED   40099 amp 40100 HIGH NO CORRECTION CONC   40101 amp 40102 HIGH NO2 CORRECTION CONC   40103 amp 40104 HIGH NOx CORRECTION CONC   40105 amp 40106 NOT USED   40107 amp 40108 NOT USED        If O2 Correction Option is installed     Table C 3  Write Coils for 427 Trace Level                                  Coil Number Action Triggered   101 ZERO MODE   102 SPAN MODE   103 NO MODE   104 NOX MODE   105 NOT USED   106 PRE MODE   107 SET BACKGROUND   108 CAL TO LO SPAN   109 AOUTS TO ZERO  10 AOUTS TO FS   111 CAL TO HI SPAN       Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual C 11    Serial Communication  Parameters    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Appendix D  Geysitech  Bayern Hessen  Protocol    This appendix provides a description of the Geysitech  Bayern Hessen or  BH  Protocol Interface and is supported both over RS 232 485 as well as  TCP IP over Ethernet   
108. Sensor    Assembly    Temperature Control    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Board    System Description  Electronics    The measurement interface board serves as a central connection area for all  measurement electronics in the instrument  It contains power supplies and  interface circuitry for sensors and control devices in the measurement  system  It sends status data to the motherboard and receives control signals  from the motherboard     Connectors located on the measurement interface board include   e Data communication with the motherboard   e 24V and 120VAC power supply inputs   e Fans and solenoid outputs   e Cooler control   e 120VAC outputs for the pump and temperature control board  e Ozonator   e Flow and pressure sensors   e Ambient temperature sensor   e Temperature control board   e PMT high voltage supply   e Measurement input board    e Permeation oven option    The flow sensor assembly consists of a board containing an instrumentation  amplifier and a flow transducer with input and output gas fittings  The  flow transducer output is produced by measuring the pressure difference  across a precision orifice  This unit is used for measuring the flow of sample  gas in the measurement system     The pressure sensor assembly consists of a board containing an  instrumentation amplifier and a pressure transducer with a gas input  fitting  The pressure transducer output is produced by measuring the  pressure difference between the sample gas pressure and ambient air  p
109. Soft Keys The     soft keys  are used to provide shortcuts that    allow the user to jump to user selectable menu screens  For  more information on processing soft keys  see    Soft Keys     below      gt      Run The   gt   is used to display the Run screen  The Run    screen normally displays the NO  NO2  and NO   concentrations           Menu The     is used to display the Main Menu when in the  Run screen  or back up one level in the menu system  For    more information about the Main Menu  see    Main Menu     later in this chapter      2      Help The  2    is context sensitive  that is  it provides    additional information about the screen that is being  displayed  Press for a brief explanation about the  current screen or menu  Help messages are displayed using  lower case letters to easily distinguish them from the  operating screens  To exit a help screen  press _      J or   to return to the previous screen  or to  return to the Run screen         JC   J up  Down The four arrow pushbuttons   t    4 J      and           gt     Left  Right   move the cursor up  down  left  and right or  change values and states in specific screens       Enter The is used to select a menu item  accept set save    a change  and or toggle on off functions                          Soft Keys The Soft Keys are multi functional keys that use part of the display to  identify their function at any moment  The function of the soft keys allows  immediate access to the menu structure and most o
110. TITY OTHER THAN SELLER WITHOUT  SELLER S PRIOR WRITTEN APPROVAL  OR ANY USE OF  REPLACEMENT PARTS NOT SUPPLIED BY SELLER  SHALL  IMMEDIATELY VOID AND CANCEL ALL WARRANTIES WITH  RESPECT TO THE AFFECTED PRODUCTS     THE OBLIGATIONS CREATED BY THIS WARRANTY  STATEMENT TO REPAIR OR REPLACE A DEFECTIVE PRODUCT  SHALL BE THE SOLE REMEDY OF BUYER IN THE EVENT OF A  DEFECTIVE PRODUCT  EXCEPT AS EXPRESSLY PROVIDED IN  THIS WARRANTY STATEMENT  SELLER DISCLAIMS ALL  OTHER WARRANTIES  WHETHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  ORAL  OR WRITTEN  WITH RESPECT TO THE PRODUCTS   INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION ALL IMPLIED  WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY  PARTICULAR PURPOSE  SELLER DOES NOT WARRANT THAT  THE PRODUCTS ARE ERROR FREE OR WILL ACCOMPLISH  ANY PARTICULAR RESULT     A 2 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Instrument    Identification    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Number    Appendix B  C Link Protocol Commands    This appendix provides a description of the C Link protocol commands  that can be used to remotely control a Model 427 Trace Level analyzer  using a host device such as a PC or a datalogger  C Link protocol may be  used over RS 232  RS 485  or Ethernet  C Link functions can be accessed  over Ethernet using TCP IP port 9880  For details  see the following  topics     e    Instrument Identification Number    on page B 1  e    Commands    on page B 2   e    Measurements    on page B 9   e    Alarms    on page B 13   e    Diagnostics    on pag
111. The Choose Signal to Output screen displays a submenu list of the analog  output signal group choices  Group choices are Concentrations  Other  Measurements  and Analog Inputs  if the I O expansion board option is  installed   This allows the user to select the output signal to the selected  output channel  In dual or auto range mode     HI    or    LO    is displayed to  indicate high or low concentrations  Range  NO  is visible only in auto  range mode  The Concentrations screen is shown below  See Table 3   7  below for a list of items for each signal group choice     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration  gt     Analog Output Config  gt  Select Channel  gt  Choose Signal to Output        RRS E Cars mito  DN EEE TE Sanat Bone ETET Aad Bast    ade          RR Pep En meh dt  PPP LES mie LG       Table 3 7  Signal Type Group Choices                Concentrations Other Measurements Analog Inputs  None None None   NO  single auto range mode  Internal Temp Analog Input 1  NO   single auto range mode  Chamber Temp Analog Input 2  NO   single auto range mode  Cooler Temp Analog Input 3  LO NO  dual mode  NO  Converter Temp Analog Input 4       Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 49    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu                Concentrations Other Measurements Analog Inputs  LO NO  dual mode  Chamber Pressure Analog Input 5  LO NO   dual mode  Flow Analog Input 6  HI NO  dual mode  PMT Volts Analog Input 7  HI 
112. Tia 4 4  Reaction Chamber siestas ieiki oie to hares Si ss 4 4  Mixing Chamber dasakc sce catesccasleeadscacaadasessions exsneaueacuascatecestenaaaaeonnds 4 4  O  tp  t Manifold gor aoste ese in een rot E re Um nnrT aa 4 4  REA CTS sin Ha sieth ce ede a a a e Acaseche sine R ONA 4 4  NO Concentration Standard  ij sc3 cantante denaitaek ih 4 4  Assaying a Working NO Standard Against a NIST traceable NO  Staite AEE E estes dedi ihanes aaapeceetenne Mashatietecttaane 4 5  PROP E Sa idea alsa Gai dr Siuata onde atuc ek ales evs T 4 6  Dynamic Parameter Specifications for Gas Titrator       sees 4 6  Determining GPT System Flow Conditions 0    ci eceeseeeeeeeeees 4 6  Pre Cali bratiot   lt u 250 15 bennett lactones anea nadie aeia t rani 4 8  Calibration ticiosnascetdicenetde A A E E 4 9  Connect GPT Apparatus to the Analyzer    sses 4 9  Adj  st Instrument GM ei a cere a ee a eee 4 10  Set Backgrounds to Zero eee Aa i E ce atl  4 10  Calibrate the NO Channel to the NO Calibration Gas                4 12  Calibrate the NO  Channel to the NOx Calibration Gas              4 12  Preparing NO  NO   and NO   Calibration Curves   0    eee 4 13  Alternative Calibration Procedure Using NO  Permeation Tube     4 16  Calibration in Dual Range and Auto Range Mode    seers 4 16  Set Background Readings to Zero 2 26 235 ecivesdcetaad eae tance 4 16  Calibrate Low NO Are nee ea ee ee ta ee 4 17  Calibrate Low NOs aots acces aeea EEE TESS ina 4 18  Calibrate Low NO oii ccssciiescpiziepdeed cecde
113. VIEW       Captive Screw  Figure 7   15  Replacing the DC Power Supply    4  Turn the power supply upside down and remove the four retaining  screws securing the power supply to the power supply plate and remove  the power supply     5  To install the DC power supply  follow the previous steps in reverse     Analog Outp Ut The analog outputs should be tested if the concentration value on the front  Te sting panel display disagrees with the analog outputs  To check the analog  outputs  you connect a meter to an analog output channel  voltage or  current  and compare the meter reading with the output value set on the  Test Analog Outputs screen     Equipment Required   Multimeter  Use the following procedure to test the analog outputs     1  Connect a meter to the channel to be tested  Figure 7 16 shows the  analog output pins and Table 7   4 identifies the associated channels     7 30 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  Analog Output Testing    Current Outputs  Analog Voltage Inputs    Analog Voltage Outputs       Figure 7   16  Rear Panel Analog Input and Output Pins    2  From the Main Menu  press _    to scroll to Diagnostics   gt  press     gt      to scroll to Test Analog Outputs  and press         The Test Analog Outputs screen appears     3  Press _     to scroll to the desired channel corresponding to the rear  panel terminal pins where the meter is connected  and press         The Set Analog Outpu
114. able  To turn  the zero span check off  set the period to 0     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 23    Operation  Calibration Menu    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Calibration  gt  Zero Span Check  gt  Period  Hours        CHS mTOR  gH Cer    Haat abe EE Scala  Pi EE EE    Zero Span Purge The Zero Duration Minutes screen defines how long zero air is sampled by   Duration Minutes the instrument  The span and purge duration screens look and function the  same way as the zero duration screen  and are used to set how long the span  gas and sample gas are sampled by the instrument  Durations between 0  and 60 minutes are acceptable  Each time a zero span check occurs the zero  check is done first  followed by the span check  To perform just a zero  check  set the span and purge duration screen to 0  off   The same applies  to perform just a span or purge check     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Calibration  gt  Zero Span Check  gt  Zero   Span or Purge Duration Min     PME ieee EE EE       Zero Span Averaging The Zero Span Averaging Time screen allows the user to adjust the  Time zero span averaging time  The zero span averaging time is used by the  analyzer only when performing an automatic zero or span check  The  analyzer   s averaging time is used for all other functions  The following  averaging times are available  1  2  5  10  20  30  60  90  120  180  240   and 300 seconds     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Calibration  gt  Zero Span Check  gt   Zero S
115. able for connecting external devices to iSeries  instruments     These connection options include    e Individual terminal board PCB assemblies  e Terminal block and cable kits  optional   e Individual cables  optional     For detailed information on the optional connection components  refer to  the    Optional Equipment    chapter  For associated part numbers  refer to     External Device Connection Components    on page 7 6     The following terminal board PCB assemblies are available for iSeries  instruments     e I O terminal board PCB assembly  37 pin  standard   e D O terminal board PCB assembly  37 pin  standard     e 25 pin terminal board PCB assembly   included with optional I O  Expansion Board     Figure 2   5 shows the recommended method for attaching the cable to the  terminal board using the included tie down and spacer  Table 2   1  identifies the connector pins and associated signals     Note All of the I O available in the instrument are not brought out on this  terminal board  if more I O is desired  an alternative means of connection  is required  A    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 2 5    Installation  Connecting External Devices    See Detail    A       See Detail    B          Assembled Connector    2 6 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual       Figure 2 5  I O Terminal Board Views    Detail    A          Detail    B       Table 2 1  I O Terminal Board Pin Descriptions                                        Pin Signal Description Pin Signal
116. ace    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 53    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu    Pressure  Compensation    Screen Contrast    3 54 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    board   When temperature compensation is off  the display shows the  factory standard temperature of 30   C     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Temperature  Compensation        Pressure compensation provides compensation for any changes to the  instrument s output signal due to reaction chamber pressure variations  The  effects of reaction chamber pressure changes on the analyzer s subsystems  and output have been empirically determined  This empirical data is used  to compensate for any change in reaction chamber pressure     When pressure compensation is on  the first line of the display represents  the current pressure in the reaction chamber  When pressure compensation  is off  the first line of the display shows the factory standard pressure of 300  mmHg     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Pressure  Compensation        The Screen Contrast screen is used to change the contrast of the display   Intensities between 0 and 100  in increments of 10 are available   Changing the screen contrast may be necessary if the instrument is  operated at extreme temperatures     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Screen Contrast     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu       ERED ik    i ify  PS PPPS E Pit          Service 
117. acement    Note If Service Mode is not displayed  refer to    Accessing the Service  Mode    on page 7 4   then return to the beginning of this step  A    2  At the Input Board Calibration screen  press to select Manual  Input Cal  and press to calibrate     The screen displays the frequency at GAIN 1     3  Make a note of the FREQ value displayed at GAIN 1  then press        or   gt     to change the GAIN to 100     4  At the GAIN 100 screen  use         to increment the D A counts  until the FREQ value matches or is slightly above  within 50 counts   the value noted in the previous step     5  Press to store the value     The screen flashes Calculating   Please Wait  and Done   Values  Saved  messages     Use the following procedure to replace the DC power supply  Figure 7     15      Equipment Required   DC power supply    Philips screwdriver    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    1  Turn instrument OFF  unplug the power cord  and remove the cover     2  Disconnect all the power supply electrical connections  Note connector  locations to facilitate re connection     3  Loosen the captive screw securing the power supply to the chassis plate  and lift out the power supply     Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 29    Servicing  Analog Output Testing    Power Supply gt    _ Retaining Screws  4         BOTTOM 
118. actory defaults     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Calibration Factors  gt  Reset User  Cal Defaults        The Calibration menu is used to calibrate the analyzer  including zero  backgrounds  the NO  NO2  and NO  coefficients  and the calibration  pressure  The screens below show the calibration menu in single mode and  dual auto range modes  The zero span check is visible only if the zero span  option is installed in single range mode     The calibration procedure is the same in dual  auto  or single range   however  there are two sets of gas coefficients in dual or auto range  i e  low  and high coefficients   This enables each range to be calibrated separately   When calibrating the instrument in dual or auto range  be sure to use a low  span gas to calibrate the low range and a high span gas to calibrate the high  range     Whether dual or singe range  the first step in calibrating the instrument is  to assign the calibration pressure  The calibration pressure is used to  account for slight pressure fluctuation brought on by changing weather   The calibration pressure is set equal to the reactor pressure at the time of    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Calibration Menu    calibration  For more information about calibration  see Chapter 4      Calibration        e Inthe Main Menu  choose Calibration        Calibrate NO  NO  and The Calibrate NO Background screen is used to adjust the background  or  Prereactor Backgrounds perform a    zero calibration     
119. agnostic screen and in  datalogging and streaming data  The units may be from 1 to 3 characters in    length  and defaults to V  volts      e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration  gt   Analog Input Config  gt  Select Channel  gt  Units        EUs EEE TE Sanat Beee       Decimal Places The Decimal Places screen allows the user to select how many digits are  displayed to the right of the decimal  from 0 to 6  with a default of 2     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration  gt   Analog Input Config  gt  Select Channel  gt  Decimal Places     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 51    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu       DH vided  Ce a E SO a EA          Number of Table Points The Number of Table Points screen allows the user to select how many  points are used in the conversion table  The points range from 2 to 10   with a default of 2     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration  gt   Analog Input Config  gt  Select Channel  gt  Table Points        CH pikari  Pet fiie fiini i          Table Point The Table Point submenu allows the user to set up an individual table  point     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration  gt   Analog Input Config  gt  Select Channel  gt  Point 1 10        Erer pi prin pr    him pirmi pH Tid  Hoa CEES Se    Ehe PEE F       3 52 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Volts 
120. all  voltage channels  all current channels  voltage channels 1 6  and current  channels 1 6  if the I O expansion board option is installed   Configuration  choices include selecting range  setting minimum maximum values  and  choosing signal to output     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration  gt     Analog Output Config     3 46 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Select Output Range    Minimum and Maximum    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Value    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu    RCPS E    DN EEE TE Sanad Bone       The Select Output Range screen is used to select the hardware range for the  selected analog output channel  Possible ranges for the voltage outputs are     0 100 mV  0 1  0 5  0 10 V     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration  gt   Analog Output Config  gt  Select Channel  gt  Select Range        The Minimum Value screen is used to edit the zero  0  to full scale  100   value in percentages for the selected analog output channel  See Table 3   6  for a list of choices  In dual or auto range mode     HI    or    LO    is displayed  to indicate high or low concentrations  Range Status is visible only in auto  range mode  The minimum and maximum output value screens function  the same way  The example below shows the set minimum value screen     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 47    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrumen
121. amic  parameter specifications as indicated in    Dynamic Parameter  Specifications for Gas Titrator    earlier in this chapter     2  Adjust the GPT diluent air and O3 generator air flows to obtain the  flows determined in    Dynamic Parameter Specifications for Gas Phase  Titrator    earlier in this chapter  The total GPT airflow must exceed the  total demand of the analyzer  The Model 427 Trace Level requires  approximately 1 liter min of sample flow  and a total GPT airflow of at  least 2 5 liters min is recommended     a  Allow the analyzer to sample zero air until the NO  NO   and NO     responses stabilize     b  After the responses have stabilized  from the Main Menu  choose  Calibration  gt  Cal Prereactor Zero     c  Press to set the zero concentration reading to zero     d  Press     to return to the Calibration menu and repeat this  procedure to set the NO and NO  background to zero     e  Record the stable zero air responses as ZNo  ZNox  and Zno2   recorder response  percent scale      3  Adjust the NO flow from the standard NO cylinder to generate a NO  concentration of about 80  of the upper range limit  URL  of the NO  range  The exact NO concentration is calculated from     _ Fno X NOstp     INO  our   on Fno   Fo   Fp  Where      NO our   Diluted NO concentration at the output manifold  ppm  NOsrtp   No feed concentration   Fxo   No flow   Fo   Ozone flow    Fp   Dilution flow    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 4 11    Cali
122. analyzer     Appendix A    Warranty    is a copy of the warranty statement     Appendix B    C Link Protocol Commands    provides a description of  the C Link protocol commands that can be used to remotely control an  analyzer using a host device such as a PC or datalogger     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual i    About This Manual  Safety    Safety    Safety and Equipment    Damage Alerts    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    e Appendix C    MODBUS Protocol    provides a description of the  MODBUS Protocol Interface and is supported both over RS 232 485   RTU protocol  as well as TCP IP over Ethernet     e Appendix D    Geysitech  Bayern Hessen  Protocol    provides a  description of the Geysitech  Bayern Hessen or BH  Protocol Interface  and is supported both over RS 232 485 as well as TCP IP over  Ethernet    e Appendix E    Standards for Trace Level Analyzers    provides  information about generating zero air     Review the following safety information carefully before using the analyzer   This manual provides specific information on how to operate the analyzer   however  if the calibrator is used in a manner not specified by the   manufacturer  the protection provided by the equipment may be impaired     This manual contains important information to alert you to potential safety  hazards and risks of equipment damage  Refer to the following types of  alerts you may see in this manual     Safety and Equipment Damage Alert Descriptions    Alert Description
123. aning products to  clean the outside case  A    Use the following procedure to replace the ozonator air feed drying  column     Remove the drying column from the connector DRY AIR bulkhead on  the rear panel of the instrument     2  Replace spent absorbent material  indicating Drierite or silica gel  with  new or regenerated material     3  Reinstall the drying column to the DRY AIR bulkhead     4  Perform a Zero Span check  see the    Calibration    chapter      The capillaries normally only require inspection when instrument  performance indicates that there may be a flow problem     Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  For more  information about appropriate safety precautions  see the    Servicing     chapter  A    Use the following procedure to inspect and replace the capillaries  This  procedure can be used to check any or all of the capillaries     1  Turn the instrument OFF and unplug the power cord     2  Remove the instrument cover     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Preventative Maintenance  Capillaries Inspection and Replacement    3  Locate the capillary holders  See Figure 5   1 and Figure 7 2            lt             Reaction Chamber Front    Figure 5 1  Inspecting and Replacing the Capillaries    4  Remove the Cajon    fitting s  from the reaction chamber body using a    5 8 inch w
124. anual     The service mode in the    Operation    chapter also includes parameters and  functions that are useful when making adjustments or diagnosing  problems     For additional service assistance  see    Service Locations    at the end of this  chapter     This chapter includes the following parts information and component  replacement procedures        Safety Precautions    on page 7 2      Firmware Updates    on page 7 4      Accessing the Service Mode    on page 7 4     Replacement Parts List    on page 7 4      Cable List    on page 7 6      External Device Connection Components    on page 7 6       Removing the Measurement Bench and Lowering the Partition Panel    on    page 7 8      Pump Replacement    on page 7 9      Vacuum Pump Diaphragm and Valve Replacement    on page 7 10     Fan Replacement    on page 7 14       PMT Cooler and Reaction Chamber Assembly Replacement    on page 7   15       Photomultiplier Tube Replacement    on page 7 17     PMT High Voltage Power Supply Replacement    on page 7 18     PMT Voltage Adjustment    on page 7 19    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 1    Servicing  Safety Precautions    Safety Precautions    A    7 2 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual       Reaction Chamber Cleaning or Removal    on page 7 20     NO2 to NO Converter Replacement    on page 7 22     Solenoid Valve Replacement    on page 7 23      Ozonator Assembly Replacement    on page 7 25     Ozonator Transformer Replacement  
125. ar ai aa N 3 72  Service Ments eseria ode a n a a 3 73  PMT Voltage Adjustment        sssssssssssesssesesesesesesestsesrererrerersrsrsesreres 3 73  Range Mode Selectinrenii ann aee aa a n aiii 3 74  Converter Set Temperature       ssesseessessereresrsrreresterrsrrstrsiesrsresreseerese 3 74  Pressure Calibratio nieno geen esanei aea i piai 3 75  C  librate Press  re Zer snnening Kisman Rii Ri 3 75  Calibrate Pressure Span     ssssesssseeeesesesesisrsisisisisesesesesesesesesseses 3 76  Restore Default Calibration      eeessssseeessesssssesrsisesesesisrerersrsrsees 3 76  Flow Calibration ssavicssiwsrineieadashiouisnitlanntenntdleds amnermetatane 3 77  Calibrate Flow ZL teas that ena natn Cele ae atte 3 77  Calibrate Flow Span se  gasses Sidhe ten aece see Gente ais 3 78  Restore Default Flow CalibratiGttccxetc scented need eee tas can 3 78  Input Board Calibratio nad  2eigi cccccto ih ieiede epteiaet dr cecal dteeoutes aces 3 79  Manual Input Calibration s  2i cniwaniadeadlead siesta 3 79  Automatic Input Calibration  20 24 0021 iii Gane aaeeets 3 80  Input Frequency Tsp Ay ists acc cunts sever later shee jean es Racer od eth oatenees 3 80  Temp  rat  re Calibration    avctiteai ites A i man ateds Gee 3 81  Analog Output Calibrations  csccsccesictss Gacosasessore Ssssersasisuveee aosdeds cant 3 81  Analog Output Calibrate Zero  ii cseceteiaecdtiiad idee 3 82  Analog Output Calibrate Full Scale              eceseseserseneseerereeeeneese 3 82  Analog Input Calibration wiiciiscscvr
126. ated with that index number  available for selection in the current  mode  determined by single dual auto  gas mode  for analog output  digital  output and digital inputs  The index number is used to insert the variable  in a field location in a list using    set sp field index     The example below  reports the list of analog output  index numbers  and variables     Send  list var aout  Receive  list var aout  index variable  O none   1 no   2 no2   3 nox   18 intt   19 rctt   20 pmtt   21 convt   25 pres   26 smplf   27 pmtv   28 aint   29 ain2   30 ain3   31 ain4   32 ains   33 ain6   34 ain7   35 aing       relay stat   This command reports the current relay logic normally    open    or normally     closed     if all the relays are set to same state  that is all open or all closed   The example below shows that the status when all the relays logic is set to  normally    open        Send  relay stat  Receive  relay stat open    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 45    C Link Protocol Commands  Record Layout Definition    Record Layout  Definition    B 46 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Note If individual relays have been assigned different logic then the  response would be a 4 digit hexadecimal string with the least significant  byte  LSB  being relay no 1  A    For example     Receive  relay stat 0x0001  indicates relay no 1 is set to  normally open logic  all others are normally closed    Receive  relay stat 0x0005  indicates 
127. ation        The commands can be sent in either uppercase or lowercase characters   Each command must begin with the proper instrument identification  number  ASCII  character  The command in the example below begins  with the ASCII character code 170 decimal  which directs the command to  the Model 427 Trace Level  and is terminated by a carriage return    CR      ASCII character code 13 decimal      If an incorrect command is sent  a    bad command    message will be  received  The example below sends the incorrect command    set unit ppm     instead of the correct command    set gas unit ppb        Send  set unit ppb  Receive  set unit ppb bad cmd    The    save    and    set save params    commands stores parameters in FLASH   It is important that each time instrument parameters are changed  that this  command be sent  If changes are not saved  they will be lost in the event of  a power failure     Streaming data is sent out the serial port or the Ethernet port on a user   defined periodic basis  Streaming data over Ethernet is only generated when  a connection is made on TCP port 9881     Table B 1 lists the 42i Trace Level C Link protocol commands  The  interface will respond to the command strings outlined below     Table B   1  C Link Protocol Commands             Command Description Page  addr dns Reports sets domain name server address for Ethernet port B 38  addr gw Reports sets default gateway address for Ethernet port B 38  addr ip Reports sets IP address for Eth
128. ay IH spun sep  129 pg Indu  ainssald 0197 10 929131d Byuod O I  809    ON I8D 4209    ON  juawinysu y2ojun 1eD mo 4 dw  Auod MO 4 s6um  s wwog 4209 7ON e9 4209    ON s    uey Wojsnd   S  piomsseg 3A0WY 1e9 ainssaig dwiay 13 009 ainsseig sbuijes BulbBboyeyeq 4209 ON IPD 4209 ON abuey  ON  piomsseg afueyD dw    jag AuoD dw    1  qwey 9 sdwat apow uey oiny 6y ON IPD Byg 10 98  131d aBuey    ON  quewinsysu  4907 yajas   po ebuey due  jeuse uy sabeyjo  Aiddng 1da yg ON e9 Byg    ON     uey ON  PIOMSSEd 18S  py eBeyon Ld p3 934  q swuejy uors434 wes6Old 10 euozO Byg 10 92  131d 1V9 6  q ON awit Bay sun seg  s  01 u09  10 9e4 out  PIOMSSEd 21M5 SUMEIY soysoubelq quawinsjsu  HORES  uonesqueo   GulBeroay     ebuey  nue uen  uaaiog uny  u    19S  1S  1 H  S  u    19    dn 13M0d             Figure 3 3  Flowchart of Menu Driven Software    3 5    Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Software Overview    Power Up Screen The Power Up screen is displayed on power up of the Model 42i Trace  Level  The Self Test is displayed while the internal components are  warming up and diagnostic checks are performed     Thermo    na 0   O a nd a    iSeries       Run Screen The Run screen displays the NO  NO    and NO  concentrations  The  status bar displays optional zero span solenoid valves  if installed  time  and  alarm status  The word    SAMPLE    on the bottom left of the display  indicates the analyzer has the span zero valve option and is in    SAM
129. ay easily scratch the  plate  a    Do not use alcohol  acetone  MEK or other Ketone based or aromatic  solvents to clean the module  use a soft cloth moistened with a naphtha  cleaning solvent   amp     Do not place the module near organic solvents or corrosive gases  A  Do not shake or jolt the module  A  1  Turn instrument OFF  unplug the power cord  and remove the cover     2  Disconnect the ribbon cable and the two wire connector from the front    panel board   3  Remove the four screws at the corners of the LCD module   4  Slide the LCD module out towards the right of the instrument     5  Replace the LCD module by following previous steps in reverse     Service Locations For additional assistance  service is available from exclusive distributors  worldwide  Contact one of the phone numbers below for product support  and technical information or visit us on the web at www thermo com aqi     1 866 282 0430 Toll Free  1 508 520 0430 International    7 50 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Chapter 8  System Description    This chapter describes the function and location of the system components   provides an overview of the software structure  and includes a description  of the system electronics and input output connections and functions as  follows     e    Hardware    on page 8 1  e    Software    on page 8 4  e    Electronics    on page 8 6    e    I O Components    on page 8 9    Hardware   Model 42  Trace Level hardware components  Fi
130. both ends of the scrubber     7 40 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  I O Expansion Board  Optional  Replacement    3  Pull the scrubber off the mounting clips   4  Push the replacement scrubber into the mounting clips     5  Attach the Teflon tubing at both ends of the scrubber     6  Replace the cover        Ammonia Scrubber             r gt   g    Ge Bs                   Figure 7   18  Replacing the Scrubber    1 0 Expansion Use the following procedure to replace the optional I O expansion board    Fi    19    Board  Optional  C        Replacement   a  Pment Required   I O expansion board    Nut driver  3 16 inch    i Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small    amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    1  Turn instrument OFF  unplug the power cord  and remove the cover     2  Unplug the I O expansion board cable from the EXPANSION BD    connector on the motherboard     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 41    Servicing  1 0 Expansion Board  Optional  Replacement    3  Remove the two standoffs holding the I O expansion board connector  to the rear panel  Figure 7   20      4  Pop off the board from the mounting studs and remove the board   5  To install the I O expansion board  follow previous steps in reverse     6  Calibrate the analog current outputs and analog voltage inputs as  d
131. brate Full Scale     3 82 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Service Menu       ORE meh dt  PPP LES mie AG          Analog Input Calibration The Analog Input Calibration menu is a selection of 8 analog inputs  if the  I O expansion board option is installed  to calibrate  and allows the user to  select the calibration action zero or span  The analog input calibration is  visible only when the instrument is in service mode  For more information  on the service mode  see    Service Mode    earlier in the chapter     Note This adjustment should only be performed by an instrument service  technician  A    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Analog Input Calibration             Wi mpini    SHIRDI CHET mT coor  Bast    ad EME hee TEEN EE    BPs EEE TE Sasad Bone ETET Aad lt aks             Analog Input Calibrate The Analog Input Calibrate Zero screen allows the user to calibrate the  Zero zero state of the selected analog input     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 83    Operation  Service Menu    Analog Input Calibrate  Full Scale    Ozonator Safety    3 84 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Analog Input Calibration  gt  Select  Channel  gt  Calibrate Zero   Hook up a voltage source of 0 V to the  analog input channel            ip pirri  PIL i          The Analog Input Calibration Full Scale screen allows the user to calibrate  the full scale state of 
132. bration  Calibration    Calibrate the NO Channel to the  NO Calibration Gas    Use the following procedure to calibrate the NO channel to the NO    calibration gas     l     Allow the analyzer to sample the NO calibration gas until the NO   NO   and NO  readings have stabilized     When the responses stabilize  from the Main Menu  choose Calibration     gt  Cal NO Coefficient     The NO line of the Calibrate NO screen displays the current NO  concentration  The SPAN CONC line of the display is where you enter  the NO calibration gas concentration     Use  _       to move the cursor left and right and use          to increment and decrement the numeric character at the cursor     Press to calculate and save the new NO coefficient based on the    entered span concentration     The NO recorder response will equal      INO lour  R    Recorder Response    scale    x 100   Zno    Where     URL   Nominal upper range limit of the NO channel  ppm    Record the  NO our concentration and the analyzer NO response as  indicated by the recorder response     Calibrate the NO  Channel to the Use the following procedure to calibrate the NO  channel to the NOx  NO  Calibration Gas calibration gas     4 12 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    1     Press  _      to return to the Calibration menu  and choose Cal NOx  Coefficient     Verify that the NO  calibration gas concentration is the same as the  NO calibration gas concentration plus any known NO  impurity     The NO  line of the Cal
133. cccececcccscescessscssesceseetsteseetesseteseeteseeeeneaess 7 7  Figure 7 3  Removing the Measurement Bench and Lowering the Partition   e e EE E A E elt ei tra TS tees  Aicccibed picked Ce 7 8  Figure 7   4  Replacing the PUMP    ceceesescetesesescetesesestetesesesteeseseees 7 10  Figure 7   5  Vacuum Pump     Head Plate and Motor View          ccccccceneees 7 13  Figure 7   6  Replacing the Fan    ccc ccccecesesescetesesestetesesestetesssesteessseees 7 14  Figure 7 7  PMT Cooler and Reaction Chamber              cccccccccscecesteceteeeteeee 7 16  Figure 7 8  Replacing the PMT uo    ccc ceceesessetesesesteesssesteeseseeteneseseaes 7 17  Figure 7   9  Replacing the PMT HVPS    no i 7 19  Figure 7 10  Cleaning or Removing the Reaction Chamber               0 c ccc  7 2   Figure 7 11  NO  to NO Molybdenum Converter Assembly              00cccc  7 23  Figure 7 12  Replacing the Solenoid Valve ou    ccccccccccccecceesteseeteseeteeeeeeees 7 24  Figure 7 13  Replacing the Ozonator Assembly           0 ccccccccccscececteceteeeteeee 7 26  Figure 7   14  Replacing the Input Board oo    ccc cecccececesesestetesesesteteseseees 7 28  Figure 7 15  Replacing the DC Power Supply           c  ccccccccccsceesseseeteeeeeeees 7 30    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual xv    Figures    xvi    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Figure 7 16  Rear Panel Analog Input and Output Pins    cece 7 31  Figure 7   17  Replacing the Pressure Transducer            c cccccccesescecesesesteteses
134. ceive  7   transmit  3   transmit  5 ground    An RJ45 connector is used for the 10Mbs Ethernet connection supporting  TCP IP communications via standard IPV4 addressing  The IP address  may be configured for static addressing or dynamic addressing  set using a  DHCP server      Any serial port protocols may be accessed over Ethernet in addition to the  serial port     The external accessory connector is not used in the Model 42i analyzer     This port is used in other models to communicate with smart external  devices that may be mounted hundreds of feet from the analyzer using an  RS 485 electrical interface     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Internal Zero Span  and Sample Valves    Ozonator Permeation    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Dryer    Chapter 9  Optional Equipment    The Model 427 Trace Level is available with the following options   e    Internal Zero Span and Sample Valves    on page 9 1  e    Ozonator Permeation Dryer    on page 9 1   e    Ammonia Scrubber    on page 9 2   e    Teflon Particulate Filter    on page 9 2   e    Ozone Particulate Filter    on page 9 2   e    NO2 to NO Converter    on page 9 2   e    I O Expansion Board Assembly    on page 9 2   e    Terminal Block and Cable Kits    on page 9 2   e    Cables    on page 9 3   e    Mounting Options    on page 9 4    With the zero span assembly option  a source of span gas is connected to  the SPAN port and a source of zero air is connected to the ZERO port   Zero and span gas should be supplied at atmospher
135. cessor that also controls the front panel user interface  The low level  processors all run a common piece of firmware that is bundled with the  high level firmware and loaded on power up if a different version is  detected     Each board has a specific address that is used to identify to the firmware  what functions are supported on that board  This address is also used for  the communications between the low level processors and the high level  processor     Every tenth of a second the frequency counters  analog I O  and digital I O  are read and written to by the low level processor  The counters are  accumulated over the past second and the analog inputs are averaged over  that second  The high level processor polls the low level processors once  per second to exchange the measurement and control data     Signals are gathered from the low level processors once per second  and  then processed by the high level processor to produce the final  measurement values  The one second accumulated counts representing the  NO NO  are accumulated and reported for the user specified averaging  time  If this averaging time is greater than ten seconds  the measurement is  reported every 10 seconds  The one second average of the other analog  inputs are reported directly  no additional signal conditioning is performed  by the high level processor      In auto mode  every ten seconds the NO  NO  solenoid switches and the  processor waits three seconds for the reaction chamber to flush and 
136. commands set the instrument to local or remote mode  The example  below sets the instrument to the local mode     Send  set mode local  Receive  set mode local ok    program no  This command reports the analyzer   s model information and program  version number  which will be dependant on the current version     Send  program no  Receive  program no iSeries 42iTL 01 03 21 154    set layout ack    This command disables the stale layout layout change indicator           that is  attached to each response if the layout has changed     Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual B 41    C Link Protocol Commands  1 0 Configuration    1 0 Configuration    B 42 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Send  set layout ack  Receive  set layout ack ok    analog iout range channel   This command reports the analog current output range setting for channels   where channel must be between 1 and 6  inclusive  The example below  reports current output channel 4 to the 4 20 mA range  according to Table  B 9  This command responds with    feature not enabled    if the I O  expansion board is not detected     Send  analog iout range 4  Receive  analog iout range 4 2    set analog iout range channel range   This command sets analog current output channel to the channel range  where channel is between 1 and 6 inclusive  and range is set according to  Table B   9  The example below sets current output channel 4 to the 0 20  mA range  This command responds with    feature not enabled    if the I 
137. converted to    NO by a molybdenum NO gt  to NO converter heated to about 325   C     The ambient air sample is drawn into the Model 427 Trace Level through  the sample bulkhead  as shown in Figure 1 1  The sample flows through a  capillary  and then to the mode solenoid valve     The mode solenoid valve determines whether the sample flows through the  NO gt  to NO converter  NOx mode  or bypasses the NO2 toNO converter   NO mode   The sample then flows through the converter output valve  and a flow sensor to the prereactor solenoid valve     The prereactor solenoid valve directs the sample either to the reaction  chamber  where it mixes with ozone to give an NO reading  or to the  prereactor  where it reacts with ozone prior to the reaction chamber giving  a dynamic zero reading for the analyzer  The prereactor is sized so that  greater the 99  of a 200 ppb NO sample will react prior to entering the  reaction chamber  yet is small enough to allow other potential interferents  to pass through to the reaction chamber     Dry air enters the Model 427 Trace Level through the dry air bulkhead   passes through a flow switch  and then through a silent discharge ozonator   The ozonator generates the ozone needed for the chemiluminescent  reaction  At the reaction chamber  the ozone reacts with the NO in the  sample to produce excited NO  molecules  A photomultiplier tube  PMT   housed in a thermoelectric cooler detects the luminescence generated  during this reaction     Thermo Fish
138. cover     2  Disconnect the plumbing connections from the flow transducer  Note  the plumbing connections to facilitate reconnection        aS    Figure 7 22  Replacing the Flow Transducer    3  Disconnect the flow transducer cable from the measurement interface    board     4  Loosen the two retaining nuts securing the flow transducer to the  ozonator bracket and remove the flow transducer     5  To install the flow transducer  follow previous steps in reverse     6  Calibrate the flow transducer  Refer to the    Flow Transducer  Calibration    procedure that follows     Flow Transducer Use the following procedure to calibrate the flow transducer   Calibration Equipment Required     Calibrated flow sensor    7 46 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  Flow Transducer Calibration    WARNING The service procedures in this manual are restricted to qualified  service representatives   amp     If the equipment is operated in a manner not specified by the  manufacturer  the protection provided by the equipment may be  impaired  A    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    1  Remove the cover     2  Disconnect the pump cable from AC PUMP connector on the  measurement interface board     3  From the Main Menu  press      to scroll to Service  gt  press  gt   
139. cted from the partially  corrected NO  value to yield an uncorrected NO  value  The NO  value is  then corrected for converter efficiency to give a corrected NO  reading   Finally  the corrected NO  reading is added to the corrected NO reading to  yield a fully corrected NOx value     The front panel display  serial and Ethernet data ports  and analog outputs  are the means of communicating the results of the above calculations  The  front panel display presents the NO  NOz  and NO  concentrations  simultaneously  The display is updated every 1 10 seconds  depending on  the averaging time     The analog output ranges are user selectable via software  The analog  outputs are defaulted based on the measurement range  The defaults are  calculated by dividing the data values by the full scale range for each of the  three parameters and then multiplying each result by the user selected  output range  Negative concentrations can be represented as long as they  are within  5  of full scale  The zero and span values may be set by the  user to any desired value     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 8 5    System Description  Electronics    Electronics    Motherboard    External Connectors    Internal Connectors    8 6 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    All electronics operate from a universal switching supply  which is capable  of auto sensing the input voltage and working over the entire operating  range     Internal pumps and heaters all operate on 110VAC  An optiona
140. d number  4 bytes    L   parse a 32 bit unsigned number  4 bytes     There is an optional single digit d which may follow any of the numeric  fields which indicates that after the field has been parsed out  the resulting  value is to be divided by 104d  Thus the 16 bit field OxFFC6 would be  interpreted with the format specifier  n3  as the number  0 058     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 47    C Link Protocol Commands  Record Layout Definition    Format Specifier for  EREC Layout    Text    Value String    Value Source    B 48 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    The subsequent lines in the ERec Layout response describe the appearance  of the full panel  The full instrument panel as it appears on the screen has  two columns of lines  Each line is composed of three major components    1  a text field   2  a value field  and  3  a button  None of these three  components is required  The text field contains statically displayed text     The value field displays values which are parsed out of the response to a  DATA ERec command  It also displays  though background changes   alarm status  The button  when pressed  triggers input from either a dialog  box or a selection list  There are five kinds of buttons  B  I  L  T  and N     Each line in the layout string corresponds to one line on the display  The  layout string describes each of the three major fields as well as translation  mechanisms and corresponding commands     The first field in the layout string i
141. d to change  the minimum internal temperature alarm limit  The minimum and  maximum internal temperature screens function the same way     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Internal Temp  gt  Min or Max        The Chamber Temperature screen displays the current chamber  temperature and sets the minimum and maximum alarm limits  Acceptable  alarm limits range from 47 to 51   C  If the chamber temperature reading  goes beyond either the minimum or maximum limit  an alarm is activated   The word    ALARM    appears in the Run screen and in the Main Menu     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Chamber Temp     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Alarms Menu       Min and Max Chamber The Minimum Chamber Temperature alarm limit screen is used to change  Temperature Limits the minimum chamber temperature alarm limit  The minimum and  maximum chamber temperature screens function the same way     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Chamber Temp  gt  Min or Max        Cooler Temperature The Cooler Temperature screen displays the current cooler temperature    and sets the minimum and maximum alarm limits  Acceptable alarm limits  range from  40 to 10   C  If the cooler temperature reading goes beyond  either the minimum or maximum limit  an alarm is activated  The word     ALARM    appears in the Run screen and in the Main Menu     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Cooler Temp        Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 65    Operation  Alar
142. display  the number of records back to view     3 28 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu        tsi    EDN PUHE Eet Bene ETET hei Bast    ade 5       pede       The Record Display screen  read only  displays the selected records        Penemu OE TE bei  ETE T Suad baee PEYRE E N Pi eo          Date and Time The Date and Time screen is used to set a start date and time for which to  view logged data  For example  if    20 JUN 2005 10 00    is entered  then  the first logged data record that is displayed is the first record after this  time  If set to one minute logging  this would be at    20 JUN 2005 10 01           RCRSE Crs mito    WH mpini  E PORE TE Aad foose PEO Fad he A Feed E deed Fat ETE       The Record Display screen  read only  displays the selected records     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 29    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu       Erase Log The Erase Log is used to erase all saved data for the selected record type   not all short records and long records      e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Datalogging Settings   gt  Erase Log        Wi mid  Pin Paid       Select Content The Select Content submenu displays a list of 32 record fields to use and a  submenu list of the analog output signal group choices to choose from   Choices are Concentrations  Other Measurements  and Analog Inputs  if  the I O expansion board is installed   This is a
143. e 2 4  Figure 2 5  1 0 Terminal Board Views          c cccccccccscscesescesestesesteeeteeeteseeeeneaees 2 6  Figure 2   6  D O Terminal Board ViGWS         0 c ccccccccccsescesescetestetesteeeteeeeeneeee 2 7  Figure 2 7  25 Pin Terminal Board VIeWs         c cccccccscecsscsescetesesescetesesesteeseseees 2 8  Figure 3 1  Front Panel Display    cccccecccesceceeceescseeceseseseeceseseseeteneseseees 3 2  Figure 3 2  Front Panel PUSNDUttONS        ccc cc ceceseseetetesesesteesesesteeseseees 3 2  Figure 3 3  Flowchart of Menu Driven Software           cccccccccceceesteteteeeeeeee 3 5  Figure 3   4  Pin Out of Rear Panel Connector in Single Range Mode                 3 9  Figure 3   5  Pin Out of Rear Panel Connector in Dual Range Mode                 3 10  Figure 3   6  Analog Output in Auto Range Mode    cccccccececeeceteeeteeee 3 11  Figure 3 7  Pin Out of Rear Connector in Auto Range Mode              cccce  3 12  Figure 4   1  GPT System    c c cccccccccccccesssescesssssesteseseseseseeeseetessetesseteseaeeneeess 4 3  Figure 5 1  Inspecting and Replacing the Capillaries 00 0 0    5 3  Figure 5 2  Rebuilding the PUMP              ccccsceceesceceteseseeceseseseeteseseseeteneseseees 5 6  Figure 6   1  Board Level Connection Diagram   Common Electronics                6 6  Figure 6 2  Board Level Connection Diagram   Measurement System             6 7  Figure 7   1  Properly Grounded Antistatic Wrist Strap      0  0 cccceccccececeeeteee 7 4  Figure 7 2  Component Layout          c c
144. e B 17   e    Datalogging    on page B 17   e    Calibration    on page B 25   e    Keys Display    on page B 29   e    Measurement Configuration    on page B 31   e    Hardware Configuration    on page B 34   e    Communications Configuration    on page B 38  e    I O Configuration    on page B 42   e    Record Layout Definition    on page B 46    Each command sent to the analyzer over the serial port must begin with the  American Standard Code for Information Interchange  ASCII  symbol or  byte value equivalent of the instrument s identification number plus 128   For example  if the instrument ID is set to 25  then each command must  begin with the ACSI  character code 153 decimal  The analyzer ignores any  command that does not begin with its instrument identification number  If  the instrument ID is set to 0  then this byte is not required  For more  information on changing Instrument ID  see Chapter 3     Operation        Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 1    C Link Protocol Commands  Commands    Commands    Accessing Streaming  Data    Commands List    B 2 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    The analyzer must be in the remote mode in order to change instrument  parameters via remote  However  the command    set mode remote    can be  sent to the analyzer to put it in the remote mode  Report commands   commands that don   t begin with    set     can be issued either in the remote  or local mode  For information on changing modes  see Chapter 3      Oper
145. e NO responses   Measure and record Fno and Fr for each NO concentration generated     Plot the analyzer NO response versus Fno Fr and determine the slope  which gives  NO srp directly  The analyzer NO  responses to the  generated NO concentrations reflect any NO2 impurity in the NO  working standard     Plot the difference between the analyzer NOx and NO responses versus  Fyo Fr  The slope of this plot is  NOz imp     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 4 5    Calibration  Equipment Required    Zero Air    Dynamic Parameter  Specifications for  Gas Titrator    Determining GPT System  Flow Conditions    4 6 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    A source of zero air free of contaminants should be used as described earlier  in this chapter  Contaminants can cause a detectable response on the  instrument and may also react with the NO  O3  or NO   during the gas  phase titration     Use the following definitions for the remainder of this chapter     Pr   Dynamic parameter specification to ensure complete reaction of the  available Os  ppm min    NOlrc   NO concentration in the reaction chamber  ppm   tk   residence time of the reactant gases in the reaction chamber  min    NO stp   Concentration of the undiluted NO standard  ppm   Fro   NO flow rate  sccm   Fo   O  generator air flow rate  sccm   Vre   Volume of the reaction chamber  cc   Fr   Analyzer demand plus 10 to 50  excess    The Os generator  ozonator  airflow rate and the NO flow rate must be  adjusted such 
146. e example below shows the  coefficient screen in dual auto range mode     Note The concentration value will show    ERROR     if the measured  concentration is not a valid span value  either higher than the selected  range  or 0 or lower   A    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Calibration Factors  gt  NO  NO2  or NOx  Coef        Calibration Pressure The Calibration Pressure screen reports the reactor pressure at which  current calibration was performed  The screen also allows this value to be  edited by the operator  This value should not be changed unless a complete  manual calibration is being performed  The calibration pressure is set equal  to the reactor pressure at the time of calibration  The acceptable range for  calibration pressure is between 200 and 450 mmHg     Note Turning the pressure compensation ON and OFF can produce  significant artificial jumps in the apparent sample concentration  If the  pressure compensation feature is to be used  the instrument must be  calibrated with the pressure compensation feature ON  For more  information about calibration  see Chapter 4     Calibration     A    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 19    Operation  Calibration Menu    3 20    Reset User Calibration    Default        BUSSE EE Sasad Boes    Calibration  Menu    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    ao ees Py tit  mG et i        The Reset User Calibration Default screen allows the user to reset the  calibration configuration values to f
147. e handling converter    components  A    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap    must be worn while handling any internal component  A    l     Turn instrument OFF  unplug the power cord  and remove the cover     Allow converter to cool to room temperature to prevent contact with  heated components     Disconnect plumbing at converter inlet and outlet     Disconnect thermocouple leads and heater connector from temperature  control board     Loosen the four captive screws holding converter housing to floor plate     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  Solenoid Valve Replacement    Top Housing Assembly    Heater Assembly         lt      ______ Thermocouple Leads  and Heater Connector    Bottom Housing Assembly    0      P    Captive Screws  4      8y    Figure 7   11  NO2 to NO Molybdenum Converter Assembly    6  Remove the six screws holding the top housing assembly to the bottom    half     7  Remove the converter cartridge heater assembly from the bottom  housing assembly     8  Loosen the heater clamp  pry heater apart no wider than necessary and  remove the converter cartridge noting the proper orientation of heater  wires and thermocouple probe     9  To replace converter  follow previous steps in reverse  Note Be sure to  wrap the O  converter tube snugly around the heater     Solenoid Valve Use the following procedure to replace a solenoid valve  Figure 7   12    R
148. e p lacement Equipment Required     Solenoid valve  Wrench  5 16 inch    Philips screwdriver    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 23    Servicing  Solenoid Valve Replacement    7 24   Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    Refer to    Removing the Measurement Bench and Lowering the  Partition Panel    in this chapter to lower the partition panel  then  proceed to the next step below     Disconnect solenoid from the Measurement Interface board  Note  electrical connections to facilitate re connection     Remove plumbing from solenoid  Note plumbing connections to  facilitate re connection     Pull solenoid valve from mounting clip   To replace solenoid  follow previous steps in reverse     Re install the measurement bench  Refer to    Removing the  Measurement Bench and Lowering the Partition Panel    in this chapter        Figure 7   12  Replacing the Solenoid Valve    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  Ozonator Assembly Replacement    Ozonator Assembly Use the following procedure to replace the ozonator assembly  Figure 7       Replacement       Equipment Required     Ozonator assembly  Wrench  5 8 inch    Philips screwdriver    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly g
149. e reaction     NO 03  gt  NO2 0O2 hv    The quantitative nature of this reaction is such that when the NO  concentration is known  the concentration of NO  can be determined   Ozone is added to excess NO in a dynamic calibration system  and the NO  channel of the chemiluminescence NO  NO NO  analyzer is used as an  indicator of changes in NO concentration     When O  is added  the decrease in NO concentration observed on the  calibrated NO channel is equivalent to the concentration of NO2  produced  Adding variable amounts of O3 from a stable O3 generator can  change the amount of NO  generated  The following sections discuss the  required apparatus and procedures for calibrating the instrument     e    Equipment Required    on page 4 1   e    Pre Calibration    on page 4 8   e    Calibration    on page 4 9   e    Calibration in Dual Range and Auto Range Mode    on page 4 16  e    Zero and Span Check    on page 4 20    The following equipment is required to calibrate the analyzer     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 4 1    Calibration  Equipment Required    Zero Gas Generator    Compression    Drying    Oxidation    Scrubbing    4 2 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    e Zero gas generator    e Gas phase titrator    A zero air source  such as a Thermo Scientific Model 111 Zero Air Supply or  Model 1160 Zero Air Supply  free of contaminants such as NO  NOs  and    O  is required for dilution  calibration  and gas phase titration     The zero air source should be
150. e the three ribbon cables and the two wire connector from the  front panel board     3  Pop off the board from the two top mounting studs and remove the  board by lifting it up and off the slotted bottom support     4  Replace the front panel board by following previous steps in reverse     7 48 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Mounting Studs  2     Ribbon Cables  3   lt  lt     LCD Module  Replacement    A  A    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  LCD Module Replacement  LCD Module    LCD Module Screws  2   Retaining Screw        Front Panel Board       Two Wire Connector    Z          Bottom Support  Figure 7 23  Replacing the Front Panel Board and the LCD Module  Use the following procedure to replace the LCD module  Figure 7 23    Equipment Required     LCD module    Philips screwdriver    CAUTION If the LCD panel breaks  do not to let the liquid crystal contact  your skin or clothes  If the liquid crystal contacts your skin or clothes  wash  it off immediately using soap and water  A    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    Do not remove the panel or frame from the module  A    The polarizing plate is very fragile  handle it carefully  a    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 49    Servicing  Service Locations    Do not wipe the polarizing plate with a dry cloth  it m
151. ec per    and    set  srec per    commands  In dual range  the long records and short records  contain the high and low NO and NO  concentrations  In single range the  low NO and low NOx values are set to 0 and the high NO and high NOx  are used  In NO or NO  only mode  the pertinent high value used  other  concentrations are set to 0  Concentrations are stored in either ppb or  pg m     In the following example  there are 740 long records currently stored in  memory  When the command Irec 100 5 is sent  the instrument counts    back 100 records from the last record collected  record 740   and then  returns 5 records  640  641  642  643  and 644  For details on how to    decode the flag fields within these records  see the    flags    command     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Datalogging    Send  lrec 5   Receive  lrec 100 5   11 03 02 22 03 flags 54089100 no 8416E 1 nox 8458E 1  lono 6474E 1 lonox 6506E 1 pres 131 4 pmtt 53 1 intt  80 0 rctt 80 0 convt 61 smplf 0 500 ozonf 0 000 pmtv    116   11 04 02 22 03 flags 54089100 no 8421E 1 nox 8457E 1  lono 6477E 1 lonox 6505E 1 pres 131 5 pmtt 53 1 intt  80 0 rctt 80 0 convt 61 smplf 0 500 ozonf 0 000 pmtv    116   11 05 02 22 03 flags 54089100 no 8440E 1 nox 8456E 1  lono 6492E 1 lonox 6505E 1 pres 131 5 pmtt 53 2 intt  80 0 rctt 80 0 convt 61 smplf 0 500 ozonf 0 000 pmtv    116   11 06 02 22 03 flags 54089100 no 8432E 1 nox 8483E 1  lono 6486E 1 lonox 6525E 1 pres 133 0 pmtt 53
152. ed  unplug the fan  power cord if necessary        T        ima ni Ll4 PMT Cover Plate Screws  6       O i o4   1_     PMT Shroud Screws  4                             olle ejjo PMT Base Screws  3   PMT Base Assembly     o   i                        e       Figure 7 8  Replacing the PMT    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 17    Servicing  PMT High Voltage Power Supply Replacement    A    PMT High Voltage  Power Supply  Replacement    A    7 18 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    4  Remove the three retaining screws holding PMT base assembly to the  cooler using a 5 16 inch nut driver     Equipment Damage Do not point the photomultiplier tube at a light  source  This can permanently damage the tube  A    5  Pull the PMT and PMT base from cooler assembly by twisting it  slightly back and forth     6  To install PMT  follow previous steps in reverse making sure to backfill  the cooler with dry air or nitrogen prior to replacing the PMT     7  Perform a photomultiplier tube calibration  See    PMT Voltage  Adjustment    in the    Operation    chapter     Use the following procedure to replace the PMT high voltage power supply   Figure 7 9      Equipment Required   PMT high voltage power supply  Nut driver  1 4 inch    Philips screwdriver    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component   amp     1  Turn instrument OFF
153. ed Antistatic Wrist Strap       The firmware can be updated by the user in the field via the serial port or  over the Ethernet  This includes both the main processor firmware and the  firmware in all low level processors  Refer to the   Port manual for the  firmware update procedure     If the Service Menu is not displayed on the Main Menu  use the following  procedure to display it     1  At the Main Menu  press  _ _  to scroll to Instrument Controls  gt   press  gt  _    to scroll to Service Mode  gt  and press           The Service Mode screen appears   2  Press to toggle the Service Mode to ON     3  Press        gt        toreturn to the Main Menu     4  Return to the procedure     Table 7   1 lists the replacement parts for the Model 427 Trace Level major  subassemblies  Refer to Figure 7 2 to identify the component location     Table 7 1  Model 42i Trace Level Replacement Parts                   Part Number Description   100480 00 Front Panel Pushbutton Board  101491 04 Processor Board   100533 00 Motherboard   100539 00 Digital Output Board  100542 00 1 0 Expansion Board  Optional   102340 00 Front Panel Connector Board          Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  Replacement Parts List                                                                                                       Part Number Description  102496 00 Front Panel Display  101399 00 Transformer  220 240VAC  Optional   101863 00 Transformer  100VAC  Optional   100536 00
154. eee 7 4  Table 7 2  Model 42i Trace Level Cables    ccecccccceseeseeseseeseeteeteeteseeseesee 7 6  Table 7 3  External Device Connection Component               cccccccceeseeneeeeees 7 6  Table 7   4  Analog Output Channels and Rear Panel Pin Connections              7 32  Table 7 5  Analog Input Channels and Rear Panel Pin Connections                7 32  Table 8 1  RS 232 DB Connector Pin Configurations 0 0 00    8 12  Table 8 2  RS 485 DB Connector Pin Configuration             ccccececeeeceeeeeeees 8 12  Table 9   1  Cable 0  9  U6  9 arene met ne en vn DT OTE re Pe  9 3  Table 9 2  Color Codes for 25 Pin and 37 Pin Cables oo    cece 9 3  Table 9 3  Mounting Options 00 0    cccsscesescsseseessseseesesesesesseseseseeeeees 9 4  Table B 1  C Link Protocol Commands            c cceccccceceesesteseeseeeseeseeteetesteseesee B 2  Table B   2  Averaging Times           cccceccccscecesesesceesesesceseseseeceeseseaceseseseecenenees B 10  Table B   3  Alarm Trigger Values         ccc ceccccccecesesescetesesescetesesesteteseseeteenees B 17  Table B   4  Record Output Formats       0    ccccecccccccscescscesestesestesesteseeteseseseeeeees B 22  Table B   5  Stream Time Values           cccceccecsccecessesseseesesseesesteseeseeseenssteseesens B 25    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual xvii    Tables    xviii    Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    Table B   6  Standard Ranges wie seice 0e cu0r c cevcrctsseor teteuorvtas sinned steer cas teeters  B 31  Table B 7  Contrast L
155. eees 7 36  Figure 7 18  Replacing the Scrubber    ccc cccccccccscecesceeeeetesteeeteteeeeneeee 7 41  Figure 7   19  Replacing the I O Expansion Board  Optional          0 0  ccccccee  7 42  Figure 7 20  Rear Panel Board Connectors           ccceccccsccsceescesestestetesteteeeeeeee 7 42  Figure 7 21  Replacing the Measurement Interface Board             cccececeeee 7 45  Figure 7   22  Replacing the Flow Transducer         7 46  Figure 7 23  Replacing the Front Panel Board and the LCD Module                7 49  Figure 8   1  Hardware Components              ccccccccsceescssestesestesestesesteseeteseeesesseees 8 2  Figure 9 2  Rack Mount Option Assembly 0 00 0    ce cccccsceccsceesceseeteseeteseeteseeseees 9 5  Figure 9 3  Bench WOURtING 252th tt ee es a 9 6  Figure 9   4  EIA Rack MOUNTING    ccc cc cecesescecesesescetesesestetesesesteseseseateenees 9 7  Figure 9   5  Retrofit Rack MOUNTING    cc cceccccecesesescetesesestetesesesteeseseeteenens 9 8  Fig  re  gt  Sct Fl s amp s RES REDS EDS RE SE aS B 13    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Tables    Tables    Table 1 1  Model 42i Trace Level Specifications    ccccccccccceeeseeesteeeteees 1 3  Table 2 1    O Terminal Board Pin Descriptions         0  ccccccccsccsesteesteseeteseeeees 2 6  Table 2 2  D O Terminal Board Pin DeScriptions          0 cccccccccceccseeesteesteseeteees 2 7  Table 2 3  25 Pin Terminal Board Pin DeSCriptiOnSs           ccccececsesceteseeeteteees 2 8  Table 3 1  Front Panel Pushbutto
156. efer to       Calibration Factors Menu    in the    Operation    chapter   Set the NO COEF  NO  COEF  and NO  COFF to 1 000     Set the Averaging Time to 10 seconds  Refer to    Averaging Time    in  the    Operation    chapter     Connect the calibration gas and allow the instrument to sample  calibration gas until the reading stabilizes     From the Main Menu  press     _  to scroll to Service  gt  press    _   gt       to scroll to PMT Voltage Adjustment  gt  and press           The Set PMT Voltage screen appears     Note If Service Mode is not displayed  refer to    Accessing the Service  Mode    on page   then return to the beginning of this step  A    7  Atthe Set PMT Voltage screen  use  t   to    increment decrement the counts until the instrument displays the  calibration gas concentration value     Use the following procedure to clean or remove the reaction chamber  see  Figure 7 10      Equipment Required     Allen Wrench  9 64 inch  Wrench  7 16 inch  Wrench  9 16 inch    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    l     Remove PMT cooler as described in    PMT Cooler and Reaction  Chamber Replacement    in this chapter     2  Disconnect all plumbing connections from the reaction chamber     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  Reaction Chamber Cleaning or Removal    3  Remove the three socket head screws fast
157. efined earlier in this chapter          Motherboard    Digital Output Board  1 0 Expansion Board  Opt     1 0 Expansion Board    Motherboard    Digital Output Board    Figure 7 20  Rear Panel Board Connectors    7 42 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Digital Output Board  Replacement    A    Motherboard  Replacement    A    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  Digital Output Board Replacement    Use the following procedure to replace the digital output board  Figure 7     19      Equipment Required   Digital output board  Nut driver  3 16 inch    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    1  Turn instrument OFF  unplug the power cord  and remove the cover     2  Remove the I O expansion board  optional   if used  See the    I O  Expansion Board Replacement    procedure in this chapter     3  Disconnect the digital output board ribbon cable from the  motherboard     4  Using the nut driver  remove the two standoffs securing the board to  the rear panel  Figure 7   20      5  Pop off the digital output board from the mounting studs and remove  the board     6  To install the digital output board  follow previous steps in reverse     Use the following procedure to replace the motherboard  Figure 7 18    Equipment Required   Motherboard   Philips screwdriver    Nut driver  3 16 inch    Equi
158. el Instruction Manual    iSeries Instruments support the MODBUS TCP protocol  The register  definition is the same as for the serial interface     TCP connection port for MODBUS   502    Here are the MODBUS ADU  Application Data Unit  formats over serial  and TCP IP        Serial  Slave Address   Function Code   Data Error Check          TCP IP    MBAP Header   Function Code   Data                      The MODBUS save address is a single byte in length  This is the same as  the instrument ID used for C Link commands and can be between 1 and  127 decimal  i e  0x01 hex to 0x7F hex   This address is only used for  MODBUS RTU over serial connections     Note Device ID    0    used for broadcast MODBUS commands  is not  supported  Device  Ds 128 through 247  i e  0x80 hex to OxF7 hex  are not  supported because of limitations imposed by C Link  A    In MODBUS over TCP IP  a MODBUS Application Protocol Header   MBAP  is used to identify the message  This header consists of the  following components     Transaction Identifier 2 Bytes 0x0000 to OxFFFF  Passed back in response   Protocol Identifier 2 Bytes 0x00  MODBUS protocol    Length 2 Bytes 0x0000 to OxFFFF  Number of following bytes   Unit Identifier 1 Byte 0x00 to OxFF  Passed back in response     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Function Code    Data    Error Check    Function Codes     0x01 0x02  Read Coils      Thermo Fisher Scientific    Read Inputs    MODBUS Protocol  Function Codes    A Slave address is not required in MODBUS
159. end   Receive     set cal pres  set cal pres ok    push button  do  down   en   enter   he   help   le   left   me   menu   ri   right   ru   run    button     do   down   en   enter   he   help   le   left   me   menu   ri   right    ru run up 1 2 3 4      These commands simulate pressing the front panel pushbuttons  The  numbers represent the front panel soft keys  from left to right     Send  push enter  Receive  push enter ok  isc   iscreen    This command retrieves the framebuffer data used for the display on the  iSeries instrument  It is 19200 bytes in size  2 bits per pixel  4 pixels per  byte arranged as 320 by 240 characters  The data is sent in RLE encoded  form to save time in transmission  It is sent as a type  5  binary C Link  response with no checksum     The RLE encoding consists of a 0 followed by an 8 bit count of  consecutive OxFF bytes  The following  c  code will expand the incoming  data     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 29    C Link Protocol Commands  Keys Display    B 30 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    void unpackDisplay   void far  tdib  unsigned char far  rlescreen        int ijk    unsigned char far  sc4bpp   sc2bpp   screen   ptr     ptr   screen    unsigned char far   malloc 19200      RLE decode the screen  for  i 0  i lt 19200  amp  amp   ptr   screen   lt  19200  i          ptrt        rlescreen   i    if    rlescreen   i     0      unsigned char rlecount     unsigned char    rlescreen     i    while  rlecount        p
160. ening front of reaction  chamber to rear  Figure 7 10   This exposes the inner surfaces of both    sections of the reaction chamber and the quartz window  To clean these  surfaces use cotton swabs and methanol     4  To continue removing rear of reaction chamber remove the three  socket head screws holding it to cooler  being careful to keep quartz  window and red filter in cooler body     5  To reinstall reaction chamber  follow previous steps in reverse  making  sure to backfill the cooler with dry air or nitrogen prior to installing  reaction chamber     6  Re install the measurement bench  Refer to    Removing the  Measurement Bench and Lowering the Partition Panel    in this chapter     PMT Cooler    O Ring  2 034     i    Viton Spacer    ta f    a        OOo 5  N Reaction Chamber Rear    a  Quartz Window     i  O Ring  2 127  on                            Figure 7   10  Cleaning or Removing the Reaction Chamber    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 21    Servicing  NO2 to NO Converter Replacement    NO  to NO Converter  Replacement    7 22 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    Use the following procedure to replace the converter  Figure 7   11      Equipment Required     NO gt  to NO Converter  Wrench  7 16 inch  Wrench  9 16 inch  Wrench  1 2 inch  Wrench  5 8 inch  Screwdriver   Nut driver  1 4 inch  Nut driver  5 16 inch    CAUTION Avoid contact with converter heated components  Allow  converter to cool to room temperature befor
161. ent Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    1  Turn instrument OFF  unplug the power cord  and remove the cover     7 26 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Input Board  Replacement    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  Input Board Replacement    2  Remove the ozonator assembly as described in    Ozonator Assembly  Replacement        3  Disconnect the plug connecting the ozonator transformer to the    measurement interface board  OZONATOR connector      4  Remove the four screws holding the ozonator transformer to the  ozonator bracket and remove the ozonator transformer     5  To install the ozonator transformer  follow the previous steps in reverse     6  Re install the measurement bench  Refer to    Removing the  Measurement Bench and Lowering the Partition Panel    in this chapter     Use the following procedure to replace the input board  Figure 7   14    Equipment Required   Input board    Philips screwdriver    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    1  Refer to    Removing the Measurement Bench and Lowering the  Partition Panel    in this chapter to lower the partition panel  then  proceed to the next step below     2  Disconnect
162. entrations  depending on operating mode  From  the Run screen  the Main Menu can be displayed by pressing  _   _   The  Main Menu contains a list of submenus  Each submenu contains related  instrument settings  This chapter describes each submenu and screen in  detail  Refer to the appropriate sections for more information     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation    Software Overview          smeis pg 4x3 O I                                              ainssaid e9    synejeg  ed 19Sp jesay  ainssaig  29                                                                                     I     sns Pg U1    209 xXON 07189 J209 ON 07  snieis gin 909 ON 0712 209    ON O  ouog   eld i  ee on i o a ON a Aerie ey aa na g  3u09 ON  209 XON IH 12D 4209 ON  H  9u0 ON   4209 7ON IH 189 4209    ON  H s    uey Wojysnd 19S  synejaq 1SN a10 say 32u09 ON ojuy yoe U0D   ya09 ON IH IED  209 ON IH abuey ONn 07  1591 1  X  d Aejdsiq 1e20 ny ueds Byuog puawn ysu    644  ON I  e9 Byg 10 923131d     uey ON  H  oney uonni a leoo ny 019Z     s nd no Bojeuy Is   L   w  L   eq   yg ON Ieo Byg XON     uey    ON 07  Ayayeg 10 euozO   9949 ueds saqeig Aejoy apow edimag yg 10 92  1    1d  VI 6g ON abuey    ON  H  leo ndu Bojeuy   9949 013Z syndy jey61a 1Se1 U09 u3319S     uey ON 07  led ndino bojeuy MO 4 40   U0ZO saGeyo  ndul Hojeuy uonesuaduiog said yoayo ueds o1eZ s jnejeqg e9 Jasp jesey   w    Bay 07     uey ON  H  1e9 dua Mold supe  y Indul Gojeuy uonesu  dwog dwa  ainssaid  2D ainssaid  2D   w   1 B
163. er Scientific    Introduction  Specifications    The NO and NO  concentrations calculated in the NO and NO  modes  are stored in memory  The difference between the concentrations is used to  calculate the NO  concentration  The Model 427 Trace Level outputs NO   NO  and NO  concentrations to the front panel display  the analog  outputs  and also makes the data available over the serial or Ethernet  connection                             V2 J12  ro V313                                              rs                               r                      aan          Figure 1 1  Model 42  Trace Level Flow Schematic    Specifications Table 1   1 lists the specifications for the Model 427 Trace Level   Table 1 1  Model 42  Trace Level Specifications    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Preset ranges    0 5  10  20  50  100  200 ppb  0 10  20  50  100  200  500 pg m        Custom ranges    0 50 to 200 ppb  0 10 to 500 ug m        Zero roise    25 ppt RMS  120 second averaging time        Lower detectable limit    50 ppt  120 second averaging time        Zero drift  24 hour     Negligible       Span drift      1  full scale       Response time  in  automatic mode     Linearity    60 seconds  10 second averaging time   90 seconds  60 second averaging time   300 seconds  300 second averaging time       1  full scale       Sample flow rate    1 LPM       Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 1 3    Introduction  Specifications    1 4 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual       Operatin
164. erence to radio communications  Operation of this  equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful interference in  which case the user will be required to correct the interference at his own  expense  A    The following symbol and description identify the WEEE marking used on    the instrument and in the associated documentation     Symbol Description    Marking of electrical and electronic equipment which applies to electrical and  electronic equipment falling under the Directive 2002 96 EC  WEEE  and the   ves     equipment that has been put on the market after 13 August 2005  A    Service is available from exclusive distributors worldwide  Contact one of  the phone numbers below for product support and technical information  or visit us on the web at www thermo com aqi     1 866 282 0430 Toll Free  1 508 520 0430 International    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Chapter 1    Chapter 2    Chapter 3    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Contents    NANCE OC NCES OID a snisicsccnd a sasssctantatdeasssnndinnssstdnentctanaecmonduintesbdnasdusmdassntanauisaussantantidy 1 1  Principle OL Operation antler estes e RENS 1 2  SpECI CAORS aroei tasis esaesa senine danei s A a eee aeee E 1 3  Wap SC GAN RCM ses sich cncn asad snaaa dust dncdct sata conus dbvbas dan casuedicdssuinsuaasuaaeaiasassicanead 2 1  PNE a ce PRN PATS oer Ace EE R OUST EDL EO Pat ES 2 1  Unpacking and Inspection 222s c ctactiasceteiensdewceetaitawtieenicete 2 1  Setup Proced  te scarica ieo teeta ceed weet Eae e
165. ermined by the options installed  Note that  at this point  pressing indicates that these are proposed changes as  opposed to implemented changes  To change the selected record format  and erase record log file data  see    Commit Content    below     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Datalogging Settings   gt  Select Content  gt  Select Field  gt  Other Measurements        Analog Inputs The Analog Inputs screen allows the user to select the output signal  none  or analog inputs 1 8  that is tied to the selected field item  The selected  item is shown by     lt       after it  Note that at this point  pressing  indicates that these are proposed changes as opposed to implemented  changes  To change the selected record format and erase record log file  data  see    Commit Content    below     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Datalogging Settings   gt  Select Content  gt  Select Field  gt  Analog Inputs     3 32 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu       Commit Content The Commit Content screen is used to save the selected output signal that  is tied to the selected field item  If no changes have been made    NO  CHANGES TO RECORD LIST     will appear  For more information    about selecting the analog output signal group choices  see    Select  Content    above     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Datalogging Settings   gt  Commit Content        Reset to Defa
166. ernet port B 38  addr nm Reports sets netmask address for Ethernet port B 39       Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Accessing Streaming Data                                                                                                 Command Description Page  alarm chamber Reports sets chamber temperature alarm maximum value B 13  temp max  alarm chamber Reports sets chamber temperature alarm minimum value B 13  temp min  alarm conc no max     Reports sets current NO concentration alarm maximum value B 14  alarm conc no min Reports sets current NO concentration alarm minimum value B 14  alarm conc no2 max Reports sets current NO  concentration alarm maximum B 14  value  alarm conc no2 min Reports sets current NO  concentration alarm minimum value B 14  alarm conc nox max Reports sets current NO  concentration alarm maximum B 14  value  alarm conc nox min Reports sets current NO  concentration alarm minimum value B 14  alarm conc pre max Reports sets current prereactor concentration alarm B 14  maximum value  alarm conc pre min Reports sets current prereactor concentration alarm B 14  minimum value  alarm converter Reports sets NO  converter temperature alarm maximum B 14  temp max value  alarm converter Reports sets NO  converter temperature alarm minimum B 14  temp min value  alarm cooler temp Reports sets PMT cooler temperature alarm maximum value B 15  max  alarm cooler temp Reports sets PMT cooler temperature alarm minim
167. esererssersseese 3 28  Date and TiMe    eesseesseeesereseessreesrresstreseessressrressresssersseessressrresees 3 29  Erase Lop ninietan aa a e eiaa eaii 3 30  Select Contenta e a E A TIEN 3 30  Concentrations oa aas oea ea enced e eaa aA eea a AS 3 31  Other Measurements        sseeeseeesseessreeesrrssersseeseressressrersseessreesrreseee 3 32  Analog Inputs senssa e e a e E ee E iNi Te 3 32  Commit Content a a ASA EAE E a EESIN 3 33  Reset to Default Content     ssssssssessseseseessressressrresrrerseessressrresereseee 3 33  Configure Datalogging       e sssessssseersreresrsrsrststserrrersesereenesesrentes 3 34  Logging Period Min   sssesessssessssesssssrsesssrsisssesisisisesesrsesesrseseseseses 3 34  Memory Allocation Percent  icvincvscaveabuaieraanegenetarscevtudsvertunyteets 3 35  Data rearment a dae ce 3 35  Communication Sethin gs sivcsscvcsietsatt toons nadioundats sheiueedsbonces deode cadevids 3 35  JELEO BRAG seen E E E NE Sas  lt Sata EE ae ek 3 36  Instrument Dasairas a eed a a isc aeenieeks 3 36  Communication Protocol  sds ieeitd fe vaumacecuct ti asker secastdel ecaitar ces 3 37  Streaming Data Configuration vccscseccdiew eesti citnaectioniess 3 37  Streaming Data Interval 3 nde Ainaeond lcutiet oie tendon eeSnde nes 3 38  Concentra ONS cadeccteeestaas A EERS 3 38  Other Measurements        sseeeseessssessseeesresserssesseressreessereseessreesrreses 3 39  Analop NPU e sy ac ia cae RRA OA RENS 3 39  RS 232 RS 485 SelectiOn ssssssssesiscresnssssrssssiisserrscesssse
168. eserrrriressrsrsesses B 1  Comma ndsas ai o n en eE a Ce nee ea a reve Teme evn oe B 2  Accessing Streaming Data      esssseseseeeessesrreesrsresresterrsresreersrrsresenresresr B 2  Commands Liste ccsseitin cel aiai RREA B 2  Measurements isina esio e aai a vos teste tel enn ER AEE aiaa B 9  Alar S e EN uted EEE e O a E N G B 13  Diagnostics anien rnei ees ei eris eeur on E ais B 17  Datalopeng sni SS a A a aaa ea ANS B 17  Calibration siseses i eisean ar aa aaa ni B 25  Keys  Display isai H reicte a AE E a RE OE B 29    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Contents    Measurement Co mii tration lt  cut324 sccacscateres ian cacencn tite ial eetacgadetete sles  B 31  Hardware Configuration i      i 6a dient eeditetntiaces teed dees B 34  Communications Configuration ici  sete ciecheies oests eee canis ben decerct aes B 38  I O  ConfigutatioN  iesist esisiini entender B 42  Record Layout Definition      ssssssssesessssesssessssesesrtersesssestsetttsesesseseseeee B 46  Format Specifier for ASCH Responses        seseseseeeseeeieeererererersrereees B 47  Format Specifier for Binary Responses      s sssssssessssssererererererersrereree B 47  Format Specifier for EREC Layout       sssssssssesssseseserererrrerersrersrsreres B 48  Ae E E E A E E Takai cs tas B 48  Value Sting se agana arein nha iiaeaa aiei B 48  MAIS SOUNCE mionna an a n RA saemdade ioe B 48  Alarm Information acacia tiene dentin idol cies B 49  Translatio Table crete tik hence tea  seats Waite tale
169. eseseseeres 3 64  Min and Max Internal Temperature Limits    3 64  Chamber Temperature aniisi iini e cesta ceuta tise 3 64    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual vii    Contents    viii    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Min and Max Chamber Temperature Limits 0 0 0    eeeeeeeeeeeees 3 65  Cooler Temperature snina asinina iia ikesh 3 65  Min and Max Cooler Temperature Limits     sssseeeeeseeeeeeeesreresese 3 66  Converter Temperature      sseseeseseseseseeresesrseertststsesereeresrsteseseseeees 3 66  Min and Max Converter Temperature Limits    seseeeseeeseeeeeeeeeeee 3 66  Pressure  min i a R chess A sie aaa 3 67  Min and Max PressuresLimits  cence cos aie ae fa eee 3 67  FLOW cacti sche bic ate re eda  G i E ta cca tds AEE A EAT 3 68  Min and Max  Blow Limits  is utestiecsetapecieettiepanascrnitncentinaee 3 68  OTA FW soc es cc dipuccd densa ia ease sca tons de cen eese an tarasecedesaetonbatces 3 68  Zero and Spats Cech ss  2 s tt ed oases a neta accent as 3 69  Max Zero  and Spar   tset easccec tte toa eal ana Hat as desee 3 69  Zero and Span Auto alpratiOns gate ais cate ceesaton a creas 3 69  NO  NO   and NO  Concentration s ciaiisvncddedasianic 3 70  Min and Max NO  NOz  and NOx Concentration Limits            3 70  Min  rigger innritan nana a A Na eiai 3 71  Zero CONCENETALI OM Yes sniicnead vise cuss iiinis eiii iiia is odes 3 71  Min and Max Zero Concentration Limits    ce eeeeeseeeeeeees 3 72  Min  Trigger cay enaren rann a a
170. ess gt      If the  lt address gt  is left out then no space is allowed in the query string   A command with no address is also a valid command     The following are the different acceptable formats of the DA command  with Instrument Address 5      lt STX gt DA lt CR gt    lt STX gt DA005 lt CR gt    lt STX gt DA lt SP gt  lt SP gt 5 lt ETX gt  lt BCC gt    lt STX gt DA lt ETX gt  lt BCC gt     The data query string is valid and will be answered with data transmission  only if the command starts with  lt STX gt  which is followed by the characters  DA  and the  lt address gt   if present  matches the Instrument Address  and  the command is terminated with either  lt CR gt  with no checksum or  lt ETX gt   followed by the correct checksum  lt BCC gt      D 4 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Geysitech  Bayern Hessen  Protocol  Geysitech Commands    Sample Data Reply String in response to Data Query Command  DA      In response to a valid data query command  DA  the instrument responds  in the following format      lt STX gt MD02 lt SP gt  lt address gt  lt SP gt  lt measured  valuel gt  lt SP gt  lt status gt  lt SP gt  lt SFKT gt  lt SP gt  lt address 1 gt  lt SP gt  lt measured  value2 gt  lt SP  gt  lt status gt  lt SP gt  lt SFKT gt  lt ETX gt  lt BCC gt     The response uses the same command terminators as used by the received  command i e  if the received command was terminated with a  lt CR gt  the  response
171. essen  Protocol  Block Checksum  lt BCC gt     The block checksum is calculated beginning with a seed value of  00000000  binary  0x00   and bitwise exclusive ORing with each of the  characters of the command string  or response  including the framing  characters  lt STX gt  and  lt ETX gt   The checksum works as an error check  The  command terminator determines the presence or absence of  lt BCC gt      If a command is terminated by  lt ETX gt  then the next two characters are the  checksum  if the command is terminated with  lt CR gt  no checksum is  attached    The block checksum is represented by two characters  which represent a 2  digit hex number  1byte    e g  1 byte 0xAB hex checksum will be  represented by the two characters    A     amp     B        The checksum is referred to as  lt BCC gt  throughout this document     The following commands are supported by the Geysitech protocol   e Instrument Control Command  ST     e Data Sampling Data Query Command  DA     There are three control commands supported by the Geysitech protocol     This  lt control commands is a single letter  which triggers an action in the  instrument  These commands are active only when service mode is inactive  and the zero span option is present     Command    N    switches the instrument gas mode to Zero mode   Command    K switches the instrument gas mode to Span mode   Command    M    switches the instrument gas mode to Sample mode    The following are the different acceptable formats of
172. evels evisu cae ae a ete St eet B 35  Table B 8  Reply Termination Formats 0 0 0    cccccccccscececesescetesesesteteseseseenenees B 40  Table B 9  Analog Current Output Range Values    cece ceceeeeeteseeteees B 42  Table B 10  Analog Voltage Output Range Values oo    cccccccceccecesesteeeteees B 43  Table B   11  Default Output Assignment    ccc cecescetesestesesteseeneees B 44  Table C   1  Read Coils for 42i Trace LeVEl          cececcccscssestesseseeseeceseeestesneseesee C 8  Table C 2  Read Registers for 427 Trace Level oo    ceccecccccecccesceeseeesteeeeens C 9  Table C   3  Write Coils for 427 Trace LeVel oc  ceceececcccccccstesteseeseeseeteeteseeseens C 11  Table D 1  Operating Status for Model 42i Trace Level oo    D 7  Table D 2  Error Status for Model 42i Trace Level    cceceeeeecseetesteeeseeees D 7    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Chapter 1  Introduction    The Model 427 Trace Level Chemiluminescence NO NO2 NO  Analyzer  combines proven detection technology  easy to use menu driven software   and advanced diagnostics to offer unsurpassed flexibility and reliability   The Model 427 Trace Level has the following features     320 x 240 graphics display   Menu driven software   Field programmable ranges   User selectable single dual auto range modes  Multiple user defined analog outputs   Analog input options   Detection limits of 50 ppt or better   Fast response time   Linearity through all ranges   Standard prereactor for continuous zero co
173. from the AC power outlet     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 9    Servicing  Vacuum Pump Diaphragm and Valve Replacement    Vacuum Pump  Diaphragm and Valve  Replacement    7 10 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual       Figure 7   4  Replacing the Pump    2  Remove both inlet and exhaust lines from the pump     3     Install the new pump by following the previous steps in reverse     Use the following procedures to replace the diaphragm and valve for the  vacuum pumps  Figure 7   5      Equipment Required    e Allen wrench  4 mm   e Nut driver  7 32 inch or 5 5 mm   e Allen wrench  3 mm   e Spanner wrench  3 8 mm diameter by 4 5 mm long inserts  e Small flat blade screwdriver   e Large flat blade screwdriver   e Cleaning agent  alcohol    e Fine grade steel wool   e    LOC TITE    blue breakable thread adhesive    Thermo Fisher Scientific    A    Diaphragm Replacement    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  Vacuum Pump Diaphragm and Valve Replacement    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    Use the following procedure to replace the diaphragm  Figure 7   5      l     Undo the four socket head cap screws and washers     C     for each head  and lift off the heads with tubing from the pump body  Keep the heads  connected if at all possible  disconnecting and then reconnecting t
174. ften used menus and  screens  They are located directly underneath the display and as the keys   functions change this is indicated by user defined labels in the lower part of  the display  so that the user knows what the keys are to be used for       9    To change a soft key  place the menu cursor     gt     on the item of the selected  menu or screen you wish to set  Press    gt    followed by the selected soft  key within 1 second of pressing the right arrow key  The edit soft key  prompt will be displayed for configuration for the new label     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 3    Operation  Software Overview    Software  Overview    3 4 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Note Not all menu items may be assigned to soft keys  If a particular menu  or screen item cannot be assigned  the key assignment screen will not come  up upon entering right arrow soft key combinations  All items under the  Service menu  including the menu itself  cannot be assigned soft keys  A       The Model 422 Trace Level utilizes the menu driven software as illustrated  by the flowchart in Figure 3   3  The Power Up screen  shown at the top of  the flowchart  is displayed each time the instrument is turned on  This  screen is displayed while the instrument is warming up and performing self   checks  After the warm up period  the Run screen is automatically  displayed  The Run screen is the normal operating screen  It displays the  NO  NO   and NO  conc
175. g C  flow    sample flow  These commands report the current measured flow  The example below  reports that the flow measurement is 0 700 liters minute     Send  flow  Receive  flow 0 7 1 m    internal temp   This command reports the current internal instrument temperature  The  first reading is the temperature being used in instrument calculations  The  second temperature is the actual temperature being measured  If  temperature compensation is on  then both temperature readings are the  same  If temperature compensation is off  a temperature of 30   C is used as  the default temperature even though the actual internal temperature is 27 2    C  The example below shows that temperature compensation is on and  that the internal temperature is 27 2   C     Send  internal temp  Receive  internal temp 027 2 deg C  actual 027 2  pmt temp    This command reports the PMT cooler temperature  The example below  reports that the PMT cooler temperature is  2 8   C     Send  pmt temp  Receive  pmt temp  2 8 deg C    Model 427 Trace Level Instruction Manual B 11    C Link Protocol Commands  Measurements    B 12 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    pmt voltage  This command reports the PMT voltage  The example below reports that  the current PMT voltage is  750 volts     Send  pmt voltage  Receive  pmt voltage  750  pres    This command reports the current reaction chamber pressure  The first  pressure reading is the pressure reading being used in instrument  calculations  The second
176. g temperature    15 35   C  may be safely operated over the 5   40            Power requirements    100 VAC   50 60 Hz   115 VAC   50 60 Hz  220 240 VAC   50 60 Hz  300 watts       Physical dimensions    16 75   W  X 8 62     H  X 23     D        Weight    Approximately 60 Ibs   including external pump        Analog outputs    6 voltage outputs  0   100 mV  1  5  10 V  User selectable   5  of  full scale over under range  12 bit resolution  user  programmable       Digital outputs    1 power fail relay Form C  10 digital relays Form A  user  selectable alarm output  relay logic  100 mA   200 VDC          Digital inputs 16 digital inputs  user select programmable  TTL level  pulled  high  Serial Ports 1 RS 232 or RS 485 with two connectors  baud rate 1200        115200  Protocols  C Link  MODBUS  and streaming data  all  user selectable        Ethernet connection    RJ45 connector for 10Mbs Ethernet connection  static or  dynamic TCP IP addressing     In non condensing environments  Performance specifications based on operation in 15 35   C range     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Lifting    A    Unpacking and    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Inspection    Chapter 2  Installation    Installing the Model 42   Trace Level includes the following  recommendations and procedures     e    Lifting    on page 2 1   e    Unpacking and Inspection    on page 2 1   e    Setup Procedure    on page 2 2   e    Connecting External Devices    on page 2 5    e    Startup    on page 2 9    When lifti
177. ger type to either floor or ceiling   The minimum alarm may be programmed as a floor trigger  alarm is  triggered when the concentration falls below the minimum value  or a  ceiling trigger  alarm is triggered when the concentration goes above the  minimum value      e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Select Concentration  gt  Min    Trigger        ERED    Bs EEE TE Sasad Bone          Zero Concentration The Zero Concentration screen displays the current zero concentration and  sets the minimum and maximum alarm limits  Acceptable alarm limits  range from 0 to 2 ppb and 0 to 5 pg m     The minimum alarm may be  programmed as a floor trigger  alarm is triggered when the concentration  falls below the minimum value  or a ceiling trigger  alarm is triggered when  the concentration goes above the minimum value   If the zero  concentration goes beyond either the minimum or maximum limit  an  alarm is activated  The word    ALARM    appears in the Run screen and in  the Main Menu     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Zero Concentration     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 71    Operation  Alarms Menu       Min and Max Zero Concentration The Minimum NO Concentration alarm limit screen is used to change the  Limits minimum NO concentration alarm limits  The minimum and maximum  NO  NO   and NO  concentration alarm limit screens function the same  way     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Zero Concentration  gt  Min or    Max        mi  Pi
178. gned to any measurement or diagnostic  channel with a user defined range in the units of the selected parameter   The voltage outputs are independent of the current outputs     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 8 9    System Description  1 0 Components    Analog Current  Outputs  Optional     Analog Voltage  Inputs  Optional     Digital Relay  Outputs    Digital Inputs    8 10 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    The optional I O Expansion board includes six isolated current outputs   These are software configured for any one of the following ranges  while  maintaining a minimum resolution of 11 bits     e 0 20 mA  e 4 20mA    The user can calibrate each analog output zero and span point through  firmware  At least 5  of full scale over and under range are also supported     The analog outputs may be assigned to any measurement or diagnostic  channel with a user defined range in the units of the selected parameter   The current outputs are independent of the voltage outputs  The current  outputs are isolated from the instrument power and ground  but they share  a common return line  Isolated GND      The optional I O expansion board includes eight analog voltage inputs   These inputs are used to gather measurement data from third party devices  such as meteorological equipment  The user may assign a label  unit  and a  voltage to user defined unit conversion table  up to 16 points   All voltage  inputs have a resolution of 12 bits over the range of 0 to 10 volts
179. gure 8   1  include   e NO gt z to NO converter  e Mode solenoid  e Reaction chamber  e Optical filter  e Pressure transducer  e Sample flow sensor  e Ozonator  e Ozone flow switch  e Photomultiplier tube  e Photomultiplier tube cooler  e Pump  e Sample capillary  e Dry air capillary    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 8 1    System Description  NO2 to NO Converter    Pressure Transducer E   Peg Are al FL el  Input Board i l oT l    Measurement    Interface Board I        ce oe          Flow Reaction  Chamber    PMT Assembly    Converter Transducer    Ww  Switch    Capillaries  2           Prereactor            Fan    goo       Power Supply       NO  to NO  Converter    Mode Solenoid    Reaction Chamber    8 2 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    fe      ae es    1 0 Expansion  Board  Opt        E          Motherboard Digital Output Board    Solenoids  3     Ozonator  Transformer    Figure 8   1  Hardware Components    The NO  to NO converter heats molybdenum to approximately 325   C in  order to convert and detect NO2  The converter consists of an insulated  housing  heater  replaceable cartridge  and a type K thermocouple sensor     The mode solenoid valve switches analyzer operation between the NO  mode and NO  mode  It routes the ambient air sample either through the  reaction chamber  NO mode  or through the NO2 to NO converter and  then to the reaction chamber  NO  mode      The reaction chamber is where the sample reacts with ozo
180. h Product that Seller may have from the original manufacturer  or third party supplier  to the extent such assignment is allowed by such  original manufacturer or third party supplier     In no event shall Seller have any obligation to make repairs  replacements  or corrections required  in whole or in part  as the result of  i  normal wear  and tear   ii  accident  disaster or event of force majeure   iii  misuse  fault  or negligence of or by Buyer   iv  use of the Products in a manner for which    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual A 1    Warranty  Warranty    they were not designed   v  causes external to the Products such as  but not  limited to  power failure or electrical power surges   vi  improper storage  and handling of the Products or  vii  use of the Products in combination  with equipment or software not supplied by Seller  If Seller determines  that Products for which Buyer has requested warranty services are not  covered by the warranty hereunder  Buyer shall pay or reimburse Seller for  all costs of investigating and responding to such request at Seller s then  prevailing time and materials rates  If Seller provides repair services or  replacement parts that are not covered by the warranty provided in this  warranty  Buyer shall pay Seller therefor at Seller s then prevailing time and  materials rates  ANY INSTALLATION  MAINTENANCE  REPAIR   SERVICE  RELOCATION OR ALTERATION TO OR OF  OR  OTHER TAMPERING WITH  THE PRODUCTS PERFORMED BY  ANY PERSON OR EN
181. h voltage value is separated by a space     Send  diag volt iob  Receive  diag volt iob 24 1 4 9 3 2  3 2    clr records  This command will clear all long and short records that have been saved     Send  clear records  Receive  clear records ok    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 17    C Link Protocol Commands  Datalogging    B 18 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    set clr lrecs   set clr srecs   These commands will clear only the long records or only the short records  that have been saved  The example below clears short records     Send  set clr srecs  Receive  set clr srecs ok    data treatment lrec   data treatment srec   These commands report the current selection of data treatment for  concentrations in the long records  lrecs  or short records  srecs   The  example below reports the data treatment for concentrations in lrec is    minimum   Send  data treatment lrec  Receive  data treatment lrec min    set data treatment lrec string  set data treatment srec string  string     cur   avg   min   max      These commands set the data treatment to current  average  minimum  or  maximum for the concentration values recorded in the long records  lrecs   or short records  srecs   The example below sets the data treatment for  concentrations in lrec to minimum     Send  set data treatment lrec min  Receive  set data treatment lrec min ok  list din   list dout    These commands report the current selection for the digital outputs in the  format  Output no Index
182. he  PTFE tube can cause leaks     Check for smooth opening and closing of the reed valves     Q      a  number of sets of diaphragms can be replaced before there is a need to  replace the valves  Follow the instructions for    valve replacement    if  changing of the valves is required     Use the spanner wrench to loosen and remove the one piece clamping    disc screw     E      Remove the old diaphragms from both heads     G         Remove the four pan head screws with M5 washers     J     and remove  the housing cover     K     from the front of the pump body  If necessary   carefully use a small flat bladed screwdriver to pry off the housing  cover     Install the two PTFE  white color  diaphragms together with one TFM   translucent  diaphragm as shown in Figure E 1  Install with the ridges  of the diaphragm convolutions as shown in the diaphragm stack cross    section inset     Temporarily insert two of the head screws through the diaphragms and  screw into the pump body to keep the position of the diaphragms as  the clamping disc is tightened  Any stress applied re aligning the  diaphragm in the process of assembling the head will significantly  reduce diaphragm life    Check the threads of the clamping disc to insure that they are clean and  free of debris  Apply a small amount of the breakable thread adhesive to  the clamping disc threads and install     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 11    Servicing  Vacuum Pump Diaphragm and Valve Replacement    Valve Re
183. he  ozonator flow is above 0 050  the no alarm condition screen is displayed   indicating that the flow is acceptable  Inadequate ozonator flow will cause  the ozonator to overheat  resulting in permanent damage to the ozonator     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Ozonator Flow     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Alarms Menu       ERE CH  vee    EUs EEE TE Sanat Boes PME Fad Bast    ade 5    Wi mpini  iL a EA DE       Zero and Span The Zero Span Check screen allows the user to view the status of the most  Check recent zero check and set the maximum zero check offset  The zero and  span check screens are visible only if the zero span check option is enabled  and function the same way     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Zero or Span Check        ERE CH  vee    CH bo bet  ETTE T Suad beoe Pi ha kr d T Ea E aa EE B i       Max Zero and Span Offset The Max Zero Check Offset screen is used to change the maximum zero  check offset  The maximum zero and span offset screens function the same  way     e In the Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Zero or Span Check  gt  Max  Offset        ao Poh dm  ERER H    EDN PUHE TE ueet Bone TOP hed Bat    ae EE eek eet POE fases       Zero and Span Auto The Zero Auto Calibration screen  read only  allows the user to view the  Calibration status of the most recent auto background calibration  The zero and span    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 69    Operation  Alarms Menu    auto calibration screens
184. he instrument  state that is tied to the selected relay output  A submenu lists signal types of  either alarm or non alarm to choose from     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 43    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration  gt   Output Relay Settings  gt  Select Relay  gt  Instrument State           Alarms The Alarms status screen allows the user to select the alarm status for the  selected relay output  The selected item is shown by     lt       after it  The I O  board status alarm is only present if the I O expansion board is installed   The zero and span check calibration alarms are only present if the  zero span valve option is installed and the instrument is operating in  manual mode     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration  gt   Output Relay Settings  gt  Select Relay  gt  Instrument State  gt  Alarms        3 44 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu    Non Alarm The Non Alarm status screen allows the user to select the non alarm status  for the selected relay output  The selected item is shown by     lt       after it     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration  gt   Output Relay Settings  gt  Select Relay  gt  Instrument State  gt  Non Alarm        RSE          Digital Input Settings The Digital Input Settings menu displays a list of the 16 d
185. his command reports the status of the digital inputs as a 4 digit  hexadecimal string with the most significant bit  MSB  being input 16     Send  dig in  Receive  dig in oxff7f    din channel   This command reports the action assigned to input channel and the  corresponding active state  The example below reports the input 1 to be  assigned an index number 3 corresponding to action of    set background     mode with the active state being high     Send  din 5  Receive  din 5 9 AOUTS TO ZERO high    set din channel index state   This command assigns digital input channel  1 16  to activate the action  indicated by index  1 35   when the input transitions to the designated state   high or low   Use    list din var    command to obtain the list of supported  index values and corresponding actions     Send  set din 1 3 high  Receive  set din 1 3 high ok    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 43    C Link Protocol Commands  1 0 Configuration    dout channel   This command reports the index number and output variable and the  active state assigned to output channel  The example below reports the  input 2 to be assigned an index number 2 corresponding to    local remote     with the active state being open     Send  dout 4  Receive  dout 4 11 GEN ALARM open    set dout channel index state  This command assigns digital output channel to be assigned to the action  associated with index  and assigns it an active state of state  open or closed      Send  set dout 4 11 open  Rece
186. hnician  A    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  PMT Voltage Adjustment     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 73    Operation  Service Menu    Range Mode Select    Converter Set  Temperature    3 74 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    rip priori  PLP       The Range Mode Select screen is used to switch between the various range  modes  single  dual  and auto range     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Range Mode Select        The Converter Set Temperature screen is used to change the converter set  temperature  The converter set temperature reading is updated every  second  The converter set temperature screen is visible only when the  instrument is in service mode  For more information on the service mode   see    Service Mode    earlier in the chapter     Note This adjustment should only be performed by an instrument service  technician  A    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Converter Set Temperature     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Pressure Calibration    Calibrate Pressure Zero    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Service Menu       RRS E Cur mito  EUs EEE TE Sanad Bone CECA i       i myinpri  Piedini i       The Pressure Calibration submenu is used to calibrate the pressure sensor  to zero  span  or restore factory default values  The pressure calibration is  visible only when the instrument is in service mode  For more information  on the service mode  see    Service Mode    earlier in this chapter     The pre
187. i 3 53  Temperature COMpensation      ssessesesssseseseseerestsrsseseseeresesrereseseseeee 3 53  Pressure Compensation sacrer eniin 3 54  Screen Contrasto araa aa a aiaia Ee a r i iS t ia 3 54  Service Moders inann naon a a a ONE R Ee 3 55  Date Time merani garan eena ii a a oi a aai 3 55  Dignostics Metsma nnee hna a e a anasto 3 56  Program Versi  n sisis  sssccavessaarssacuestisuscoedeavevesncancenais sa creda aiie 3 56  WGP GES ae sesters sotesnio onan serioa a Aa Ega cates ea Ea Ee eoir sE 3 57  Motherboard Voltages      s ssssseessesessessssssssssssrsrsrsrsesisesesesrseseseseses 3 57  Interface  Board Voltagesraniniiienanenn ean an N ei 3 57  VO  Board Voltages ieran A a n 3 58  Temperatures tek ao iE ET E KE RE EE E 3 58  Press renn e ea a a E A A A site 3 59  FOW wate iil iaaa a Wainer tances 3 59  Prercactor Zeroman iritiraa ioare esd a a eai iN 3 59  Analog Input Readings     ssseeeseeesesesesesesesesrsesrsrsrsrsrrrsrrrerrererersreres 3 60  Analog  Input Voltages in ie innn Sasha Ei 3 60  Digitalin Ut 6 ass SG ANa a ead NG Sees  ie 3 60  Relay States sorne n R N T ER 3 61  Rest Analog Qutp  ts soenoe oi oiie A a SR aaa 3 61  Set Analog Outputs    s sssssesesesesessesessstsesesestsesrsrsrereeterereesrsrsres 3 62  Instrument Configuration tes cok cca ce aos Me tila en ate 3 62  Contact Information zennan inin i eae aaeatelds sates 3 62  Alarms Menu cot oti ciacs contests rnana a e a S 3 63  Internal Temperature     sesesesesesesesesssssssesssssssestststsisestseseseses
188. ibrate NOx screen displays the current NOx  concentration  The SPAN CONC line of the display is where you enter  the NO  calibration gas concentration     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Preparing NO  NO   and  NO  Calibration Curves    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Calibration  Calibration    Use  _         to move the cursor left and right and use          to increment and decrement the numeric character at the cursor     3  Press to calculate and save the new NO  coefficient based on the    entered span concentration     4  Press _  gt    to return to the Run screen  The exact NO  concentration    is calculated from     Fyno X   NO let  NO limp   Fro   Fo   Fp        NOx lour    Where    NO   our   diluted NO  concentration at the output manifold  ppm     NOz  imp   concentration of NO  impurity in the standard NO cylinder  ppm    The NO  recorder response will equal      NOx lout    Recorder Response    scale     URL    Where     x 100  Zo     URL   Nominal upper range limit of the NO  channel  ppm    5  Record the NO  concentration and the analyzer s NO  response     Use the following procedures to prepare the NO  NO   and NO2    calibration curves     1  Generate several additional NO and NO  concentrations by decreasing  Fno or increasing Fp     2  For each concentration generated  calculate the exact NO and NOx  concentrations using the above equations for  NO our and  NO Jour     3  Record the NO and NO  responses     4  Plot the analyzer responses versus the respective ca
189. ic pressure  It may be  necessary to use an atmospheric dump bypass plumbing arrangement to  accomplish this     For more information  refer to the    Installation    chapter and the     Operation    chapter     The permeation dryer minimizes routing maintenance procedures by  providing a continuous stream of dry air to the ozonator  using the  selective water permeation characteristics of the dryer   With the  permeation dryer option  it is not necessary to constantly replenish the  ozonator air drying column as in the standard instrument     Refer to the    Operation    chapter for more information     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 9 1    Optional Equipment  Ammonia Scrubber    Ammonia Scrubber    Teflon Particulate  Filter    Ozone Particulate  Filter    NO  to NO Converter    1 0 Expansion Board  Assembly    Terminal Block and  Cable Kits    9 2 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    The ammonia scrubber is mounted internally and removes ammonia from  the sample air     A 5 10 micron pore size  two inch diameter Teflon  element is available for  the Model 427 Trace Level  This filter should be installed just prior to the  SAMPLE bulkhead  When using a filter  all calibrations and span checks  must be performed through the filter     The ozone particulate filter minimizes the potential for contamination of  the ozonator by trapping any particulate matter before passing through the  ozonator     The Model 427 Trace Level includes a Molybdenum NO gt  to NO co
190. ific    Alarm Information    Translation Table    Selection Table    Button Designator    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Record Layout Definition    The value source is followed by optional alarm information  indicated by a  commercial at sign     with a source indicator and a starting bit indicator   All alarm information is presumed to be two bits long  low and high   The  bitfield extraction is performed on the integer part of the source  Typical  alarm information would appear as   6 4      Then  there appears an optional translation table within braces       This is  a string of words separated by spaces  An example translation table would  be   Code_0 Code_1 Code_2 Code_3    The value  once extracted is used  as a zero based index into the translation table to determine the string to    display     Then there appears an optional selection table within parentheses             This is a string of numbers separated by spaces   0 1    The selection table  lists the translation table entries which the user may select from when  setting the parameter  This is not necessarily the same as the entries which  may be displayed     Then there appears an optional button designator  This will be one of  B    T  Es  T   or  N    B  Indicates a button which pops up an input dialog prompting the    user for a new value using the designated input format  The input  format is specified from the  B  through the subsequent semicolon     I   Indicates a button which po
191. igital inputs  available  and allows the user to select the logic state and instrument  parameter for the relay selected     Note The digital inputs must be asserted for at least one second for the  action to be activated  A    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration  gt   Digital Input Settings        WH mnie     a proi Mn Py Tit     Mii i    EN EEE TE Sanat Beee PUES Aad Bast    ads P       Logic State The Logic State screen is used to change the I O relay to either normally  open or normally closed  The default state is open  which indicates that a  relay connected between the digital input pin and ground is normally open    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 45    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu    and closes to trigger the digital input action  If nothing is connected to the  digital input pin  the state should be left at open to prevent the action from  being triggered     e Press to toggle and set the logic state open or closed           Instrument Action The Instrument Action screen allows the user to choose the instrument  action that is tied to the selected digital input     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  I O Configuration  gt   Digital Input Settings  gt  Select Relay  gt  Instrument Action        DH vided  PLP       Analog Output The Analog Output Configuration menu displays a list of the analog   Configuration output channels available for configuration  Channel choices include 
192. ing gases are available from gas suppliers   however  the typical analyses for Nox and SO  impurities only guarantee  levels below 5 ppb  In practice  Thermo Fisher Scientific   s personnel as well  as other users of Trace Level equipment have found these gases to be at  least an order of magnitude better than what is guaranteed  and therefore  are adequate for most purposes  Non reactive and diffusion resistant  regulators are required  and as the cylinder pressure falls below 500 psig   the integrity of the zero gas becomes more in question     Rather than relying on cylinder sources for zero air  Thermo Fisher  Scientific routinely uses zero air generate by    brute force     that is  by  compression  chemical scrubbing and reaction  Ambient air that has been  compressed and pressurized to give an output of about 25 psig is dried by  passing the air through a heatless air dryer  for example  and then sent  through a series of chemical reactors and or scrubbers  Normally  these  include indicating silica gel  Purafil  activated charcoal  and a fine  5  micron  particulate filter  When first used  this    brute force    approach  actually can generate enhanced impurity levels for Nox and SO    as these  gases desorb from the chemical reactors  However  after 24 to 48 hours of  continuous operation  impurity levels will generally fall and stabilize below  detection limits for the Trace Level analyzers  It is critical when using this  type of zero air source to always maintain
193. ion The Flow Calibration submenu is used to calibrate the flow sensor to zero   span  or restore factory default values  The flow calibration is visible only  when the instrument is in service mode  For more information on the  service mode  see    Service Mode    earlier in the chapter     Note This adjustment should only be performed by an instrument service  technician  A    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Flow Calibration        Roc   Parti          Calibrate Flow Zero The Calibrate Flow Zero screen calibrates the flow sensor at zero flow     Note The pump must be disconnected before performing the zero  calibration  A    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Flow Calibration  gt  Zero     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 77    Operation  Service Menu       Calibrate Flow Span The Calibrate Flow Span screen allows the user to view and set the flow  sensor calibration span point     Note An independent flow sensor is required to read the flow  then the  operator enters the flow value on this screen to perform the calibration  a    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Flow Calibration  gt  Span        ip guided  Piet          Restore Default Flow The Restore Default Flow Calibration screen allows the user to reset the  Calibration flow calibration configuration values to factory defaults     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Select Flow Calibration A or B  gt   Set Defaults        3 78 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manua
194. ion panel  then proceed to the next step below  Refer to     Removing the Measurement Bench and Lowering the Partition Panel     on page 7 8 in this chapter     2  Unplug all connectors  Note the locations of the connectors to facilitate  reconnection     7 44 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  Flow Transducer Replacement    3  Unscrew the two screws at the top of the measurement interface board   Pop off the measurement interface board from the four mounting studs  and remove the board  Figure 7   21      4  To install the measurement interface board  follow previous steps in  reverse     5  Re install the measurement bench     6  Calibrate the PMT voltage  pressure transducer  flow transducer  input  board  and ambient temperature sensor as defined earlier in this  chapter           Mounting Studs  2     Mounting Screws  2     Measurement Interface Board    Figure 7 21  Replacing the Measurement Interface Board    Flow Transducer Use the following procedure to replace the flow transducer  Figure 7   22    Replaceme Nt Equipment Required     Flow transducer    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 45    Servicing  Flow Transducer Calibration    1  Turn instrument OFF  unplug the power cord  and remove the 
195. iption    Ground   Ground   LCLK     LCD Signal  Ground   Ground   LLP     LCD Signal  LFLM     LCD Signal  LD4     LCD Signal  LDO     LCD Signal  LD5     LCD Signal  LD1     LCD Signal  LD6     LCD Signal  LD2    LCD Signal  LD7    LCD Signal  LD3    LCD Signal  LCD Bias Voltage   5V   Ground   Ground  LCD_ONOFF     LCD Signal  Keypad Row 2 Input  Keypad Row 1 Input  Keypad Row 4 Input  Keypad Row 3 Input    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Troubleshooting  Connector Pin Descriptions    oy  5    Connector Reference  Label Designator    Signal Description    N  o    Keypad Col 2 Select    N  o    Keypad Col 1 Select    N  N    Keypad Col 4 Select    N   oe     Keypad Col 3 Select    N  co    Ground    w  oO    Ground    w          Ground     Se   N    Ground    24V    24V   LDO_5V     LCD Signal  LD1_5V     LCD Signal  LD2_5V     LCD Signal  LD3_ONOFF_5V     LCD Signal  LCD_ONOFF_5V     LCD Signal  LFLM_5V     LCD Signal   NC   LLP_5V     LCD Signal  LCLK_5V     LCD Signal    5V    wo ww  BR          LCD DATA J2    oOo co N on A wo N  gt     N    ai       Ground    25V   LCD Bias Voltage  Ground   KEYBOARD J3 1 Keypad Row 1 Input  Keypad Row 2 Input     a  a  a  P w N          Keypad Row 3 Input  Keypad Row 4 Input  Keypad Col 1 Select  Keypad Col 2 Select  Keypad Col 3 Select    o N oon A Wo N    Keypad Col 4 Select       ank    LCD BACKLIGHT J4  5 Supply    2 NC    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 6 17    Troubleshooting  Connector Pin Descripti
196. isconnect the pump  plumbing from the instrument     2  Note the orientation of the pump head top plate for later reassembly   Using a 3 mm Allen wrench  remove the eight socket head screws and  washers securing the pump head top plate     3  Discard the old Teflon gasket     4  Note the orientation of the diaphragm head for later reassembly   Remove the diaphragm head  Using a 4 mm Allen wrench  remove the  four socket head screws securing the diaphragm head to the pump    body     5  Insert the tips of blunt needlenose pliers in the dimples of the clamping  disk  then loosen and remove the clamping disk     6  Remove and discard the old Teflon gasket     7  Insert the clamping disk into the new Teflon diaphragm  three pieces   and screw the clamping disk into the pump  Do not over tighten     Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual 5 5    Preventative Maintenance  Pump Rebuilding                5y RA  I  1E        y  SK  ir  p R       oe  Me     p y l  N jJ    J  S  er gyi  Y  7 eee 4       Figure 5 2  Rebuilding the Pump    8  Remove the screw and nut securing the flapper valves and remove and    discard old flapper valves     5 6 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    10     11     12     13     14     Preventative Maintenance  Pump Rebuilding    Install the new flapper  check that the screw head and not the washer is    on the smooth side of the pump  and check that the flappers are  completely flat and straight 
197. isher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Hardware Configuration    Send  contrast  Receive  contrast 5 50     set contrast  evel  This command sets the screen   s  evel of contrast  according to Table B   7   The example below sets the contrast level to 50      Send  set contrast 5  Receive  set contrast 5 ok    Table B   7  Contrast Levels    Level Contrast Level  0 0   10   20   30   40   50   60   70   80   90   100                                 Oo  ao rlwTas  wisi ony  A  JN                  conv set temp  This command reports the temperature that the NO  converter is set to   The example below reports that the converter temperature is set to 325   C     Send  conv set temp  Receive  conv set temp 325 deg C    set conv set temp value   This command sets the temperature that the NO  converter is set to  where  value is an integer representing dwgrees C  The example below sets the  converter temperature to 325   C     Send  set conv set temp  Receive  set conv set temp 325 deg C ok  date    This command reports the current date  The example below reports the  date as December 1  2004     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 35    C Link Protocol Commands  Hardware Configuration    B 36 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Send  date  Receive  date 12 01 04    set date mm dd yy   mm   month   dd   day   yy   year   This command sets the date of the analyzer   s internal clock  The example  below sets the date to December 1  2004     Send  set date 12 01 0
198. isiactuieseedetesercieclaceienadesteads 3 83  Analog Input Calibrate Zetec pasa Sa kel ee ee Cnet a hee ca eceeeds 3 83  Analog Input Calibrate PulleScale s 2   25  a5 c27earesedee eer teeehsaneeadn cs 3 84  Ozonator Safety cated ies oe eal nine Mane als Aieicachar tenants 3 84  Dil  tow RaO reio ned MS ce case irag aaia 3 85  Display Pixel Testacrinenrinnni nai a aa 3 85  Restore User ebaultscssc tad teens creer co epee eed ad a a eerc tees 3 86    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Contents    Password Ment sgoe Mites ok cok cade N lea ial acted tet iat 3 86  Set EO ra EEE ete leanne adiiadey setae deeds  3 86  Lock listine oai hetsi asees sted lahled aaatead eee anast hceaents 3 87  Change Password  iicseesseiehesatsnccennes atencliesinciedaareienctistiacditieueics 3 87  Remove Password ate t tector tes naan Aa ee et et ee eae 3 87  Unlock Instruments Seid cus  cis ts eeu dalle Oe  3 88  Chapter 4 Calibra ti OM ena a ar raaa Avatar aa raaa icaceardctn tvtenttiaenataaies 4 1  Equipment Required snina nae a tina ace antec Es 4 1  Zeto Gas GOHETAL ON iii sus enir siess eE AET E KERE E R NEE 4 2  Compression oen ee panini Lata ame EE R 4 2  Diya est davesssesianeviacivasisiasssuattavagssutasaveneibusesbaghivsaitisiotianedenaes 4 2  COL AUG e CEN E E E T 4 2  Scrubbing  scannen a E eee 4 2  Gas Phase TitratO Toerien e EE ENNS 4 3  Flow Controllers onner a En a iaa 4 3  Press  re RCRA COT Steg teach E E ER 4 3  Ozone Generat  r kihi a n ai i i aiiis 4 3  Diverter Valve mirna eini An R 
199. ithout pits or  scratches  Do not scratch the head plate  Finish the cleaning with  alcohol and then air dry the parts     4  Lay the two replacement reed valves on a flat surface to the direction of  any slight bend     5  Lay the replacement reed valves in place  center bowed out  see valve  installation   and tighten the pan head screw  both washers  and the  nut  Be certain that the reed valves lay straight and smooth with  clearance from the recessed edge to prevent sticking  If a reed valve    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  Vacuum Pump Diaphragm and Valve Replacement    curves away from the valve hole  remove the screw  flip the valve over  and reinstall     6  Match the holes of the PTFE head gasket     V     with the head seal  surface  install the head lid  and tighten the two center bolts with M4  lock washers first and then cross alternate tightening of the perimeter  bolts  Re tighten the two center bolts after the other bolts are tight     Head Lid Screws  and Washers    Head    Lid         Head  Clamping   LUAS J   Gasket    Disc mes   a J      Head     Qty 3 Layered a f         Plate A  Diaphragms  E     5    See detail                    Compressor 4 j  gt     Housing a i 3 Layer Diaphragm           Installation Detail                                        Connecting   S    p  Rod Disc       Important  Install with      ridges up as shown Dia ph ragm     conneci  g   Translucent Diaphragm  top         Pye eg   Installation     T   H TP     White Diaph
200. ive  set dout 4 11 open ok    dtoa channel   This reports the outputs of the 6 or 12 Digital to Analog converters   according to Table B 11  The example below shows that the D A  1 is  97 7  full scale     Send  dtoa 1  Receive  dtoa 1 97 7     Note If the instrument is in a mode which does not provide a particular  output  and that output is selected  the value will be 0 0  a    All channel ranges are user definable  If any customization has been made  to the analog output configuration  the default selections may not apply  A    Table B 11  Default Output Assignment                            DtoA Function Single Range Dual Range Auto Range   1 Voltage Output NO High NO High Low NO  2 Voltage Output NO   High NO   High Low NO    3 Voltage Output NO  High NO  High Low NO   4 Voltage Output Not Used Low NO Range  NO      5 Voltage Output Not Used Low NO2 Not Used   6 Voltage Output Not Used Low NO  Not Used   7 Current Output NO High NO High Low NO  8 Current Output NO  High NO   High Low NO    9 Current Output NO  High NO  High Low NO   10 Current Output Not Used Low NO Range  NO            B 44 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands          1 0 Configuration  DtoA Function Single Range Dual Range Auto Range  11 Current Output Not Used Low NO  Not Used  12 Current Output Not Used Low NO  Not Used    list var aout   list var dout   list var din   These commands report the list of index numbers  and the variables   associ
201. k           Min Trigger The Minimum Trigger screen allows the user to view and set the Zero  concentration alarm trigger type to either floor or ceiling  The minimum  alarm may be programmed as a floor trigger  alarm is triggered when the  concentration falls below the minimum value  or a ceiling trigger  alarm is  triggered when the concentration goes above the minimum value      e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Zero Concentration  gt     MinTrigger        3 72 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Service Menu    Service Menu The Service menu appears only when the instrument is in the service mode     To put the instrument into the service mode   e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Service Mode     Advanced diagnostic functions are included in the service mode   Meaningful data should not be collected when the instrument is in the  service mode  In dual or auto range modes     HI    or    LO    multi point  calibration is displayed to indicate the calibration of the high or low  concentrations     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service     WH rh iyd       PMT Voltage The PMT Voltage Adjustment screen is used to manually adjust the PMT  Adjustment supply voltage  The PMT voltage adjustment screen is visible only when  the instrument is in service mode  For more information on the service  mode  see    Service Mode    earlier in this chapter     Note This adjustment should only be performed by an instrument service  tec
202. l  transformer is required if operating on the 210 250VAC or 90 110VAC  ranges     An on off switch controls all power to the instrument  and is accessible on  the front panel     The motherboard contains the main processor  power supplies  a sub   processor and serves as the communication hub for the instrument  The  motherboard receives operator inputs from the front panel mounted  function key panel and or over I O connections on the rear panel and  sends commands to the other boards to control the functions of the  instrument and to collect measurement and diagnostic information  The  motherboard outputs instrument status and measurement data to the front   panel mounted graphics display and to the rear panel I O  The  motherboard also contains I O circuitry and the associated connector to  monitor external digital status lines and to output analog voltages that  represent the measurement data  Connectors located on the motherboard  include     External connectors include    e External Accessory   e RS 232 485 Communications  two connectors   e Ethernet Communications    e I O connector with Power Fail Relay  16 Digital Inputs  and 6 Analog  Voltage Outputs     Internal connectors include    e Function key panel and Display   e Measurement Interface Board Data  e I O Expansion Board Data   e Digital Output Board   e AC distribution    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Measurement    Interface Board    Measurement Interface  Board Connectors    Flow Sensor  Assembly    Pressure 
203. l Board Connector Pin Descriptions    Connector  Label    INTERFACE    Reference  Designator    J1    Pin         o oO A WO N    Signal Description    Bench Temperature Input  Ground    15V   Converter Heater On Off  Converter Temperature Input   15V_PWR       AC INPUT    J2         AC HOT  AC NEUT       BENCH    J3         FP WO N    Bench Heater AC Output  Bench Heater AC Return  Ground    Bench Thermistor       CONVERTER         wo N    Ground  Converter Heater AC Output    Converter Heater AC Return       CONV TC    SS TEMP    Thermo Fisher Scientific    J5    J6    m    Converter Thermocouple TC    Converter Thermocouple TC        SS Temperature Range Jumper A    SS Temperature Range Jumper B    Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual 6 21    Troubleshooting  Service Locations    Service For additional assistance  service is available from exclusive distributors    Locations    worldwide  Contact one of the phone numbers below for product support  and technical information or visit us on the web at www thermo com aqi     1 866 282 0430 Toll Free  1 508 520 0430 International    6 22 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Chapter 7  Servicing    This chapter explains how to replace the Model 42i Trace Level  subassemblies  It assumes that a subassembly has been identified as  defective and needs to be replaced     For fault location information refer to the    Preventive Maintenance     chapter and the    Troubleshooting    chapter in this m
204. l Thermo Fisher Scientific    Input Board Calibration    Manual Input Calibration    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Service Menu    The Input Board Calibration menu is used to initiate a calibration of the  input A D stages  The input board calibration menu is visible only when  the instrument is in service mode  For more information on the service  mode  see    Service Mode    earlier in the chapter     Note This adjustment should only be performed by an instrument service  technician  A    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Input Board Calibration        aa ee  ee         Wi mri   ribet       The Manual Input Calibration screen is used to do a manual calibration of  the input board A D stages per the following procedure     Note The measurement system and the PMT are both shut off inside this  screen  A    1  In the Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Input Board Calibration  gt   Manual Input Calibration     2  Press to leave warning screen     3  Make a note of the frequency at gain of 1     4  Use    Jand   gt   to change the gain between 10 and 100     5  Use  t  and     to increment or decrement the D A counts so  the frequency at gain 100 is equal to the frequency at gain 1     6  Press to save new input board calibration     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 79    Operation  Service Menu       Automatic Input Calibration The Automatic Input Calibration screen is used to do an automatic  calibration of the input board A D stages  A message will be disp
205. layed after  the optimum setting has been determined     Note The measurement system and the PMT are both shut off inside this  screen  A    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Input Board Calibration  gt   Automatic Input Calibration     e Press to leave warning screen and begin automatic calibration        Input Frequency Display The Input Frequency Display screen is used to manually adjust the input  board gain  This may be used as a troubleshooting tool for the input board   The gain setting and test mode are reset upon exiting this screen     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Input Board Calibration  gt  Input    Frequency Display   e Press to leave warning screen   e Use  t Jand     to toggle the test signal and bypass the PMT   e Use _ Jand _ _  to change the gain between 1  10 and 100           3 80 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Temperature  Calibration    Analog Output    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Calibration    Operation  Service Menu       UL GET Ted  lose E FO he feat E       The Temperature calibration screen allows the user to view and set the  ambient temperature sensor calibration  The temperature calibration is  visible only when the instrument is in service mode  For more information  on the service mode  see    Service Mode    earlier in the chapter     Note This adjustment should only be performed by an instrument service  technician  A    e In the Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Temperature Calibration      
206. lculated NO and  NO  concentrations and draw or calculate the respective calibration  curves  For subsequent calibrations where linearity can be assumed   these curves may be checked with a three point calibration consisting of    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 4 13    Calibration  Calibration    4 14 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    10     11     a zero point  NO and NO  concentrations of approximately 80  of the  URL  and an intermediate concentration     Sample this NO concentration until the NO and NO  responses have  stabilized  then measure and record the NO concentration as  NO onric     Adjust the GPT system to generate a NO concentration near 90  of  the URL of the instrument range selected     Adjust the O  generator in the GPT system to generate sufficient O  to  produce a decrease in the NO concentration equivalent to about 80   of the URL of the NO  range  The decrease must not exceed 90  of    the NO concentration determined in Steps 5 and 6 above     When the analyzer responses stabilize  record the resultant NO  concentrations as  NO rem     From the Main Menu choose Calibration  gt  Cal NO2 Coefficient     The NO  line of the Calibrate NO  screen displays the current NO   concentration  The SPAN CONC line of the display is where you enter  the NO  calibration gas concentration     Set the NO  calibration gas concentration to reflect the sum of the  following  the NO  concentration generated by GPT    NO onric     NO rem   and any NO  impu
207. le B   6  The example below sets the NO full scale range to  200 ppb     Send  set range 5  Receive  set range 5 ok    Table B 6  Standard Ranges                      Selection ppb pg m   0 5 10   1 10 20   2 20 50   3 50 100   4 100 200   5 200 500   6 C1 C1       Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 31    C Link Protocol Commands  Measurement Configuration    B 32 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual          Selection ppb pg m   7 C2 C2  8 C3 C3    custom range  range   1 2 3     This command reports the user defined value of custom range 1  2  or 3   The example below reports that custom range 1 is defined to 5 50 ppb     Send  custom 1  Receive  custom 1 550E 2 ppb    set custom range range value   set custom 1 value   set custom 2 value   set custom 3 value   set custom 1 range value   set custom 2 range value   set custom 3 range value   These commands are used to set the maximum concentration for any of the  three custom ranges 1  2  or 3 to range value  where value is a floating point  number representing concentration in ppb or pg m   The example below  sets the custom 1 range to 55 5 ppb     Send  set custom 1 range 55 5  Receive  set custom 1 range 55 5 ok    range mode  This command reports the current range mode     Send  range mode  Receive  range mode single    set range mode mode    This command sets the current range mode to single  dual  or auto  The  example below sets the range mode to single     Send  set range mode single  Receive  set range m
208. le gas bypasses  the NO2 to NO converter  Therefore  only the NO concentration is  determined  The manual NOx mode puts the mode solenoid valve into the  closed position so that the sample gas passes through the NO  to NO  converter  Therefore  only the NO  concentration is determined  In the  manual modes  additional averaging times of 1  2  and 5 seconds are  available from the Averaging Times screen     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Auto Manual  Mode        EEE E Saeed boose          Datalogging Settings The Datalogging Settings menu deals with datalogging     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Datalogging  Settings     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 27    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu       tO Mihei i          Select SREC LREC The Select SREC LREC is used to select short record or long record format    for other operations in this menu     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Datalogging Settings   gt  Select SREC LREC        ERE E    p LP pn pH pimpi  PEDER ie Priv ig Kiet OPEL iniiai i       View Logged Data The View Logged Data screen is used to select the start point to view the  logged data by number of records or date and time     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Datalogging Settings   gt  Select SREC or LREC  gt  View Logged Data        DH Guide  I a E SO a EA          Number of Records The Number of Records screen is used to select the starting point to 
209. lectricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    1  Turn instrument OFF and unplug the power cord     7 8 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  Pump Replacement    2  Ifthe instrument is mounted in a rack  remove it from the rack   3  Remove the cover     4  Disconnect the plumbing connections at the rear of the measurement    bench     5  Disconnect the three connectors that pass through the center of the  partition panel     6  Remove two screws from the left side of the case  viewed from front    7  Remove one screw from the bottom front of the case   8  Remove one screw from the top front of the partition panel     9  While holding the case securely  loosen the captive screw at the rear of  the measurement bench  and pull the measurement bench from the rear  of the case     10  Remove the screw at the top rear of the partition panel securing the top  of partition panel to the measurement bench  and lower the panel being  careful not to put excessive tension on the cables     11  Replace the measurement bench by following previous steps in reverse     se the following procedure to replace the pump  see Figure 7   4   To   Pump Replacement Use the following proced place the pump  see Figure 7 4  T  rebuild the pump  see    Pump Rebuilding    in the    Preventive Maintenance     chapter     Equipment Required   110V pump or 220V pump    1  Disconnect the pump power line 
210. leshooting procedure is completed  the initial  value can be re entered thereby not altering the multipoint calibration  A    Although it is recommended that a GPT system be used to calibrate the  analyzer  the procedure described in the Code of Federal Regulations  Title  40  Part 50  Appendix F using a NO  permeation tube may be used as an  alternative procedure for calibrating the instrument     The dual auto range calibration feature is used to calibrate the analyzer at  two different span levels  as opposed to a single span level in the standard  mode  generating a    tailored multi point    calibration curve stored in the  analyzer s memory  This feature may be used     e When widely different gas levels are being monitored  such as a factor  of 10 or greater apart    e If precision and span levels are being introduced using separate tanks    e If more than one multi component cylinder is being used to calibrate  the instrument    Properly designed chemiluminescence analyzers are inherently linear over a  wide dynamic range  and under normal USEPA compliance situations this  feature is not required  Dual calibration may be used for span levels less  than a factor of 10 apart  however if this is done to correct for a significant  non linearity  it may mask the problems causing the effect  such as  bad  calibration cylinder  leaks in sampling lines  or low ozonator output     Use the following procedures to calibrate the analyzer in dual or auto range  mode     Use the fo
211. llowing procedure to set the prereactor background reading to  zero  Both the NO background and NO  background screens operate the  same way  and the following procedure also applies to the NO and NOx  background screen     For detailed information about the menu parameters and the icons used in  these procedures  see the    Operation    chapter     1  Follow the    Pre Calibration    procedure described previously in this  chapter     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Calibration  Calibration in Dual Range and Auto Range Mode    2  Introduce zero air to the SAMPLE bulkhead and allow the analyzer to  sample zero air until the NO  NO   and NO  responses stabilize     3  When the responses stabilize  from the Main Menu choose Calibration   gt  Cal Prereactor Zero     4  The Prereactor Background screen displays the current prereactor  background and zero concentration     5  Press to set the zero background to zero   6  Press   gt    to return to the Run screen     7  Repeat Steps 3 through 6  selecting Cal NO Background or Cal NOx  Background to set the NO and NO  backgrounds to zero     Calibrate Low NO Use the following procedure to calibrate NO channel to the NO    calibration gas     1  Disconnect the source of zero air from the SAMPLE bulkhead  In its  place  connect a source of NO calibration gas of about 80  of the low    NO full scale range     2  Allow the analyzer to sample the low NO calibration gas until the NO   NO  and NO  readings stabilize     3  When the responses a
212. logging period B 23  malloc Irec Reports sets memory allocation for long records B 23  malloc srec Reports sets memory allocation for short records B 23  me  menu  Simulates pressing menu pushbutton B 29  meas mode Reports sets which measurement mode is active B 34  mode Reports operating mode in local  service  or remote B 41  no Reports current NO concentration B 10  no bkg Reports sets current NO background B 28  no coef Reports sets current NO coefficient B 26  no gas Reports sets NO span gas concentration B 27  no of Irec Reports sets number of long records stored in memory B 23  no of srec Reports sets number of short records stored in memory B 23  no2 Reports current NO  concentration B 10    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 7    C Link Protocol Commands  Accessing Streaming Data    B 8 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual                                                                                           Command Description Page  no2 coef Reports sets current NO  coefficient B 26  no2 gas Reports sets NO  span gas concentration B 27  nox Reports current NO  concentration B 10  nox bkg Reports sets current NO  background B 28  nox coef Reports sets current NO  coefficient B 26  nox gas Reports sets NO  span gas concentration B 27  ozonator Reports sets ozonator on or off B 36  ozonator flow Reports current ozonator flow B 36  ozonator safety Reports sets ozonator safety on or off B 36  ozonator status Reports status of ozonator and safety B 36  pmt 
213. ls  gt  Communication  Settings  gt  Baud Rate        Instrument ID The Instrument ID screen allows the operator to edit the instrument ID   The ID is used to identify the instrument when using the C Link or  MODBUS protocols to control the instrument or collect data  It may be  necessary to edit the ID number if two or more of the same instrument are  connected to one computer  Valid Instrument ID numbers are from 0 to  127  The Model 427 Trace Level has a default Instrument ID of 42  For  more information about the Instrument ID  see Appendix B    C Link  Protocol Commands    or Appendix C    MODBUS Protocol        e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Communication  Settings  gt  Instrument ID     3 36 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu       Communication Protocol The Communication Protocol screen is used to change the instrument  communication protocol for serial communications     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Communication  Settings  gt  Communication Protocol        Streaming Data Configuration The Streaming Data Configuration menu is used to allow for configuration  of the 8 streaming data output items  streaming interval  current data  format  and current timestamp setting  The Choose Item Signal submenu  displays a list of the analog output signal group choices to choose from   Choices are Concentrations  Other Measurements  and Analog Inputs  if  the I O expansi
214. m  The selected item is shown  by     lt       after it  Items displayed are determined by the options installed     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Communication  Settings  gt  Streaming Data Config  gt  Select Item  gt  Other  Measurements        The Analog Inputs screen allows the user to select the analog input signal   none or analog inputs 1 8  that is tied to the selected streaming data item   The selected item is shown by     lt       after it     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Communication  Settings  gt  Streaming Data Config  gt  Select Item  gt  Analog Inputs        The RS 232 RS 485 Selection screen allows the user to choose between the  RS 232 or RS 485 specification for serial communication     Note Disconnect the serial cable before changing RS 232 and RS 485  selection to prevent damage to the connected equipment  A    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 39    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Communication    Settings  gt  RS 232 RS 485 Selection     ERED CH   STIS OP TE bet    PPP L E bed PERRO PLP       ERED Pati ri ppr    TCP IP Settings The TCP IP Settings menu is used for defining TCP IP settings    Note The instrument power must be cycled after any of these parameters  have been changed for the change to take effect  A    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Communication  Settings  gt  TCP IP Settings        Bae  Pike PEE F          Use 
215. minal Board PCB Assembly  DB37M  standard with all  instruments           103084 00    Converter       Pressure Transducer           p m ea  Input Board A y d       hjm    Measurement JA                Interface Board   eaaa  gt     hy       i    i g    Power Supply    i   a ye    Ses    T     R        Ozonator  Transformer        Terminal Board PCB Assembly  DB25M  standard with all  instruments     Reaction PMT Assembly    Transducer Chamber  Flow    Switch    Capillaries  2         ail  i f    1 0 Expansion  Board  Opt           Solenoids  3  Motherboard Digital Output Board    Figure 7 2  Component Layout    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 7    Servicing  Removing the Measurement Bench and Lowering the Partition Panel    Removing the The measurement bench can be removed and the partition panel can be  Measurement Bench lowered to improve access to connectors and components  Refer to the    following steps when a procedure requires lowering the partition panel  see    and Lowering the igure 7 3    Partition Panel    SLIDE BENCH OUT        REMOVE SCREWS Pass Through  Connectors    Partition Panel          Remove Screw    Loosen  Captive         Remove Screws  Remove Screw    _      is    LOWER PANEL    T Remove Hidden Screw    Figure 7 3  Removing the Measurement Bench and Lowering the Partition  Panel    Equipment Required     Philips screwdriver    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static e
216. ms Menu    Min and Max Cooler The Minimum Cooler Temperature alarm limit screen is used to change  Temperature Limits the minimum cooler temperature alarm limit  The minimum and  maximum cooler temperature screens function the same way     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Cooler Temp  gt  Min or Max        Converter Temperature The Converter Temperature screen displays the current converter  temperature and sets the minimum and maximum alarm limits  Acceptable  alarm limits range from 300 to 700   C  The actual alarm setpoints should  be set for the installed converter  If the converter temperature reading goes  beyond either the minimum or maximum limit  an alarm is activated  The  word    ALARM    appears in the Run screen and in the Main Menu     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Converter Temp        Min and Max Converter The Minimum Converter Temperature alarm limit screen is used to change  Temperature Limits the minimum converter temperature alarm limit  The minimum and  maximum converter temperature screens function the same way     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Alarms  gt  Converter Temp  gt  Min or Max     3 66 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Alarms Menu       Pressure The Pressure screen displays the current reaction chamber pressure reading  and sets the minimum and maximum alarm limits  Acceptable alarm limits  range from 200 to 450 mmHg  If the pressure reading goes beyond either  the minimum or maximum limit 
217. mtv    115    erec   This command returns a brief description of the main operating conditions  at the time the command is issued  i e  dynamic data   The example below  shows a typical response  The format is defined by the current settings of     format    and    erec format    commands  For details on how to decode the  flag fields within these records  see the    flags    command     Send  erec  Receive  erec    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 19    C Link Protocol Commands  Datalogging    B 20 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    10 11 04 06 05 flags DD008000 no 0 000 nox 0 000 no2  0 000 1 lono 147 500 lonox 0 000 lono2 0 000 1 pmtv  805 491 tempal 1 pres 172 278 pcal 150 000 smplf 0 000  ozonf 0 050 hiavgtime 10 loavgtime 10 nobkg 0 000  noxbkg 0 000 nocoef 1 000 noxcoef 1 000 no2coef 1 000  lonocoef 1 000 lonoxcoef 1 000 lono2coef 1 000 norange  100000 000 noxrange 100000 000 no2range 100000 000  lonorange 100000 000 lonoxrange 100000 000 lono2range  100000  000    lrec  srec  lrec xxxx yy  SEEC XXXX YY    lrec aa bb 00 pp qq yy  srec aa bb 00 pp qq yy    xxxx   the number of past records   yy   the number of records to return  1 to 10   aa   hours  01 to 24    bb   minutes  01 to 59    oo   month  01 to 12    pp   day  01 to 31    qq   yeat    These commands output long or short records and dynamic data  The  output format is determined by the    set lrec format     and    set srec format     commands  The logging time is determined by the    set lr
218. n a Thermo non ElA rack  includes mounting slides  and  retrofit front panel rack mounting handles     9 4 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Optional Equipment  Mounting Options                Figure 9 2  Rack Mount Option Assembly    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 9 5    Optional Equipment  Mounting Options    16 75 REF       Figure 9 3  Bench Mounting    9 6 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Optional Equipment  Mounting Options    16 75       Figure 9   4  EIA Rack Mounting    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 9 7    Optional Equipment  Mounting Options    16 75       Figure 9 5  Retrofit Rack Mounting    9 8 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Appendix A  Warranty    Seller warrants that the Products will operate or perform substantially in  conformance with Seller s published specifications and be free from defects  in material and workmanship  when subjected to normal  proper and  intended usage by properly trained personnel  for the period of time set  forth in the product documentation  published specifications or package  inserts  Ifa period of time is not specified in Seller   s product  documentation  published specifications or package inserts  the warranty  period shall be one  1  year from the date of shipment to Buyer for  equipment and ninety  90  days for all other 
219. n gas     4 18 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    l     Adjust the O  generator in the GPT system to generate sufficient O  to  produce a decrease in the low NO concentration equivalent to about  80  of the URL of the low NO  range  The decrease must not exceed  90  of the low NO concentration determined in the    Calibrate Low  NO     procedure     From the Main Menu choose Calibration  gt  Cal Lo NO2 Coefficient     The Lo NO  field displays the current NO  concentration  The Lo  NO  Span Conc field is where you enter the Lo NO  calibration gas  concentration     Set the low NO  calibration gas concentration to reflect the sum of the  NO  concentration generated by GPT and any NO  impurity     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Calibrate High NO    Calibrate High NO     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Calibration  Calibration in Dual Range and Auto Range Mode    Use      gt   to move the cursor left and right and use   t        to increment and decrement the numeric character at the cursor     Press to calculate and save the new low NO  coefficient based on    the entered span concentration     Use the following procedure to calibrate the NO channel to the NO    calibration gas     l     Connect a source of high NO calibration gas of about 80  of the high  NO full scale range  Allow the analyzer to sample the high NO  calibration gas until the NO  NO2  and NO  readings have stabilized     After the responses have stabilized  from the Main Menu  choose    Calibration  gt  Cal 
220. n or off  The example  below reports that the PMT is on     Send  pmt status  Receive  pmt status on    set pmt onoff  These commands set the PMT on or off  The example below turns the  PMT off     Send  set pmt off  Receive  set pmt off ok  save    set save params   This command stores all current parameters in FLASH memory  It is  important that each time instrument parameters are changed  that this  command be sent  If changes are not saved  they will be lost in the event of  a power failure  The example below saves the parameters to FLASH  memory     Send  set save params  Receive  set save params ok  time    This command reports the current time  24 hour time   The example  below reports that the internal time is 2 15 30 pm     Send  time  Receive  time 14 15 30    Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual B 37    C Link Protocol Commands  Communications Configuration    Communications  Configuration    B 38 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    set time hh mm ss  hh   hours   mm   minutes   ss   seconds    This command sets the internal clock  24 hour time   The example below  sets the internal time to 2 15 pm     Note If seconds are omitted  the seconds default to 00  A    Send  set time 14 15   Receive  set time 14 15 ok   addr dns   This command reports the TCP IP address for the domain name server   Send  addr dns   Receive  addr dns 192 168 1 1   set addr dns address    This command sets the dns address  where address consists of four numbers      9    ranging
221. ncentration levels require  for sub ambient monitoring  Although extra care is required  primarily in  zero air generation  users familiar with normal compliance requirements  should be able with minimal additional effort to obtain valid concentration  data     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual E 3    
222. ne and produces  excited NO  that gives off a photon of energy when it decays     The reaction chamber is heated and controlled to approximately 50   C in  order to ensure the greatest instrument stability  The sample and ozone  flow capillaries and a thermistor sensor are also housed in on the reaction  chamber assembly     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Optical Filter    Pressure Transducer    Sample Flow Sensor    Ozonator    Ozonator Flow  Switch    Photomultiplier Tube    Photomultiplier Tube  Cooler    External Pump    Sample Capillary    Thermo Fisher Scientific    System Description  Ozonator    The optical filter housed in the reaction chamber limits the spectral region  viewed by the detector and eliminates possible interferences due to other  chemiluminescent reactions     The pressure transducer measures the reaction chamber pressure     The sample flow sensor located at the reaction chamber inlet measures the  sample flow into the reaction chamber     The Ozonator generates the necessary ozone concentration required for the  chemiluminescent reaction  The ozone reacts with the NO in the ambient  air sample to produce the electronically excited NO2 molecules     The ozonator flow switch located at the ozonator inlet completes an  electrical safety circuit when air flows through the sensor to the ozonator  If  airflow stops  the flow sensor breaks the electrical circuit to the ozonator  and shuts it off to prevent the ozonator from overheating     The Photomultiplier 
223. nector Pin Descriptions    on page 6 13     Front Panel Board Connector Pin Diagram    on page 6 16       I O Expansion Board  Optional  Connector Pin Descriptions    on page 6   18       Digital Output Board Connector Pin Descriptions    on page 6 19     Input Board Connector Pin Descriptions    on page 6 20       Temperature Control Board Connector Pin Descriptions    on page 6 21    Table 6 3  Motherboard Connector Pin Descriptions    Connector Reference Pin Signal Description  Label Designator    INTF DATA J1 1 Ground   RS485 to Interface Board   RS485 to Interface Board    w N       10 BASE T J2         Ethernet Output      Ethernet Output      Ethernet Input       NC   NC   Ethernet Input       NC   NC   Ground    RS485 to Interface Board   RS485 to Interface Board    co N Oo wo A WwW N       INTF DATA J1         wo N       10 BASE T J2            Ethernet Output      Ethernet Output      Ethernet Input      NC    FP Wo N    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Troubleshooting  Connector Pin Descriptions    Connector Reference Pin Signal Description  Label Designator    NC   Ethernet Input      NC   NC    5V    24V    24V    co NY OD wo       EXPANSION BD J2            Ground   Ground   Ground   RS485 to Expansion Board   RS485 to Expansion Board   5V    24V    24V    oOo N oOo wo A WO N       SPARE DATA J12         Ground  Ground  Ground   RS485 to Spare Board   RS485 to Spare Board    aoa N oon A Wo N        0 J5         Power Fail Relay N C  Contact  Ground   TTL Input 1  TTL
224. ng External Devices    25 Pin Terminal Board The 25 pin terminal board is included with the optional I O Expansion    Board     See Detail    A       y See Detail    B          Assembled Connector    Figure 2 7  25 Pin Terminal Board Views    Detail    A          Table 2 3  25 Pin Terminal Board Pin Descriptions    Detail    B                                           Pin Signal Description Pin Signal Description  1 lOut1 13 Analog_In1  2 Isolated ground 14 Analog_In2  3 lOut2 15 Analog_In3  4 Isolated ground 16 GNDD   5 lOut3 17 Analog_In4  6 Isolated ground 18 Analog_In5  7 lOut4 19 Analog_In6  8 Isolated ground 20 GNDD   9 lOut5 21 Analog_In7  10 Isolated ground 22 Analog_In8  11 lOut6 23 GNDD   12 Isolated ground 24 GNDD    2 8 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual       Thermo Fisher Scientific    Installation  Startup    Sta FtUP Use the following procedure when starting the instrument   1  Turn the power ON     2  Allow 90 minutes for the instrument to stabilize     3  Set instrument parameters such as operating ranges and averaging times  to appropriate settings  For more information about instrument  parameters  see the    Operation    chapter     4  Before beginning the actual monitoring  perform a multipoint  calibration as described in the    Calibration    chapter     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 2 9    Chapter 3  Operation    This chapter describes the front panel display  front panel pushbuttons  and  menu driven software
225. ng chapters and appendixes to provide direct access to specific    operation and service information     Chapter 1    Introduction    provides an overview of product features   describes the principles of operation  and lists the specifications     Chapter 2    Installation    describes how to unpack  setup  and startup  the analyzer     Chapter 3    Operation    describes the front panel display  the front  panel pushbuttons  and the menu driven software     Chapter 4    Calibration    provides the procedures for calibrating the  analyzer and describes the required equipment     Chapter 5    Preventative Maintenance    provides maintenance  procedures to ensure reliable and consistent instrument operation     Chapter 6    Troubleshooting    presents guidelines for diagnosing  analyzer failures  isolating faults  and includes recommended actions for  restoring proper operation     Chapter 7    Servicing    presents safety alerts for technicians working on  the analyzer  step by step instructions for repairing and replacing  components  and a replacement parts list  It also includes contact  information for product support and technical information     Chapter 8    System Description    describes the function and location of  the system components  provides an overview of the software structure   and includes a description of the system electronics and input output  connections     Chapter 9    Optional Equipment    describes the optional equipment  that can be used with this 
226. ng the instrument  use procedure appropriate to lifting a heavy  object  such as  bending at the knees while keeping your back straight and  upright  Grasp the instrument at the bottom in the front and at the rear of  the unit  Although one person can lift the unit  it is desirable to have two  persons lifting  one by grasping the bottom in the front and the other by  grasping the bottom in the rear     Equipment Damage Do not attempt to lift the instrument by the cover or  other external fittings  A    The Model 42i Trace Level is shipped complete in two containers  If there  is obvious damage to the shipping containers when you receive the  instrument  notify the carrier immediately and hold for inspection  The  carrier is responsible for any damage incurred during shipment     Use the following procedure to unpack and inspect the instrument     1  Remove the instrument from its shipping container and set it on a table  or bench that allows easy access to both the front and rear     2  Remove the cover to expose the internal components     3  Remove the packing material  Figure 2 1      Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 2 1    Installation  Setup Procedure                                   Remove Packing   2 pieces                 Remove Packing   2 pieces                                                        Z    Units without Optional 1 0 Board Units with Optional 1 0 Board    Setup Procedure    2 2 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    Figure 2   1  Remove 
227. nostics  gt  Voltages  gt  I O Board  Voltages        Cs a  EG D          Temperatures The Temperatures screen  read only  displays the internal temperature   reaction chamber temperature  cooler temperature  and converter    temperatures  The internal temperature is the air temperature measured by  a sensor located on the interface board     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Diagnostics  gt  Temperatures        3 58 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Diagnostics Menu    Pressure The Pressure screen  read only  displays the reaction chamber pressure  The  pressure is measured by a pressure transducer at the reaction chamber     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Diagnostics  gt  Pressure           Flow The Flow screen  read only  displays the flow rate  The flow is measured by  internal flow sensors  For more information  see    Introduction        e Inthe Main Menu  choose Diagnostics  gt  Flow        mbit PELIR E  PRECEDES fe ri       Prereactor Zero The Prereactor Zero screen  read only  displays the current prereactor  background  zero  reading  In dual or auto range modes  low range and  high range are displayed  The example below shows the prereactor zero  screen in single range mode     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Diagnostics  gt  Prereactor Zero     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 59    Operation  Diagnostics Menu    Analog Input  Readings    Analog Input  Voltages    Digital Inputs    3 60 Model 42  Trace 
228. ns   0 0    eee eee ceceeeseseeseeeeseseeseseeseseeseeeeneees 3 3  Table 3 2  Default Analog Outputs in Single Range Mode             c ccccceeeee 3 9  Table 3 3  Default Analog Outputs in Dual Range Mode               cece 3 10  Table 3 4  Default Analog Outputs in Auto Range Mode            ccccceeeeeee 3 12  Table 3 5  Available Operating Ranges        0    c cccccccccccscesestesestesestesesteseeeeeees 3 14  Table 3   6  Analog Output Zero to Full Scale Table oo    cece 3 48  Table 3 7  Signal Type Group Choices    ceccecccccceccscesestesestesesteseetesesteseeeeees 3 49  Table 4 1  Scrubbing Materials casas ee ae as 4 2  Table 6   1  Troubleshooting   General Guide oo    ccc cece ceeeteseeteseeteseeeees 6 2  Table 6 2  Troubleshooting   Alarm Messages            cccccecesesesceteseseeteneeenenees 6 4  Table 6 3  Motherboard Connector Pin Descriptions         0    ccccccceccseesesteeeeeees 6 8  Table 6   4  Measurement Interface Board Connector Pin Descriptions           6 13  Table 6 5  Front Panel Board Connector Pin Diagram           cccccccceccsceteeeeeees 6 16  Table 6   6    O Expansion Board  Optional  Connector Pin Descriptions          6 18  Table 6 7  Digital Output Board Connector Pin Descriptions             0cccece 6 19  Table 6 8  Input Board Connector Pin Descriptions            100110011151115111011111  6 20  Table 6 9  Temperature Control Board Connector Pin Descriptions                6 21  Table 7   1  Model 42  Trace Level Replacement Parts    cece eeeen
229. ntage of  Percent cach record type for both short records and long records  Percentages  between 0 and 100  are available in increments of 10  Changing this value  results in log erasure for both short records and long records     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Datalogging Settings   gt  Configure Datalogging  gt  Memory Allocation          ERED CH  perm    H WH mnt  PS PHP ELSES Pi AG Lf bi       Data Treatment The Data Treatment screen is used to select the data type for the selected  record type  whether the data should be averaged over the interval  the  minimum or maximum measured during the interval  or the current value   last value measured   Data treatment doesn   t apply to all data  just to the  concentration measurement  All other data points log the current value at  the end of the interval     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Datalogging Settings   gt  Configure Datalogging  gt  Data Treatment        Communication The Communication Settings menu is used with communications control  Settings and configuration     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Communication  Settings     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 35    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu       Baud Rate    The Baud Rate screen is used to set the RS 232 RS 485 interface baud rate   Baud rates of 1200  2400  4800  and 9600  19200  38400  57600  and  115200 are available     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Contro
230. ntration alarm limits  Values must be in  the units that are currently set for use  The example below sets the NO  concentration alarm maximum value to 115     Send  set alarm conc no max 115  Receive  set alarm conc no max 115 ok    alarm converter temp min   alarm converter temp max   These commands report the converter temperature alarm minimum and  maximum value current settings  The example below reports that the  converter temperature alarm minimum value is 300 0   C     Send  alarm chamber temp min  Receive  alarm chamber temp min 300 0 deg C    set alarm converter temp min value   set alarm converter temp max value   These commands set the converter temperature alarm minimum and  maximum values to value  where value is a floating point number  representing converter temperature alarm limits in degrees C  The example  below sets the converter temperature alarm maximum value to 340 0   C     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Alarms    Send  set alarm converter temp max 340  Receive  set alarm converter temp max 340 ok    alarm cooler temp min   alarm cooler temp max   These commands report the cooler temperature alarm minimum and  maximum value current settings  The example below reports that the cooler  temperature alarm minimum value is  10 0   C     Send  alarm cooler temp min  Receive  alarm cooler temp min  10 0 deg C    set alarm cooler temp min value   set alarm cooler temp max value   These commands set the cooler 
231. nu  choose Diagnostics  gt  Program Version     3 56 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Diagnostics Menu       ERED CH  vee  Bet EPP Eesi ar in    i EH bo bet  Bs ETE EE Sanat Bone EY Fane Bast    ade 5 i PG       Voltages The Voltages menu displays the current diagnostic voltage readings  This  screen enables the power supply to be quickly read for low or fluctuating  voltages without having to use a voltage meter  The I O board is only  displayed if the I O expansion board option is installed     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Diagnostics  gt  Voltages        Wi mre   rib a EA DE          Motherboard Voltages The Motherboard screen  read only  is used to display the current voltage  readings on the motherboard     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Diagnostics  gt  Voltages  gt  Motherboard  Voltages        ERED CH  MP Tit    Wi hid  PPE Pi AG Lf bie       Interface Board Voltages The Interface Board screen  read only  is used to display the current voltage  readings on the interface board     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 57    Operation  Diagnostics Menu    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Diagnostics  gt  Voltages  gt  Interface Board  Voltages        ip priori  iL i       1 0 Board Voltages The I O Board screen  read only  is used to display the current voltage    readings on the I O expansion board  This menu is only displayed if the  I O expansion board option is installed     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Diag
232. nverter  as standard equipment     The I O expansion board provides six analog current output channels  0   20 mA or 4 20 mA  and eight analog voltage inputs  0 10V   The DB25  connector on the rear panel provides the interface for these inputs and  outputs     The optional terminal block and cable kits provide a convenient way to  connect devices to the instrument  These kits break out the signals on the  rear panel connector to individual numbered terminals     Two types of terminal block and cable kits are available  One kit is for the  DB37 connectors and can be used for either the analog output connector  or the relay output connector  The other kit is for the DB25 connector and  can be used for the optional I O expansion board  For associated part  numbers  refer to    External Device Connection Components    on page 7 6     Each kit consists of   e one six foot cable  e one terminal block    e one snap track    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Cables    Optional Equipment  Cables    Note Supporting all of the connections on units with the optional I O  expansion board requires     e two DB37 kits  e one DB25 kit    Table 9 1 identifies the optional individual cables that are available for the  instrument and Table 9 2 provides the cable color codes  For associated  part numbers  refer to    External Device Connection Components    on page    7 6     Note Table 9   2 provides the color coding for both 25 pin cables and 37   pin cables  Color codes
233. o of lrec   no of srec    These commands report the number of long and short records stored in the  long and short records memory  The example below shows that 50 long  records have been stored in the memory     Send  no of lrec  Receive  no of lrec 50 recs  malloc Irec   malloc srec    These commands report the currently set memory allocation for long and  short records in percent of total memory     Send  malloc lrec  Receive  malloc lrec 10     set malloc lrec value  set malloc srec value  value   0 to 100    These commands set the percent of memory space allocated for long and  short records to value  where value is a floating point number representing    percent  The example below sets the memory allocation for long records to  10     Note Issuing these commands will clear all the logging data memory  All  the existing records should be retrieved using appropriate commands  if  required  A    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 23    C Link Protocol Commands  Datalogging    B 24 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Send  set malloc lrec 10  Receive  set malloc lrec 10 ok    set copy sp to lrec   set copy sp to srec   set copy sp to stream   These commands copy the current selections in scratch pad  sp  into the  long record  short record  or streaming data list  The example below copies  the current list in scratch pad into the long records list     Send  set copy sp to lrec  Receive  set copy sp to lrec ok    set copy lrec to sp   set copy srec to sp   set
234. ode single ok  gas mode    This command reports the current mode of sample  zero  or span  The  example below reports that the gas mode is sample     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Measurement Configuration    Send  gas mode  Receive  gas mode sample  set sample    set sample gas   These commands set the zero span valves to the sample mode  The  example below sets the instrument to sample mode  that is  the instrument  is reading the sample gas     Send  set sample  Receive  set sample ok  set zero    set zero gas   These commands set the zero span valves to the zero mode  The example  below sets the instrument to zero mode that is  the instrument is reading  the sample gas     Send  set zero  Receive  set zero ok  set span   set span gas    These commands set the zero span valves to the span mode  The example  below sets the instrument to span mode that is  the instrument is sampling  span gas     Send  set span  Receive  set span ok  gas unit    This command reports the current gas units  ppb or pg m    The example  reports that the gas unit is set to ppb     Send  gas unit  Receive  gas unit ppb    set gas unit    unit     ppb   pg m       This command sets the gas units to ppb or pg m     The example below sets  the gas units to pg m        Send  set gas unit ug m3  Receive  set gas unit ug m3 ok    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 33    C Link Protocol Commands  Hardware Configuration    Hardware  Configuration
235. oefficients  There are two span coefficients so that each range can be  calibrated separately  This is necessary if the two ranges are not close to one  another  For example  the low NO range is set to 0   50 ppb and the high  NO range is set to 0 200 ppb     Figure 3   6  Analog Output in Auto Range Mode    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 11    Operation  Range Menu    By default  in the auto range mode  the analog outputs are arranged on the    rear panel connector as shown in Figure 3 7  See Table 3   4 for channels    and pin connections  Auto range mode may be selected from the    Range    Mode Select    on page 3 74                        000000000000000000  0000000000000000 000                       Figure 3 7  Pin Out of Rear Connector in Auto Range Mode    Table 3 4  Default Analog Outputs in Auto Range Mode                   Channel Connector Pin 1 0 Terminal Pin Description   1 14 1 NO Analog Output   2 33 3 NO  Analog Output   3 15 5 NO  Analog Output   4 34 7 Range Status   half scale   high range  zero scale   low range   5 17 g None   6 36 11 None   Ground 16  18  19  35  37 2 4 6 8  10  12 Signal Ground    Note All channels are user definable  If any customization has been made  to the analog output configuration  the default selections my not apply  A    3 12 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Gas Units    NO  NO2  and NO     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Ranges    Operation  Range Menu   
236. on board option is installed      e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Communication  Settings  gt  Streaming Data Config        Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 37    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu       DHATI mg  a bea          Streaming Data Interval The Streaming Data Interval screen is used to adjust the streaming data    interval  The following interval times are available  1  2  5  10  20  30  60   90  120  180  240  and 300 seconds     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Communication  Settings  gt  Streaming Data Config  gt  Streaming Data Interval     DH Guide  Piet       Concentrations The Concentrations screen allows the user to select the output signal that is  tied to the selected streaming data item  The selected item is shown by      lt       after it  In dual or auto range mode     HI    or    LO    is displayed to  indicate high or low concentrations  Range  NO   is visible only in auto  range mode    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Communication  Settings  gt  Streaming Data Config  gt  Select Item  gt  Concentrations        uns re  ria i          3 38 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Other Measurements    Analog Inputs    RS 232 RS 485 Selection    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu    The Other Measurements screen allows the user to select the output signal  that is tied to the selected streaming data ite
237. ons    Connector Reference Pin Signal Description  Label Designator    3 Ground    Table 6   6    0 Expansion Board  Optional  Connector Pin Descriptions    Connector Reference Pin Signal Description  Label Designator    EXPANSION I O J1         Analog Voltage Input 1  Analog Voltage Input 2  Analog Voltage Input 3  Ground   Analog Voltage Input 4  Analog Voltage Input 5  Analog Voltage Input 6    Ground    oOo aoa nN wD oO FP WO PD    Analog Voltage Input 7     gt         Analog Voltage Input 8     a       Ground   NC   NC   Ground   Current Output 1  Current Output Return  Current Output 2  Current Output Return       x x      a       gt   co loo  N o  Sz A w N    Current Output 3    N        Current Output Return    N       Current Output 4    N  N    Current Output Return    N  o    Current Output 5    N  5    Current Output Return    N  Sai    Current Output 6   5V    24V    24V       MOTHER BD J2    wo N        6 18 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Troubleshooting  Connector Pin Descriptions    Connector Reference Pin Signal Description  Label Designator  4 Ground  5 Ground  6 Ground  7  RS485 to Motherboard  8  RS485 to Motherboard    Table 6 7  Digital Output Board Connector Pin Descriptions    Connector Reference Pin Signal Description  Label Designator    MOTHER BD J1    wi     5V    24V   24V  Ground  Ground  Ground  SPI Reset  SPI Input  SPI Output  10 SPI Board Select  11 SPI Clock    DIGITAL J2 1 Relay 1 Contact a  OUTPUTS    
238. pan Avg Sec     3 24 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu       Zero Span Ratio The Zero Span Ratio screen is used to adjust the ratio of zeros to spans  For  example  if this value is set to 1  a span check will follow every zero check   If this value is set to 3  there will be two zero checks between each  zero span check  This value may be set from 1 to 10  with 1 as default     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Calibration  gt  Zero Span Check  gt   Zero Span Ratio        Instrument Co ntrols The Instrument Controls menu contains a number of items  The software    M enu controls listed in this menu enable control of the listed instrument  functions     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls     Pra es       Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 25    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu    Ozonator The Ozonator screen is used to turn the internal ozonator on or off  The  display shows the status of the control line that turns the ozonator on or  off  The next line of the display shows the user specified ozonator setting   Under most conditions  the control line status and ozonator set status are  the same  However  as a safety precaution  the microprocessor can override  the user specified ozonator setting  This occurs only if the ozonator flow  doesn   t indicate any flow or if the NO  converter temperature is below the  minimum alarm limit  In this case  an alarm is activated
239. placement    7 12 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    8  Rotate the counterweight until the connecting rod is in mid stroke and  then tighten the clamping disc  Do not over tighten the clamping disc     Note Over tightening of the clamping disc will significantly reduce  diaphragm life  Tighten enough to avoid contact with the head  Ifa  significant amount of torque is required to tighten  first re check to see if  the threads are clear  then check that the connection rod support disc     H      is properly seated on the connection rod  Over torque of the clamping disc  must never be a way to avoid contact with the head  A    9  Remove the two temporary aligning screws and re install the heads on  to the pump body  The correct head bolt torque range is 20 30 inch   pounds     10  Turn the counterweight     M     through at least one full revolution to  check for smooth operation     11  Re install the housing cover and check the pump for correct  performance     Use the following procedure to replace the valve     1  With the head off the pump  unscrew the socket head cap screws with  M4 lock washers     S     to remove the head lid     T     and gasket     V         2  Loosen the single pan head screw  washers and nut     P     and remove  the two stainless steel reed valves     Q      If necessary  hold the nut in  place with a nut driver     3  Lightly clean the valve seat area of debris or deposits with fine grade  steel wool  This area must be clean and smooth  w
240. pment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 43    Servicing  Measurement Interface Board Replacement    1  Turn instrument OFF  unplug the power cord  and remove the cover     2  Remove the I O expansion board  optional   if used  See the    I O  Expansion Board Replacement    procedure in this chapter     3  Remove the digital output board  See the    Digital Output Board  Replacement    procedure in this chapter     4  Unplug all connectors from the motherboard  Note connector locations  to facilitate reconnection     5  Using the nut driver  remove the six standoffs securing the board to the  rear panel     6  Pop off the motherboard from motherboard support bracket  and  remove the motherboard     7  To install the motherboard  follow previous steps in reverse     8  Calibrate the analog voltage outputs as defined earlier in this chapter   all ranges      Measurement Use the following procedure to replace the measurement interface board  Fi    21    Interface Board    7        Replacement a  Pment Required     Measurement interface board    Philips screwdriver    f Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small    amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    1  Lower the partit
241. ponse B 30   Use iscreen instead   sp field Reports sets item number and name in scratch pad list B 24  span Sets zero span valves to span mode B 33  span gas Sets zero span valves to span gas mode B 33  sr Reports last short record stored B 19  srec Reports maximum number of short records B 20  srec format Reports sets output format for short records  ASCII or binary  B 21  srec layout Reports current layout of short record data B 22  srec mem size Reports maximum number of short records B 22  srec per Reports sets short record logging period B 23  stream per Reports sets current set time interval for streaming data B 25  stream time Reports sets a time stamp to streaming data or not B 25  temp comp Reports sets temperature compensation on or off B 34  time Reports sets current time  24 hour time  B 37  up Simulates pressing up pushbutton B 29  zero Sets zero span valves to zero mode B 33  zero gas Sets zero span valves to zero gas mode B 33  avg time  high avg time    low avg time    These commands report the averaging time in seconds when operating in  single range  or averaging time used with the high and low ranges when   operating in dual or auto range mode  The example below shows that the  averaging time is 300 seconds  according to Table B   2     Send   Receive     avg time  avg time 12 300 sec    set avg time selection    set high avg time selection    set low avg time selection    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 9    C Link Protocol Commands  Measuremen
242. products  the  Warranty  Period    Seller agrees during the Warranty Period  to repair or replace  at  Seller s option  defective Products so as to cause the same to operate in  substantial conformance with said published specifications  provided that   a  Buyer shall promptly notify Seller in writing upon the discovery of any  defect  which notice shall include the product model and serial number  if  applicable  and details of the warranty claim   b  after Seller   s review  Seller  will provide Buyer with service data and or a Return Material  Authorization     RMA      which may include biohazard decontamination  procedures and other product specific handling instructions  and  c  then   if applicable  Buyer may return the defective Products to Seller with all  costs prepaid by Buyer  Replacement parts may be new or refurbished  at  the election of Seller  All replaced parts shall become the property of Seller   Shipment to Buyer of repaired or replacement Products shall be made in  accordance with the Delivery provisions of the Seller   s Terms and  Conditions of Sale  Consumables  including but not limited to lamps   fuses  batteries  bulbs and other such expendable items  are expressly  excluded from the warranty under this warranty     Notwithstanding the foregoing  Products supplied by Seller that are  obtained by Seller from an original manufacturer or third party supplier are  not warranted by Seller  but Seller agrees to assign to Buyer any warranty  rights in suc
243. ps up a selection list with input  translation  That is  the values read are translated before they are  compared to the selection list options     L   Indicates a button which pops up a selection list without any  translation  The output value is number of the selected option     T   Indicates a button which pops up a selection list with output  translation  The number of the option selected is used as an index into  the translation table to generate an output string     N   Indicates a button which only sends the subsequent command to  the instrument  No user prompting happens     The following string through an optional         or the end of the line is the  command which is to be sent to the instrument upon the completion of the  button selection  The command string should normally contain print style  formatting to include the user input  If a         is present  it indicates a    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 49    C Link Protocol Commands  Record Layout Definition    Examples    B 50 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    command which is sent to the instrument upon successful completion of  the button command to update the value field     This is not currently used     Some examples      n  is the C syntax for an end of line character         Concentrations n     This is a single text only line       n     This is a single blank line       NO 3s n     This is a line which appears slightly indented  The text field is  NO   the  value is taken from the
244. r Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 85    Operation  Password Menu    Restore User  Defaults         Password Menu    Set Password    3 86 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    The Restore User Defaults screen is used to reset the user calibration and  configuration values to factory defaults  The restore default user is visible  only when the instrument is in service mode  For more information on the  service mode  see    Service Mode    earlier in the chapter     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Restore User Defaults     DH md  PLP e          The Password menu allows the user to configure password protection  If  the instrument is locked  none of the settings may be changed via the front  panel user interface  The items visible under the password menu are  determined by the instrument   s password status     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Password              The Set Password screen is used to set the password to unlock the front  panel  The set password is shown if the instrument is unlocked and the  password is set     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Password  gt  Set Password    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Lock Instrument                Lock Instrument The Lock Instrument screen is used to lock the instrument s front panel so    users can not change any settings from the front panel  The lock  instrument is shown if the instrument is unlocked and the password is set     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Password  gt  Lock Instrument       Change 
245. r for  Binary Responses    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Record Layout Definition    The first line of the Layout response is the scanf like parameter list for  parsing the fields from an ASCII ERec response  Parameters are separated  by spaces and the line is terminated by a  n  the normal line separator    character   Valid fields are      s   parse a string    d   parse a decimal number    ld   parse a long  32 bit  decimal number   f   parse a floating point number    x   parse a hexadecimal number    lx   parse a long  32 bit  hex number        ignore the field    Note Signed versus unsigned for the integer values does not matter  it is  handled automatically  a    The second line of the Layout response is the binary parameter list for  parsing the fields from a binary response  Parameters MUST be separated  by spaces  and the line is terminated by a   n   Valid fields are     t   parse a time specifier  2 bytes    D   parse a date specifier  3 bytes    i   ignore one 8 bit character  1 byte    e   parse a 24 bit floating point number  3 bytes  n x   E   parse a 24 bit floating point number  3 bytes  N x   f   parse a 32 bit floating point number  4 bytes     c   parse an 8 bit signed number  1 byte    C   parse an 8 bit unsigned number  1 byte   n   parse a 16 bit signed number  2 bytes   N   parse a 16 bit unsigned number  2 bytes   m   parse a 24 bit signed number  3 bytes   M   parse a 24 bit unsigned number  3 bytes   l   parse a 32 bit signe
246. racted    from the NO reading to produce the NO reading that is displayed     In the example below  the analyzer is displayed 0 09 ppb of NO while  sampling zero air  A background correction is 0 0 ppb means that 0 ppb is  being subtracted from the NO concentration being displayed  Therefore   the background correction must be increased to 0 09 ppb in order for the    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 17    Operation  Calibration Factors Menu    NO  NO   and NO   Coefficients    3 18 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    NO reading to be at 0 ppb  i e   a NO reading of 0 09 ppb minus a NO  background reading of 0 09 ppb gives the corrected NO reading of 0 ppb     To set the NO reading in the example below to zero  use      to  increment the NO background correction to 0 09 ppb  As the NO  background correction is increased  the NO concentration is decreased   Note that at this point  pressing   t Jand       however  has no affect  on the analog outputs or the stored NO background correction of 0 0 ppb   A question mark following both the NO reading and the NO background  correction indicates that these are proposed changes as opposed to  implemented changes  To escape this screen without saving any changes   press to return to the Calibration Factors menu or to return  to the Run screen  Press to actually set the NO reading to 0 ppb and  store the new background correction of 0 09 ppb  Then the question mark  prompt beside the NO reading disappears     e Inthe 
247. ragm  center  J    Counter   weight   White Diaphragm  bottom          a a          Housing       Cover               Upper  Valve   Under     Head Lid          Valve  Installation       Bottom View  of Headplate    HEAD ORIENTATION MAY DIFFER FROM ABOVE        Figure 7   5  Vacuum Pump     Head Plate and Motor View    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 13    Servicing  Fan Replacement    Fan Replacement    7 14 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Use the following procedure to replace the fan  Figure 7   6    Equipment Required   Fan    Philips screwdriver    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    1  Turn instrument OFF  unplug the power cord  and remove the cover   2  Remove the fan guard from the fan and remove the filter    3  Pull the power connectors off the fan    4  Remove the four fan mounting screws and remove the fan     5  Install a new fan following the previous steps in reverse         Mounting Screws  4     Filter    Fan Guard    Figure 7   6  Replacing the Fan    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  PMT Cooler and Reaction Chamber Assembly Replacement    PMT Cooler and Use the following procedure to replace the PMT cooler and reaction  Reaction Chamber chamber assembly  see Figure 7   7     Assembly   Replacement    Equipment Required   PMT cooler  Wrench  7 16
248. rature control board  follow previous steps in  reverse     7 38 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  Ambient Temperature Calibration    Ambient     Use the following procedure to calibrate the ambient internal temperature  Tem per ature for the instrument     Calibration Equipment Required     Calibrated thermometer or 10K  1  Resistor    WARNING The service procedures in this manual are restricted to qualified  service representatives  A    If the equipment is operated in a manner not specified by the  manufacturer  the protection provided by the equipment may be  impaired  A    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    1  Remove the instrument cover     2  Tape the thermistor  plugged into the measurement interface board  to  a calibrated thermometer  Figure 7 2      Note Since the thermistors are interchangeable to an accuracy of  0 2   C   and have a value of 10K ohms at 25   C  an alternate procedure is to  connect an accurately known 10K resistor to the thermistor input  AMB  TEMP  on the measurement interface board  and enter the temperature  reading  A    A 1   C change corresponds to a  5  change in resistance  thus this  alternative procedure can be quite accurate as a check  however  it clearly is  not NIST traceable  A    3  From the Main Menu  press  _     to scroll
249. rd accepts the current signal from the PMT and converts it  to a voltage  which is scaled by a factor of approximately 1  10  or 100  depending on the full scale range of the NO channel  The scaled voltage    signal is converted to a frequency and sent to the microprocessor     The input board includes a test signal that can be activated under software  control  The test signal is injected at the first stage of the input board in  parallel with the PMT input  This allows the input board and the  connection to the processor system to be tested and calibrated without  using the PMT     The digital output board connects to the motherboard and provides  solenoid driver outputs and relay contact outputs to a connector located on  the rear panel of the instrument  Ten relay contacts normally open  with  power off  are provided which are electrically isolated from each other   Eight solenoid driver outputs  open collector  are provided along with a  corresponding  24VDC supply pin on the connector     The I O expansion board connects to the motherboard and adds the  capability to input external analog voltage inputs and to output analog  currents via a connector located on the rear panel of the instrument  It  contains local power supplies  a DC DC isolator supply  a sub processor  and analog circuits  Eight analog voltage inputs are provided with an input    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Front Panel Connector    Board    1 0 Components    Analog Voltage    Thermo Fisher Scientific   
250. re information about the dual and auto range modes  see    Single  Range Mode        Dual Range Mode     and    Auto Range Mode    earlier in  this chapter     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 13    Operation  Range Menu    Table 3 5 lists the available operating ranges     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Range  gt  NO  NO2  or NOx Range     ip guid  POEL PEGG       Table 3 5  Available Operating Ranges                         ppb pgm     5 10  10 20  20 50  50 100  100 200  200 500  C1 C1   C2 C2  c3 c3    C1  C2  and C3 are custom ranges  For more information about custom  ranges  see    Set Custom Ranges    below     Set Custom Ranges The Custom Ranges Menu lists three custom ranges  C1  C2  and C3   Custom ranges are user defined ranges  In the ppb mode  any value  between 5 and 200 ppb can be specified as a range  In the ug m   mode  any  value between 10 and 500 ug m   can be specified as a range     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Range  gt  Set Custom Ranges     3 14 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Custom Ranges    Averaging Time    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Averaging Time       ERE p any Pl pes PP Tite  J METEEN Lid    Wi mpini  PS PHP L ri       The Custom Ranges screen is used to define the custom ranges     The display shows the current custom range  The next line of the display is  used to set the range  To use the custom full scale range  be sure to select it   Custom range 1  2  or 3  in the NO  NOz  or NO  Ranges
251. re stabile  from the Main Menu choose    Calibration  gt  Cal Lo NO Coefficient     4  The Lo NO field displays the current NO concentration   The Lo NO Span Conc field is where you enter the low NO calibration    gas concentration     Use  e   gt   to move the cursor left and right and use   t        to increment and decrement the numeric character at the cursor     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual 4 17    Calibration  Calibration in Dual Range and Auto Range Mode    Calibrate Low NO     5  Press to calculate and save the new low NO coefficient based on    the entered span concentration     Use the following procedure to calibrate the NO  channel to the NO     calibration gas     l     Press       to return to the Calibration menu and choose Cal Lo NOx  Coefficient     2  Verify that the low NO  calibration gas concentration is the same as the    low NO calibration gas concentration plus any known NO  impurity     The Lo NO  field displays the current NO  concentration  The Lo  NO  Span Conc field is where you enter the low NO  calibration gas  concentration     Use      gt   to move the cursor left and right and use   t       to increment and decrement the numeric character at the cursor     Press to calculate and save the new low NO  coefficient based on    the entered span concentration     4  Press   gt    to return to the Run screen     Calibrate Low NO  Use the following procedure to calibrate the NO  channel to the NO gt     calibratio
252. re supported     e C Link   e Modbus Slave   e Geysitech  Bayern Hessen   e Streaming Data    The Streaming Data protocol transmits user selected measurement data via  the serial port in real time for capture by a serial printer  data logger  or PC     RS 232 Connection A null modem  crossed  cable is required when connecting the analyzer to  an IBM Compatible PC  However  a straight cable  one to one  may be  required when connecting the analyzer to other remote devices  As a  general rule  when the connector of the host remote device is female  a  straight cable is required and when the connector is male  a null modem  cable is required     Data Format   1200  2400  4800  9600  19200  38400  57600  or 115200 BAUD  8 data bits  1 stop bit  no parity  All responses are terminated with a carriage return  hex 0D     Refer to Table 8   1 for the DB9 connector pin configuration     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 8 11    System Description  1 0 Components    RS 485 Connection    Ethernet Connection    External Accessory  Connector    8 12 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Table 8 1  RS 232 DB Connector Pin Configurations             DB9 Pin Function  2 RX   3 TX   7 RTS   8 CTS   5 Ground    The instrument uses a four wire RS 485 configuration with automatic flow  control  SD   Refer to Table 8 2 for the DB9 connector pin configuration     Table 8 2  RS 485 DB Connector Pin Configuration             DB9 Pin Function  2   receive  8   re
253. relay no 1 and 3 are set  to be normally open logic  all others are normally  closed     set relay open   set relay open value   set relay closed   set relay closed value   These commands set the relay logic to normally open or closed for relay  number value  where value is the relay between 1 and 16  The example  below sets the relay no 1 logic to normally open     Note If the command is sent without an appended relay number then all  the relays are assigned the set logic of normally open closed  A    Send  set relay open 1  Receive  set relay open 1 ok    The Erec  Lrec Srec layouts contain the following   e A format specifier for parsing ASCII responses  e A format specifier for parsing binary responses  In addition to these the Erec Layout contains     e A format specifier for producing the front panel displays    Values are read in using either the ASCII or binary format specifiers and  converted to uniform internal representations  32 bit floats or 32 bit  integers   These values are converted into text for display on the screen  using the format specifier for the front panel display  Normally  the  specifier used to parse a particular datum from the input stream will be  strongly related to the specifier used to display it  such as  all of the floating  point inputs will be displayed with an  f output specifier  and all of the  integer inputs will be displayed with a  d  specifier      Thermo Fisher Scientific    Format Specifier for  ASCII Responses    Format Specifie
254. rench being careful not to lose the ferrule or O ring     5  Remove the glass capillaries  ferrule  and O ring  Inspect O ring for  cuts or abrasion  and replace as necessary     6  Check capillary for particulate deposits  Clean or replace as necessary     7  Replace capillary in reaction chamber body  making sure the O ring is  around the capillary before inserting it into the body     8  Replace Cajon    fitting  Note that the Cajon    fitting should be  tightened slightly more than hand tight     9  Reconnect tubing to top of fittings  being careful to insert ferrule and  O ring properly  and tighten knurled nut finger tight     10  Re install the cover     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 5 3    Preventative Maintenance  Thermoelectric Cooler Fins Inspection and Cleaning    Thermoelectric Cooler  Fins Inspection and  Cleaning    A    Fan Filters Inspection  and Cleaning    5 4 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    11  Connect the power cord and turn the instrument ON     Use the following procedure to inspect and clean the thermoelectric cooler  fins     Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  For more  information about appropriate safety precautions  see the    Servicing       chapter  A   1  Turn the instrument off and unplug the power cord    2  Remove the instrument cover    3  Locate the PMT cooler  
255. rent selections in scratch pad into srec list B 24    copy sp to stream Sets copies current selections in scratch pad into stream list B 24       B 4 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Accessing Streaming Data                                                                            Command Description Page   copy srec to sp Sets copies current srec selection into the scratch pad B 24   copy stream to sp Sets copies current streaming data selection into the scratch B 24  pad   custom Reports sets defined custom range concentration B 32   data treatment Irec  Reports sets data treatment for concentrations values in long B 18  records   data treatment srec  Reports sets data treatment for concentrations values in B 18  short records   date Reports sets current date B 35   default params Sets parameters to default values B 36   dhcp Reports sets state of use of DHCP B 39   diag volt iob Reports diagnostic voltage level for I O expansion board B 17   diag volt mb Reports diagnostic voltage level for motherboard B 17   diag volt mib Reports diagnostic voltage level for measurement interface B 17  board   dig in Reports status of the digital inputs B 43   din Reports sets digital input channel and active state B 43   do  down  Simulates pressing down pushbutton B 29   dout Reports sets digital output channel and active state B 44   dtoa Reports outputs of the digital to analog converters per B 
256. ressure     The temperature control board regulates and sets the temperature of the  reaction chamber and converter     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 8 7    System Description  Electronics    PMT Power Supply  Assembly    Input Board  Assembly    Digital Output Board    1 0 Expansion Board   Optional     8 8 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    The reaction chamber temperature is measured with a thermistor  The  voltage across the thermistor is fed to the main processor for use in  calculating and displaying the reaction chamber temperature  The voltage  across the thermistor is also compared to a set point voltage and used to  control that the reaction chamber heaters to maintain a constant  temperature of 50   C  Protective circuitry prevents over heating in the  event of broken wires to the thermistor     The converter temperature is measured by a conditioned thermocouple  signal and fed back to the main processor to be used to display and control  the converter temperature  The temperature control board receives control  signals from the main processor software to control the converter heater to  the desired set point  Protective circuitry prevents over heating in the event  of broken wires to the thermocouple or processor faults     The PMT power supply produces high voltage to operate the photo  multiplier tube used in the measurement system  The output voltage is  adjustable from approximately 600 to 1200 volts under software control     The input boa
257. rity     Use  el  to move the cursor left and right and use  t       to increment and decrement the numeric character at the cursor     Fno X NO gt  limp     NO  lovr    INO Jorra    NO kem    2 JOUT ORIG REM Fno   Fo  Fp       Where      NO ovr   diluted NO  concentration at the output manifold  ppm   NO oric   original NO concentration  prior to addition of O3  ppm     NO rem   NO concentration remaining after addition of O3  ppm    Press to calculate and save the new NO  coefficient based on the    entered span concentration     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    12     13     14     Calibration  Calibration    The analyzer does a one point NO  span coefficient calculation   corrects the NO  reading for converter inefficiency  and then adds the    corrected NO  to the NO signal to give a corrected NO  signal     If the analyzer calculates a NO  span coefficient of less than 0 96  either  the entered NO  concentration is incorrect  the converter is not being  heated to the proper temperature  the instrument needs servicing  leak  or imbalance   or the converter needs replacement or servicing  The  NO  analog output will reflect the NO  concentration generated by  GPT  any NO  impurity  and the NO  zero offset     The recorder response will be as follows     Recorder Response    scale        NOs lour     x 100   URL ZNO     Where     URL   Nominal upper range limit of the NO  channel  ppm  Record the NO  concentration and the analyzer s NO3 response     
258. ro Autocal  Alarm   Span Autocal    Instrument out of calibration    Recalibrate instrument     Check gas supply  Perform  manual calibration        Alarm     NO  NO    NO   Conc     Concentration has exceeded  range limit    Concentration low    Check to insure range  corresponds with expected  value  If not select proper  range     Check user defined low set  point  set to zero        Alarm   Motherboard  Status    Alarm   Interface  Status    Alarm   I O Exp Status    Internal cables not connected  properly  Board is defective    Check that all internal cables  are connected properly   Recycle AC power to  instrument  If still alarming   change board     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 6 5    Troubleshooting  Board Level Connection Diagrams    Board Level  Connection  Diagrams    Figure 6 1 and Figure 6   2 are board level connection diagrams for the  common electronics and measurement system  These illustrations can be  used along with the connector pin descriptions in Table 6 3 through Table  6 6 to troubleshoot board level faults                       VOEXPANSICN  BOARD  EXPANSION VO        J1  TOIVEASLFEVENT SYSTEM  OGTAL QUIPUT  BOARD  DIGITAL 132  OUTPUTS 37 Pin  11 Pin  8 Pin  p  RS232 RS485        FRCNT 16 Pin LCD  9 Pin j   PE DISPLAY  m  RS232 RS485     5r AP BAD 4 Pin    5 J3 KEY PANEL  ei 8 Pin     EXPANSION RS485  15 Pin     SPARE DATA  8 Pin  ANALOG OUTPUTS   DIGITAL INPUTS 37 Pin  DATA   gt  IPI8  3 Pin a  in  2 Pin  POWER_GOOD  2 Pin  3 Pin  3 Pin 
259. rocedure that follows     Use the following procedure to calibrate the input channels to full scale by  applying a known voltage to the channels     Equipment Required   DC voltage source  greater than 0 volts and less than 10 volts   1  Connect the known DC voltage source to the input channel  1 8  to be    calibrated  Figure 7   16 shows the analog output pins and Table 7   5  identifies the associated channels     2  From the Main Menu  press       to scroll to Service  press  gt        to scroll to Analog Input Calibration  and press          The Analog Input Cal screen displays input channels 1 8     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Pressure Transducer  Assembly Replacement    A    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Servicing  Pressure Transducer Assembly Replacement      At the Analog Input Cal screen  press      to scroll to the channel    selected in Step 1  and press      Press     to scroll to Calibrate Full Scale  and press  e      The screen displays the current input voltage for the selected channel        Use         Jand         to enter the source voltage  and press  to calibrate the input voltage for the selected channel to the  source voltage        Press _       gt        to return to the input channels display and repeat  Steps 3 5 to calibrate other input channels to the source voltage as  necessary     Use the following procedure to replace the pressure transducer assembly     Figure 7 17    Equipment Required     Pressure transducer assembly    Philips screwdriver 
260. roduce NO and  NO  and are not recommended  A    A valve can be used to divert the NO flow when zero air is required at the  manifold     The reaction chamber used for the reaction of ozone with excess NO  should have sufficient volume so that the residence time meets the  requirements specified in this chapter     The mixing chamber is used to provide thorough mixing of the reaction  8 P 8 8  products and diluent air     The output manifold should be of sufficient diameter to insure an  insignificant pressure drop at the analyzer connection  The system must  have a vent designed to insure atmospheric pressure at the manifold and to  prevent ambient air from entering the manifold     The following information describes the NO concentration standard and  the method for calculating the NO concentration standard and the NO2    impurity     NO Concentration Standard A cylinder containing 10 to 50 ppm NO in Nz with less than 1 ppm NO     4 4 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    is usually used as the concentration standard  The cylinder must be  traceable to a National Institute of Standards and Technology  NIST  NO  in N  Standard Reference Material or NO  Standard Reference Material     Procedures for certifying the NO cylinder  working standard  against an  NIST traceable NO or NO  standard and for determining the amount of  NO  impurity are given in EPA Publication No  EPA 600 4 75 003      Technical Assistance Document for the Chemiluminescence Measurement  of Nitrogen
261. rounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    1  Refer to    Removing the Measurement Bench and Lowering the  Partition Panel    in this chapter to lower the partition panel  then  proceed to the next step below     2  Carefully disconnect the plumbing at the glass inlet and outlet of the  ozonator     3  Disconnect the stainless steel tubing from the flow transducer     4  Loosen the four captive screws securing the ozonator bracket to the  floor plate     Flow Transducer    Captive Screws  4        Ozonator     Top View    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 25    Servicing  Ozonator Transformer Replacement    Ozonator Bracket Screws  2           Ozonator          Ozonator Transformer  Screws  4      lt    _____      _      _ 07zonator Transformer      LA    EI  E   Ozonator     Side View  Figure 7   13  Replacing the Ozonator Assembly  5  Remove the two screws securing the ozonator to the ozonator bracket     6  Unplug the ozonator from the ozonator transformer by lifting the  ozonator straight up     7  To install the ozonator  follow the previous steps in reverse     8  Re install the measurement bench  Refer to    Removing the  Measurement Bench and Lowering the Partition Panel    in this chapter     Ozonator Transformer     Use the following procedure to replace the ozonator transformer  Figure 7       Replacement       Equipment Required     Ozonator transformer    Philips screwdriver    Equipm
262. rrection  Independent NO NO2 NO  ranges   Replaceable NO  converter cartridge  User selectable digital input output capabilities  Standard communications features include RS232 485 and Ethernet    C Link  MODBUS  Geysitech  Bayern Hessen   and streaming data  protocols    For details of the analyzer   s principle of operation and product  specifications  see the following topics        Principle of Operation    on page 1 2       Specifications    on page 1 3    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 1 1    Introduction  Principle of Operation    Principle of  Operation    1 2 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    Thermo Fisher Scientific is pleased to supply this NO NO2 NO  analyzer   We are committed to the manufacture of instruments exhibiting high  standards of quality  performance  and workmanship  Service personnel are  available for assistance with any questions or problems that may arise in the  use of this analyzer  For more information on servicing  see Chapter 7      Servicing        The Model 427 Trace Level operates on the principle that nitric oxide   NO  and ozone  O3  react to produce a characteristic luminescence with  an intensity linearly proportional to the NO concentration  Infrared light  emission results when electronically excited NO2 molecules decay to lower  energy states  Specifically     NO  03     gt  NO2 O2 hv    Nitrogen dioxide  NO2  must first be transformed into NO before it can  be measured using the chemiluminescent reaction  NO  is 
263. rument     This chapter provides the following troubleshooting and service support  information     e    Safety Precautions    on page 6 1   e    Troubleshooting Guides    on page 6 1   e    Board Level Connection Diagrams    on page 6 6  e    Connector Pin Descriptions    on page 6 8    e    Service Locations    on page 6 22    Read the safety precautions in the Preface and    Servicing    chapter before  performing any actions listed in this chapter     The troubleshooting guides presented in this chapter are designed to help  isolate and identify instrument problems     Table 6 1 provides general troubleshooting information and indicates the  checks that you should perform if you experience an instrument problem     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 6 1    Troubleshooting  Troubleshooting Guides    Table 6 2 lists all the alarm messages you may see on the graphics display    and provides recommendations about how to resolve the alarm condition   See    Alarms Menu    in the    Operation    chapter for detailed information     Table 6 1  Troubleshooting   General Guide    Malfunction    Does not start up    Possible Cause    No power    Power Supply    Digital electronics    Action    Check that the instrument is  plugged into the proper source   115 or 220 VAC  50 or 60H23      Check instrument fuses     Check voltages using a digital  voltmeter        Unplug power cord  Check that  all boards are seated properly     Unplug power cord  Remove  one board  Install kno
264. s the text  It is delimited by a      The  string up to the first     will be read and inserted in the text field of the line     This is followed by a possible string enclosed in quotes that is used to place  a string into the value field     The value source  which is the item  or word  number in the DATA ERec  response  appears next  This is followed by an optional bitfield designator   The datum identified by the value source can be printed as a string  s    hexadecimal  x   decimal  d   or floating point  f  or binary  b  number   Typically  bitfield extractions are only done for decimal or hexadecimal  numbers     Floating point numbers can be followed with an optional precision  specifier which will be used as an argument to printf s  f format  e g   a  field of  4  would be translated into the printf command of    3f    Alternately  the special character     can precede the precision specifier  this  causes an indirection on the precision specifier  which now becomes a field  number      This is useful when formatting  for example  numbers which have varying  precision depending on the mode of the instrument     Binary numbers can also have an optional precision specifier which is used  to determine how many bits to print  For example  the specifier  b4  will  print the lowest four bits of the parsed number     I here are serious restrictions on where an  s  field may appear  currentl  y y  sources 1 and 2 must be  s   and no others may be  s      Thermo Fisher Scient
265. se to the erec  lrec  srec  and related  commands  For details on how to interpret the strings  see    Record Layout  Definition    later in this appendix     Send  lrec layout  Receive  lrec layout  s  s 41x  f  f  f  f  f  f  f  f  f  f  f   f    t D L fFFFFFFFFFFF  flags no nox hino hinox pres pmtt intt rctt convt smplf  ozonf pmtv    lrec mem size   srec mem size   These commands report the long and short records that can be stored with  the current settings and the number of blocks reserved for long and short  records  To calculate the number of short records per block  add 2 to the  number of records  and then divide by the number of blocks  The example  below shows that 7 blocks were reserved for long records and the maximum  number of long records that can be stored in memory is 1426     Send  lrec mem size  Receive  lrec mem size 1426 recs  7 blocks    B 22 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Datalogging    lrec per  srec per  These commands report the long and short records logging period  The  example below shows that the short record logging period is 5 minutes     Send  srec per  Receive  srec per 5 min    set srec per value  set srec per value    value   1 5 15 30 60     These commands set the long and short records logging period to value in  minutes  The example below sets the long record logging period to 15  minutes     Send  set lrec per 15  Receive  set lrec per 15 ok  n
266. sndeel 7 25  Ozonator Transformer Replacement 2 2  tvecdaiet oh eaieacet ee dastaatestes 7 26  Input Board    Replacement ton easel ate e den Sane amy 7 27  Input Board  ali bration ove lel  Sas asses aaa ani 7 28  DC Power Supply Replacement i iscte chasceteanierteiigtertebiestactedeatee 7 29  Analog Q  tput esting ieiuniis aeia Aa 7 30    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Contents    Analog Output CaliPrariO ntsc caccssicnedesneccgancsivse ns sheueeasasdegedincctaestessass 7 32  Analog Input Calibration oii26  gcsecsistieest navecensieasecentedeed  ateecneieene 7 33  Calibrating the Input Channels to Zero Volts sses 7 33  Calibrating the Input Channels to Full Scale oe eee eeeseeeneeeeeeees 7 34  Pressure Transducer Assembly Replacement          scssesssessesereeeeeeneee 7 35  Pressure Transducer Cali bratia igs mac s Giver nce hea eed 7 36  Temperature Control Board Replacement  ici2445 295 5  G cate cah gs 7 38  Ambient Temperature Calibration i ceicciagudsecs este vdeicniGeadeles 7 39  Fuse Replacement usss iiai RENA 7 40  Scrubber Replacement       sesssssesesessssesesesesesrsrsrsrsrsrsesrertetrerreerererersee 7 40  I O Expansion Board  Optional  Replacement    ssesseseseeeeeesseeeeeeeesese 7 41  Digital Output Board Replacement        sssssssssessssesrseserererrrrrerrrsrsrseses 7 43  Motherboard Replacement i    age ick cael eae ata 7 43  Measurement Interface Board Replacement          seeeseeeseeeereeeeeeneesees 7 44  Flow Transducer Replacement
267. ssssassisiserssass 3 39  TCP IP Setting sinise ini aaen iei a S REES 3 40  Use DHCP rara aa a N A iat 3 40  IR Address m PO rT en nr a a E EEA E 3 41  Netas kannaa a a a a a an a a a iiS 3 41  Default Gateway ios annn on een a a ace 3 42  H  st Namens seieren eae a an aa a 3 42  V O Configutatio nnana eisrean ait cee 3 42  Output Relay Settings       sseseeeeeeseesessesesesesssssestsesesesesesesrersrerseees 3 43    vi Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Contents    TSO BUC States noginn enn cds g a ae 3 43  Instrum  nt State noiai eana aa 3 43  SPUN ET u a a EREE NEE E ETTE 3 44  NonnA latin    ohiratni iiaiai 3 45  Digital Tiput Settings sonnan A N ees 3 45  Logie Staten s Ea a cs ea AARTE ais 3 45  T  str  ment ACHON   cesia tisdoctestontsaatiienede aiesvecearGaGeaassteetiscuvess 3 46  Analog Output Conf surationiy  x 2icncecavanlaneuieineincntis 3 46  Select Output Range tsiscciesdiaeeieiiaseciecereinlaelnneatiacy  3 47  Minimum and Maximum    Value ccsiiccasacimnscedidedcdaainn 3 47  Choose Signal to Output iad oe ete htatad irate csenten nee 3 49  Analog Input Contienrationy 2 20 tien non gucies eA es 3 50  TD ESE EOE cis A sigs eave sue AA S a tetas 3 50  UDS a R tad ey ad ated gai A A eased 3 51  Decimal PACs eriecticctsiaiestet caste a cent ct RNs 3 51  Number of Table Points  cisiecitasitascessrasnceetavavenntetucosstesaccsdasstesetes 3 52  Fable POINTA enoe Ne a E a E er a 3 52  NAE EE E A A E 3 53  User Valie an a a N Salone a heh E
268. ssure sensor   s zero counts and span slope are displayed on the  menu     Note This adjustment should only be performed by an instrument service  technician  A    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Pressure Calibration        Pr irog ame m    ORE imei  Rri     ii       The Calibrate Pressure Zero screen calibrates the pressure sensor at zero  pressure     Note A vacuum pump must be connected to the pressure sensor before  performing the zero calibration  A    e In the Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Pressure Calibration  gt  Zero     Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 75    Operation  Service Menu       Calibrate Pressure Span The Calibrate Pressure Span screen allows the user to view and set the  pressure sensor calibration span point     Note The plumbing going to the pressure sensor should be disconnected so  the sensor is reading ambient pressure before performing the span  calibration  The operator should use an independent barometer to measure  the ambient pressure and enter the value on this screen before   calibrating  A    e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Pressure Calibration  gt  Span        Restore Default The Restore Default Calibration screen allows the user to reset the pressure  Calibration calibration configuration values to factory defaults     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Pressure Calibration  gt  Set  Defaults     3 76 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Service Menu       Flow Calibrat
269. status Reports sets PMT status on or off B 36  pmt temp Reports temperature of the PMT cooler  same as cooler B 11  temperature   pmt voltage Reports current PMT voltage B 12  pre Reports current prereactor concentration B 10  pre bkg Reports sets current prereactor background B 28  pres Reports current reaction chamber pressure B 12  pres cal Reports sets pressure used for calibration B 28  pres comp Reports sets pressure compensation on or off B 34  program no Reports analyzer program number B 41  push Simulates pressing a key on the front panel B 29  range mode Reports sets current range mode B 32  range no Reports sets current NO range B 31  range no2 Reports sets current NO  range B 31  range nox Reports sets current NO  range B 31  react temp Reports current reaction chamber temperature B 12  relay stat Reports sets relay logic status to for the designated relay s  B 45  ri  right  Simulates pressing right pushbutton B 29  ru  run  Simulates pressing run pushbutton B 29  sample Sets zero span valves to sample mode B 33  sample flow Reports current measured sample flow in LPM B 11  sample gas Sets zero span valves to sample gas mode B 33  save Stores parameters in FLASH B 37  save params Stores parameters in FLASH B 37       Thermo Fisher Scientific    Measurements    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands                                                    Measurements  Command Description Page  sc  screen  C series legacy command that reports a generic res
270. steaeeeeretlacasiancideeineesieaerieds 4 18  Calibrate High NOronini inicies eooo patanyareeedeesesatabendasie 4 19  Calibrate  High NOripednaneng innn pa n a iR 4 19  Calibrate High INOS is tatnsiatiss sare iaa a aa aN 4 20    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual ix    Contents    Chapter 5    Chapter 6    Chapter 7    x Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    ZRTOBN SPACE sw aczesivas usacceg anda tena iateaecnaensves iaeia ia 4 20  Preventative Maintemance              sssssesssssssssesssesssessssesssessnesssesssnessneeneesseees 5 1  Safety  Precautions  hss ance ste Seater ta Ea E ath High een ENE 5 1  Replacement  Partsitse df e ute costa ceils She ee e tiated 5 2  Cleaning the Outside Case icc souscohoatearentaesdolebiteect ents nenldiecbol lenis 5 2  Ozonator Air Feed Drying Column Replacement           eeseseeereeeees 5 2  Capillaries Inspection and Replacement j2icv ce gicc cc siecte heccaescenne 5 2  Thermoelectric Cooler Fins Inspection and Cleaning    5 4  Fan Filters Inspection and Cleaning 22 20 4063 nensci ieee 5 4  Pamp  Rebuilding hin cn carte dese racaasceaie Saco E aes ep ERNI 5 5  TU Pe SUN GN ING fossa sceasdeecivsncisnsnntncvadonitusbndaxpudeacexoachatacsacunsssinceasesndnndextbsbiecs 6 1  Sa fey  Preca Uto nS 5    nR R as Conc cay sa tetas hace aad ERRE 6 1  Troubleshooting Guides ccte essa an aaa ne Mahl ticaeida agar tunel 6 1  Board Level Connection Diagrams sicsicoasvossnshulsstivose Sah vstuesityryeunasyvcbians 6 6 
271. structions in each procedure  Avoid  contact with converter heated components  A    Allow converter to cool to room temperature before handling converter  components   amp     Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  Figure 7   1   If an  antistatic wrist strap is not available  be sure to touch a grounded metal  object before touching any internal components  When the instrument is  unplugged  the chassis is not at earth ground  A    Handle all printed circuit boards by the edges  A    Do not point the photomultiplier tube at a light source  This can  permanently damage the tube  A    Do not remove the LCD panel or frame from the LCD module  A  The polarizing plate is very fragile  handle it carefully  a    Do not wipe the polarizing plate with a dry cloth  it may easily scratch the  plate  A    Do not use alcohol  acetone  MEK or other Ketone based or aromatic  solvents to clean the LCD module  use a soft cloth moistened with a  naphtha cleaning solvent  A    Do not place the LCD module near organic solvents or corrosive gases   amp     Do not shake or jolt the LCD module  a    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 3    Servicing  Firmware Updates    Firmware  Updates    Accessing the  Service Mode    Replacement  Parts List    7 4 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual     A      4 T    Figure 7   1  Properly Ground
272. t  A    This adjustment should only be performed by an  instrument service technician  A    Handle all printed circuit boards by the edges only  A    Do not remove the panel or frame from the LCD module   A    The LCD module polarizing plate is very fragile  handle it  carefully  A    Do not wipe the LCD module polarizing plate with a dry  cloth  it may easily scratch the plate  A    Do not use Ketonics solvent or aromatic solvent to clean  the LCD module  use a soft cloth moistened with a  naphtha cleaning solvent  A    Do not place the LCD module near organic solvents or  corrosive gases  A    Do not shake or jolt the LCD module  A    Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual iii    About This Manual  FCC Compliance    FCC Compliance    A    WEEE Symbol    Where to Get Help    iv Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    WARNING Changes or modifications to this unit not expressly approved  by the party responsible for compliance could void the user   s authority to  operate the equipment  A    Note This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits  for a Class A digital device  pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules  These  limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful  interference when the equipment is operated in a commercial environment   This equipment generates  uses  and can radiate radio frequency energy  and  if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual   may cause harmful interf
273. t Controls  gt  IO Configuration  gt   Analog Output Config  gt  Select Channel  gt  Set Minimum or  Maximum Value        mw OEH iid  PULP          Table 3 6  Analog Output Zero to Full Scale Table                                                                            Output Zero   Value Full Scale 100  Value  NO Zero  0  Range Setting   NO  Zero  0  Range Setting   NO  Zero  0  Range Setting   LO NO Zero  0  Range Setting   LO NO  Zero  0  Range Setting   LO NO  Zero  0  Range Setting   HI NO Zero  0  Range Setting   HI NO  Zero  0  Range Setting   HI NO  Zero  0  Range Setting   Prereactor Zero  0  Range Setting   LO Prereactor Zero  0  Range Setting   HI Prereactor Zero  0  Range Setting   Range  NO   Recommend not to change the setting for this output   Internal Temp User set alarm min value User set alarm max value  Chamber Temp User set alarm min value User set alarm max value  Cooler Temp User set alarm min value User set alarm max value  NO  Converter Temp User set alarm min value User set alarm max value  Chamber Pressure User set alarm min value User set alarm max value  Flow User set alarm min value User set alarm max value  PMT Volts 700 volts 1100 volts   Ozonator Flow User set alarm min value User set alarm max value                         3 48 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu    Output Zero   Value Full Scale 100  Value       Everything Else 0 Units 10 Units    Choose Signal to Output 
274. t hold set point  of  3   C    Cooler reads  20   C    Replace defective fan   Clean or replace foam filter   Replace cooler     Replace cooler      thermoelectric module inside  cooler failed     Replace cooler     thermocouple  bad        Alarm   Conv  Temp    Alarm   Pressure    Converter temperature low    High pressure indication    Molybdenum converter should  be hot to the touch  if not the  heater may have failed  Check  that converter temp  set point  is approximately 325   C  Check  that voltage to the heater is  115 VAC        Check the pump for a tear in  the diaphragm  replace with  pump repair kit if necessary     Refer to    Preventive  Maintenance    chapter in this  manual  Check that capillaries  are properly installed and 0   rings are in good shape   Replace if necessary  Check  flow system for leaks        Alarm   Flow    Flow low    Check sample capillary  0 020  inch ID  for blockage  Replace  as necessary     If using sample particulate  filter make sure it is not       6 4 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Alarm Message    Alarm     Ozonator Flow    Possible Cause    Ozone flow low    Troubleshooting  Troubleshooting Guides    Action    blocked  Disconnect sample  particulate filter from the  sample bulkhead  if flow  increases  replace the filter        Check ozone capillary  0 008  inch ID  for blockage  Replace  as necessary        Alarm   Zero Check  Alarm   Span Check    Alarm   Ze
275. temperature alarm minimum and  maximum values to value  where value is a floating point number  representing cooler temperature alarm limits in degrees C  The example  below sets the cooler temperature alarm maximum value to  2 0   C     Send  set alarm cooler temp max  2 0  Receive  set alarm cooler temp max  2 0 ok    alarm internal temp min   alarm internal temp max   These commands report the internal temperature alarm minimum and  maximum value current settings  The example below reports that the  internal temperature alarm minimum value is 15 0   C     Send  internal temp alarm min  Receive  internal temp alarm min 15 0 deg C    set internal temp alarm min value   set internal temp alarm max value   These commands set the internal temperature alarm minimum and  maximum values to value  where value is a floating point number  representing internal temperature alarm limits in degrees C  The example  below sets the internal temperature alarm maximum value to 45 0   C     Send  set internal temp alarm max 45  Receive  set internal temp alarm max 45 ok    alarm pressure min   alarm pressure max   These commands report the pressure alarm minimum and maximum value  current settings  The example below reports that the pressure alarm  minimum value is 205 mmHg     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 15    C Link Protocol Commands  Alarms    B 16 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Send  pressure alarm min  Receive  pressure alarm min 205 mmHg    set alarm pressure
276. that the following relationships hold     Pr   NO  kc X tr 22 75 ppm   min    Eno   NO  p      NO kr               RC STD y Fo  Fro      tp      2  lt 2 min    Fo   Fno    Use the following procedure to determine the flow conditions to be used in  the GPT system     1  Determine Fr  the total flow required at the output manifold  which  should be equal to the analyzer demand plus 10 to 50 percent excess     2  Establish  NO our as the highest NO concentration that will be  required at the output manifold   NO our should be about equal to    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Calibration  Equipment Required    90  of the upper range limit  URL  of the NO  concentration range to  be covered     3  Determine Fno as     F z  NO  our X Fr  NOS   SCO   NO   STD    4  Select a convenient or available reaction chamber volume  Initially a  trial volume may be selected in the range of 200 to 500 cc     5  Compute Fo as            NO X Fun X V  FS     Isrp NO RC   Ex    2 75    6  Compute tr as     VRC    ES  Fo   Fno    7  Verify that tr  lt  2 minutes  If not  select a reaction chamber with a  smaller Vrce     8  Compute the diluent air flow rate as     Fp   Fr   Fo   Fro    9  If Fo turns out to be impractical for the desired system  select a reaction  chamber having a different Vrc and recompute Fp and Fo     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 4 7    Calibration  Pre Calibration    Pre Calibration    4 8 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Perform the
277. the Packing Material    Check for possible damage during shipment    Check that all connectors and circuit boards are firmly attached   Re install the cover    Remove any protective plastic material from the case exterior     Remove the external pump from its shipping container and place next  to the instrument     Use the following procedure to setup the instrument     l     Connect the sample line to the SAMPLE bulkhead on the rear panel   Figure 2 2   Ensure that the sample line is not contaminated by dirty   wet  or incompatible materials  All tubing should be constructed of  FEP Teflon     316 stainless steel  borosilicate glass  or similar tubing  with an OD of 1 4 inch and a minimum ID of 1 8 inch  The length of  the tubing should be less than 10 feet     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Installation  Setup Procedure       Wwe                                  Figure 2 2  Model 42i Trace Level Rear Panel    Note Gas must be delivered to the instrument free of particulates  It may  be necessary to use the Teflon particulate filter as described in    Ozone  Particulate Filter    on page 9 2  A    Note Gas must be delivered to the instrument at atmospheric pressure  It  may be necessary to use an atmospheric bypass plumbing arrangement as  shown in Figure 2   3 if gas pressure is greater than atmospheric pressure  A         Vent to Exhaust Line at    Instrument Bulkhead Atmospheric Pressure     lt        _ Input Gas Line    Figure 2 3  Atmospheric Dump Bypass Plumbing    Thermo
278. the selected analog input     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Analog Input Calibration  gt  Select  Channel  gt  Calibrate Full Scale   Hook up a voltage source of 10 V to  the analog input channel       OC gp  5 i i       The Ozonator Safety screen is used to turn the ozonator safety feature on  or off  If the ozonator safety is turned off  the ozonator will always be on   even if the converter is not up to temperature  The ozonator safety screen is  visible only when the instrument is in service mode  For more information  on the service mode  see    Service Mode    earlier in the chapter     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Ozonator Safety     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Service Menu       Dilution Ratio The Dilution Ratio screen allows the user to view and set the dilution ratio   Acceptable values are 1 500  1  The default is 1 1  When this value is set   the dilution ratio is applied to all concentration measurements  This screen  is only accessible if the dilution ratio option is installed     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Dilution Ratio        i rh iyd  A a E a EE       Display Pixel Test The Display Pixel Test is used to test the LCD display  The display pixel  test is visible only when the instrument is in service mode  For more  information on the service mode  see    Service Mode    earlier in the chapter     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Service  gt  Display Pixel Test                                a     et               Thermo Fishe
279. tific    Registers    MODBUS Protocol  Function Codes    Request   Field Name  Hex   Function 0x01   Starting Address Hi 0x00  Starting Address Lo 0x02  Quantity of Outputs Hi 0x00  Quantity of Outputs Lo 0x0D  Response   Field Name  Hex   Function 0x01   Byte Count 0x03  Output Status 2   10 OxCD  Output Status 11 15 Ox0A    The status of outputs 2   10 is shown as the byte value 0xCD  or binary  1100 1101  Output 10 is the MSB of this byte  and output 2 is the LSB   By convention  bits within a byte are shown with the MSB to the left  and  the LSB to the right  Thus  the outputs in the first byte are    10 through 2      from left to right  In the last data byte  the status of outputs 15 11 is shown  as the byte value 0x0A  or binary 0000 1010  Output 15 is in the fifth bit  position from the left  and output 11 is the LSB of this byte  The four  remaining high order bits are zero filled     Read holding   input registers reads the measurement data from the  instrument  Issuing either of these function codes will generate the same  response  These functions read the contents of one or more contiguous  registers     These registers are 16 bits each and are organized as shown below  All of  the values are reported as 32 bit IEEE standard 754 floating point format   This uses 2 sequential registers  least significant 16 bits first     The request specifies the starting register address and the number of  registers  Registers are addressed starting at zero  Therefore  registers
280. tion    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    Note An error in the zero setting of the pressure transducer does not  introduce a measurable error in the output concentration reading   Therefore  if only a barometer is available and not a vacuum pump  only  adjust the span setting  A    A rough check of the pressure accuracy can be made by obtaining the  current barometric pressure from the local weather station or airport and  comparing it to the pressure reading  However  since these pressures are  usually corrected to sea level  it may be necessary to correct the reading to  local pressure by subtracting 0 027 mm Hg per foot of altitude  A    Do not try to calibrate the pressure transducer unless the pressure is known  accurately  A    1  Remove the cover     2  Disconnect the tubing from the pressure transducer and connect a  vacuum pump known to produce a vacuum less than 1 mm Hg     3  From the Main Menu  press  _     to scroll to Service  gt  press  gt     to scroll to Pressure Calibration  gt  and press    The Pressure Sensor Cal menu appears     Note If Service Mode is not displayed  refer to    Accessing the Service  Mode    on page 7 4   then return to the beginning of this step  A    4  At the Pressure Sensor Cal menu  press to select Zero     The Calibrate Pressure Zero screen appears     5  Wait at least 
281. tr      0   rlecount            else if    rlescreen   i     Oxff          unsigned char rlecount     unsigned char    rlescreen     i      while  rlecount        ptr      Oxff    rlecount       To convert this data into a BMP for use with windows  it needs to be  turned into a 4BPP as that is the smallest windows can display  Also note  that BMP files are upside down relative to this data  i e  the top display line  is the last line in the BMP     Sc    screen  This command is meant for backward compatibility on the C series  Screen  information is reported using the    iscreen    command above     Thermo Fisher Scientific    Measurement  Configuration    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Measurement Configuration    Send  screen   Receive  screen  This is an I series  Instrument  Screen  Information not  available    range no  range no2   range nox   high range no   high range no2   high range nox   low range no   low range no2   low range nox   These commands report NO  NO2  and NO  range in single range mode   or the high and low ranges in dual or auto range mode  If the mode is  incorrect  the instrument responds with    can   t  wrong settings     The  example below reports that the NO full scale range is set to 50 ppb   according to Table B 6     Send  range no  Receive  range no 6  5000E 2 ppm    set range Selection   set high range Selection   set low range Selection   These commands select the NO  NO   and NO  full scale ranges   according to Tab
282. translated to an output string   Once the bits have been extracted   they are shifted down to the bit zero position  Thus  the possible values of  this example will be 0 through 3  The translation list shows the words  which correspond to each input value  the zeroth value appearing first  0   gt   local  1   gt  remote  etc    The selection list shows that only the first two  values  in this case  are to be shown to the user when the button is pressed   The  T  button indicates full translation  input code to string  and user  selection number to output string       xC     This is a line that starts a new column  the  xC or  L      Comp 6 11x off on Tset temp comp  s n     This shows that the bitfield end  the second part of a bitfield specification   is optional  The bitfield will be one bit long  starting in this case at the  eleventh bit      Background  7f 8Bd ddd set 03 bkg  s n     This shows the use of indirect precision specifiers for floating point  displays  The background value is taken from the 7th element  and the  precision specifier is taken from the 8th  If the asterisk were not present  it  would indicate instead that 8 digits after the decimal point should be  displayed     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 51    Serial Communication  Parameters    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Appendix C  MODBUS Protocol    This appendix provides a description of the MODBUS Protocol Interface  and is supported both over RS 232 485  RTU protocol  as well as TCP IP   
283. ts    B 10 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    These commands set the averaging time  high and low averaging times   according to Table B   2  The example below sets the low range averaging  time to 120 seconds     Send  set low avg time 9  Receive  set low avg time 9 ok    Table B 2  Averaging Times                                     Selection Time  NO Measure Mode  Time  NO NO  Measure  NO  Measure Mode Mode   0 1  seconds   1 ia   2 2    3 5    4 10 10 seconds   5 20 20   6 30 30   7 60 60   8 90 90   9 120 120   10 180 180   11 240 240   12 300 300     Manual mode only    no  no2   nox   pre   high no   high no2   high nox   high pre   low no   low no2   low nox   low pre   These commands report the measured NO  NO2  NO  and prereactor    concentrations when operating in single range  or high and low NO  NO      Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    C Link Protocol Commands  Measurements    NO   and prereactor when operating in dual or auto range mode  The  example below shows that the NO concentration is 67 2 ppb     Send  no  Receive  no 6720E 2 ppb  conv temp    This command reports the current NO converter temperature  The  example below reports that the current converter temperature is 320 7   C     Send  conv temp  Receive  conv temp 320 7 deg C    cooler temp  This command reports the current PMT cooler temperature  The example  below reports that the current PMT cooler temperature is  2 8   C     Send  pmt temp  Receive  pmt temp  2 8 de
284. ts in the response message are packed as one per bit of the data  field  Status is indicated as 1   Active  on  and 0     Inactive  off   The LSB  of the first data byte contains the output addressed in the query  The other  outputs follow toward the high end of this byte  and from low order to  high order in subsequent bytes  If the returned output quantity is not a  multiple of eight  the remaining bits in the final data byte will be padded  with zeros  toward the high order end of the byte   The Byte Count field  specifies the quantity of complete bytes of data     Note The values reported may not reflect the state of the actual relays in  the instrument  as the user may program these outputs for either active  closed or open  A    Request   Function code 1 Byte 0x01 or 0x02   Starting Address 2 Bytes 0x0000 to maximum allowed by instrument  Quantity of outputs 2 Bytes 1 to maximum allowed by instrument   Unit Identifier 1 Byte 0x00 to OxFF  Passed back in response   Response   Function code 1 Byte 0x01 or 0x02   Byte count 1 Byte N    Output Status n Byte N N or N 1     N   Quantity of Outputs   8  if the remainder not equal to zero  then N N 1    Error Response  Function code 1 Byte 0x01 or 0x02  Exception code 1 Byte 01 IIlegal Function  02 IIlegal Address     03 Illegal Data  04 Slave Device Failure    Here is an example of a request and response to read outputs 2 15     Thermo Fisher Scientific     0x03 0x04  Read Holding  Registers   Read Input    Thermo Fisher Scien
285. ts screen appears         Press      to set the output to zero   The Output Set To line displays Zero     5  Check that the meter is displaying the zero value  If the meter reading  differs by more than one percent  the analog outputs should be  adjusted  Refer to the    Analog Output Calibration    procedure that  follows     6  Press     to set the output to full scale   The Output Set To line displays Full Scale     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 7 31    Servicing  Analog Output Calibration    7  Check that the meter is displaying a full scale value  If the meter  reading differs by more than one percent  the analog outputs should be    adjusted  Refer to the    Analog Output Calibration    procedure that  follows     8  Press to reset the analog outputs to normal     Table 7   4  Analog Output Channels and Rear Panel Pin Connections                      Voltage Pin Current Pin   Channel Channel   1 14 1 15   2 33 2 17   3 15 3 19   4 34 4 21   5 17 5 23   6 36 6 25   Ground 16  18  19  35 37 Current Output Return 16  18  20  22  24    Table 7 5  Analog Input Channels and Rear Panel Pin Connections    Input Channel Pin  1 1                      2 2  3 3  4 5  5 6  6 7  7 9  8 10       Ground 4 8 11    Analog Outp Ut Use the following procedure to calibrate the analog outputs if a meter  Calibration reading in the    Analog Output Testing    procedure differed by more than    one percent or after replacing the optional I O expansion board   Equipment Required     
286. tstststsesesesesesesese 8 4  Measurement Calculations enean ia a ai Se 8 5  Output Communication   ss ssesessessesetesesrertsrestrrtsrertestssrrresesterrssrsreees 8 5  Electronics zst aa a a O E re 8 6  AV tie TO AT i noieta ore nsi eeen aaae a AES 8 6  External CONNECTOTS isare siseasi irora risian anir AKASAKA K EESE 8 6  Fitter ral Connect Ots ans esnie sank eiria ekinari areoso Sais 8 6  Measurement Interface Board     sssesssssesssesesssssesssessrersrerireererseseeeees 8 7  Measurement Interface Board Connectors       e sssesseseseeeeeeseeesereseses 8 7    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual xi    Contents    xii    Chapter 9    Appendix A    Appendix B    Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Flow Sensor HSsetaby Wrasse scat tcols late dichecdtancetitcs det cecaacgeturetseeccatatcahe 8 7  Pressure Sensor Assembly 5 scscsedsvezssntsguavsaaiidacedeesavsvedsaass nn cvuecussadoons 8 7  Temperature Control Boards ciel sud had tea adel edie Sed eendetete  8 7  PMT Power Supply Assembly scicvscsscicusccateaveccatieucisntiecteasbteeendecazetes 8 8  Input Board Assembly casas inic aon naa eie 8 8  Digital O  tput Boat arse aaraa nR E Ra et Ae 8 8  I O Expansion Board  Optional    sssessssseeeeeessssssssssssssrsssessrseseseseses 8 8  Front Panel Connector Board     s ssssssssssssesssesressrseteererereerersesesrersres 8 9  VO Components znie ai o a a a a a A E 8 9  Analog Voltage Outputs    ssssesssesssesesesesesesesesrsrsesrsrsrsrreseseseseseseses 8 9  Analog Current O
287. tube  PMT  provides the infrared sensitivity required  to detect the NO  luminescence resulting from the reaction of the ozone  with the ambient air sample     Optical energy from the reaction is converted to an electrical signal by the  PMT and sent to the input board that transmits it to the processor     The thermoelectric PMT cooler reduces the PMT temperature to  approximately  3   C to minimize dark current and increase instrument  sensitivity  The cooler helps to increase zero and span stability over a wide  ambient temperature range  The cooler housing also shields the PMT from  external electrical and optical interferences     The external vacuum pump draws the reacted gasses out of the reaction  chamber     The sample capillary along with the pump is used to control flow in the  sample line     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 8 3    System Description  Software    Dry Air Capillary    Software    Instrument Control    Monitoring Signals    8 4 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    The dry air capillary along with the pump is used to control flow in the dry  air line     The processor software tasks are organized into four areas   e Instrument Control   e Monitoring Signals   e Measurement Calculations    e Output Communication    Low level embedded processors are used to control the various functions on  the boards  such as analog and digital I O and heater control  These  processors are controlled over a serial interface with a single high level  pro
288. ue   set low no coef value   set low no2 coef value   set low nox coef value   These commands set the NO  NO   and NO  coefficients to user defined  values to value  where value is a floating point representation of the  coefficient  The example below sets the NO coefficient to 1 005     Send  set no coef 1 005  Receive  set no coef 1 005 ok    no gas   no2 gas   nox gas   high no gas   high no2 gas   high nox gas   low no gas   low no2 gas   low nox gas   These commands report NO  NO2  and NO  span gas concentrations used  to auto calibrate low NO  NO  and NO  coefficients  The high and low  commands are only available in dual and auto range mode  If the mode is  incorrect  the instrument responds with    can   t  wrong settings     The  example below reports that the NO low span gas concentration is 240 0    ppb     Send  low no gas  Receive  low no gas 2400E 1 ppb    set no gas value   set no2 gas value   set nox gas value   set high no gas value   set high no2 gas value   set high nox gas value   set low no gas value   set low no2 gas value   set low nox coef value   These commands set the NO  NO2  and NO  span gas concentrations used  by the auto calibration routine to value  where value is a floating point  representation of the gas concentration in current selected units  The gas  units are the same as those chosen by the user  The example below sets the  NO span gas concentration to 123 4 ppb     Send  set no gas 123 4  Receive  set no gas 123 4 ok    Model 42  Trace 
289. ult Content The Reset to Default Content screen is used to reset all of the datalogging  field items to default values  For more information about selecting the  analog output signal group choices  see    Select Content    above     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Datalogging Settings   gt  Reset to Default Content     Thermo Fisher Scientific Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 3 33    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu         EER prup Ph dm propru pH nid prnah prm pm pm dt  peop ogra gryp Tibi  PRECEDES fim Py AG Bo PERI PELLET PoeiPiisiitc Bly ict heP RILLJeEPET       Configure Datalogging The Configure Datalogging menu deals with datalogging configuration for    the currently selected record type     e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Datalogging Settings   gt  Configure Datalogging            o ECH OE Bet  2 a EO a T A TE          Logging Period Min The Logging Period Min screen is used to select the logging period in    minutes for the record format  srec or lrec   List of choices include  off  1   5  15  30  and 60 minutes  default      e Inthe Main Menu  choose Instrument Controls  gt  Datalogging Settings   gt  Configure Datalogging  gt  Logging Period Min        PAPE BED Ph my Poppy pH prepri  Pp THG  Pi io LA PEREGE Phe fni i       3 34 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual Thermo Fisher Scientific    Operation  Instrument Controls Menu    Memory Allocation The Memory Allocation Percent screen is used to select the perce
290. um value B 15  min  alarm internal temp  Reports sets internal temperature alarm maximum value B 15  max  alarm internal temp Reports sets internal temperature alarm minimum value B 15  min  alarm pressure max Reports sets pressure alarm maximum value B 15  alarm pressure min Reports sets pressure alarm minimum value B 15  alarm sample flow Reports sets sample flow alarm maximum value B 16  max  alarm sample flow Reports sets sample flow alarm minimum value B 16  min  alarm trig conc no Reports sets current NO concentration alarm warning value B 16  alarm trig conc no2 Reports sets current NO  concentration alarm warning value B 16  alarm trig conc nox Reports sets current NO  concentration alarm warning value B 16  alarm trig conc pre Reports sets current prereactor concentration alarm warning B 16  value  Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual B 3    C Link Protocol Commands  Accessing Streaming Data                                                                                        Command Description Page  analog iout range Reports analog current output range per channel B 42  analog vin Retrieves analog voltage input data per channel B 42  analog vout range Reports analog voltage output range per channel B 42  avg time Reports sets averaging time B 9  baud Reports sets current baud rate B 39  bkg no Reports sets current NO background B 28  bkg nox Reports sets current NO  background B 28  bkg pre Reports sets current prereactor background B 28  cal high no coef Sets
291. urements reported in dual or auto range modes include     e lowNO    e low NO   e low NO   e low PRE  e high NO  e high NO   e high NO   e high PRE    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Geysitech  Bayern Hessen  Protocol  Geysitech Commands    Operating and Error See Table D 1 for operating status and Table D 2 for error status for the  Status Model 427 Trace Level     Table D 1  Operating Status for Model 427 Trace Level       D7   D6 D5   D4 D3   D2   D1   DO                                   gt  Bit 8  7 6  5 4  3 2  1   gt  Hex value 80   40 20  10 08  04   02   01  MSB LSB   Operating status    Service Mode  On  0   0 0   0 0  0 0   1  Maintenance  Local  0   0 0   0 0  0 1 0  Zero gas  On  0 10 0 10 0 1 0 10  Span gas  On  0 10 0 10 1 0 0 10  Gas Unit Indication  ppm OR ppb  10   0 0   1 0  0 0   0  Ozonator  Off  0  0 1 10 0  0 0  0  PMT  Off  0 J1 0  0 0  0 0 7 0  Not used 1 10 0 7 0 0  0 0 7 0                                     Table D 2  Error Status for Model 427 Trace Level    D7   D6 D5   D4 D3   D2   D1   DO   gt  Bit 8  7 6  5 aes 2  1                                                     gt  Hex value 80   40 20   10 08   04   02   01  MSB LSB   Error status    Not Used 0   0 0   0 0   0 0   1  Not Used 0   0 0   0 0   0 1  0  Not Used 0  0 0  0 0 J1 0 10  Any Temperature Alarm 0 10 0 10 1 0 0 0  Pressure Alarm 0 10 0 l1 0 10 0  0  Sample Flow Alarm 0 0 1  0 0 10 0 0  Ozonator Flow Alarm 0 l1 0  0 0 J0 0 10  Not used 1 10 0  0 0 J0 0 10                                
292. utputs  Optional    s ssssssessssessssseererersrsesresesrereees 8 10  Analog Voltage Inputs  Optional     ssessssesssesssesssssesesrsesrrrrerrreresesesss 8 10  Digital Relay Outputs snoa on E e A R 8 10  Digital Inp  ts  sesona i aE R a 8 10  Serial POTS 88 rinne EA E E A E E 8 11  RS 232 Connections si txesicsiassiiadesvesttiascapaatecsdoaceosnteeseeanauescatiides 8 11  RS 485 Connection sieis nri EEES EEE AR EREE 8 12  Ethernet Cone Chon  scstie  Sede cacdaccetucs hese detaad et areri ca cance Eiaeia 8 12  External Accessory Connector atiaen  ieee ieeen ds oe tens bectnedessnete 8 12  Optional Eqquippmie ntti  cc icccssncesecs eck ccscdcccst stcarcneckecndtesbdarcscedecuercabiarceechecuceadeardaes 9 1  Internal Zero Span and Sample Valwesis 5230  002621 Bech laine 9 1  Ozonator Permeation Diver   iiaii ee Tea ce eee eee 9 1  Ammonia Scrubber sssini inisesin sedasa 9 2  Teflon  Particulate Filterite ka e RE 9 2  Ozone Particulate  Pilter cinien R 9 2  NOzto  NO GC  nverter na eei a a i 9 2  I O Expansion Board Assembly       seeeeeeseeeeeeesesessesesrseseserrrrrrrerereess 9 2  Terminal Block and Cable Kits     s s sssessssessesessseesssessesesesesseseseseesesessese 9 2  Capless nt Gta aaran aas aran a a aa anotada lad teladgauatlag 9 3  Mounting Options  inea aaa a A E AA ak 9 4  Warianty  aata a araar ian amen heads A 1  C Link Protocol Commands                  nnnrrrrrrrrrresessnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnerrrrrrrrnene B 1  Instrument Identification Number    ssseeeeeee
293. ve     b  Thoroughly flushing the regulator and delivery system with NO  after opening the cylinder valve     c  Not removing the regulator from the cylinder between calibrations  unless absolutely necessary     4  Connect the analyzer sample bulkhead input to the output of the GPT  system     Use the following procedure to adjust the instrument gain  This includes   e Setting the Prereactor  NO and NO  backgrounds to zero   e Calibrating the NO channel to the NO calibration gas   e Calibrating the NO  channel to the NO  calibration gas    Set Backgrounds to Zero The Prereactor  NO and NO  background corrections are determined    4 10 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    during zero calibration  The background signal is the combination of  electrical offsets  PMT dark current  and trace substances undergoing  chemiluminescence  For more detailed information  see    NO  NOx  and  Prereactor Backgrounds    in the    Operation    chapter     Use the following procedure to set the prereactor background  Both the  NO and NO  background screens operate the same way  and the following  procedure also applies to the NO and NO  background screen     Note The NO channel should be calibrated first and then calibrate the  NO  channel  a    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Calibration  Calibration    For detailed information about the menu parameters and the icons used in  these procedures  see the    Operation    chapter     1  Determine the GPT flow conditions required to meet the dyn
294. ve the  cooler assembly with the reaction chamber     Note If only the cooler is being replaced  remove the PMT and reaction  chamber from the old cooler and install them on the new cooler  A    8  Install new cooler by following previous steps in reverse   Fasten knurled fittings on reaction chamber finger tight  A    Make sure that the heat shrink covered tubing between the reaction  chamber and the converter is light tight at the connections  A    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Photomultiplier Tube  Replacement    Thermo Fisher Scientific    A    Servicing  Photomultiplier Tube Replacement    9  Re install the measurement bench  Refer to    Removing the  Measurement Bench and Lowering the Partition Panel    in this chapter     Use the following procedure to replace the PMT tube   Equipment Required    Photomultiplier tube and PMT base   Nut driver  5 16 inch   Flat blade screwdriver    Philips screwdriver  small    Equipment Damage Some internal components can be damaged by small  amounts of static electricity  A properly grounded antistatic wrist strap  must be worn while handling any internal component  A    1  Turn instrument OFF  unplug the power cord  and remove the cover     2  Disconnect the high voltage cable from the PMT power supply and  unplug the BNC cable from the Input Board     3  Remove six external screws holding PMT cover plate and the four  screws holding the PMT shroud to the panel and remove the PMT  cover plate  Figure 7   8   If the cooler fan is attach
295. wn good  board  Repeat until faulty board  is detected        No output signal  or  very low output     No sample gas reaching the  analyzer    Ruptured pump diaphragm    Blocked sample capillary    No ozone reaching the reaction  chamber    Check input sample flow     Rebuild pump head    Unplug power cord  Clean or  replace capillary     Check the Instrument Control  menu to see if the ozonator is  ON  If it is ON  check dry air  supply        No output signal    Disconnected or defective input  or high voltage supply    Analyzer not calibrated    Defective  15 volt    Unplug power cord  Check that  cables are connected properly   Check cable resistance     Recalibrate     Check supply voltages   Diagnostics menu         Calibration Drift    Dryer to ozonator depleted    Line voltage fluctuations    Defective pump  Unstable NO or NO  source    Clogged capillaries    Clogged sample air filter    Replace     Check to see if line voltage is  within specifications     Rebuild pump   Replace     Unplug power cord  Clean or  replace capillary     Replace filter element        6 2 Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Thermo Fisher Scientific    Malfunction    Possible Cause    Troubleshooting  Troubleshooting Guides    Action       Excessive Noise    Defective or low sensitivity  PMT    Defective input board    Defective cooler    Unplug power cord  Remove  PMT  Install known good PMT   Plug in power cord  Check  performance     Replace board    
296. wn to have excellent stability and accuracy  NIST  traceable mass flow controllers with dull scale ranges from 20 sccm to  20 000 sccm are also readily available  It is therefore relatively straight  forward to generate span gas concentration from below 1 ppb to 10 ppb  assuming a suitable zero gas source is used  For example     NO Flow     NO  GENERATED      NO  SEAN Total Flow    Assuming a calibration cylinder of 1 ppm  NO flow of 10 sccm  and a total  flow of 10 000 sccm  allows generation of span concentration of 1 ppb   Using the specifications of the mass flow controllers and calibration  cylinder  this concentration should be accurate to within  5   Multi point  concentrations from 0 5 ppb to 10 ppb may be similarly generated   establishing the linearity of the particular analyzer being calibrated     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual E 1    Standards for Trace Level Analyzers  Geysitech Commands    E 2 Model 42i Trace Level Instruction Manual    Thermo Fisher Scientific believes it is not necessary to generate  concentrations below these levels since the fundamental linearity of the  instrumentation has been demonstrated     If however  the zero air used for dilution and for establishing baseline  conditions has impurity levels greater than several tenths of a ppb  the  accuracy of the analyzer being calibrated may be severely jeopardized  A 0 5  ppb impurity level is equivalent to a 10  relative error for a 5 ppb  concentration     Ultra zero ambient monitor
297. zero  readings  Unless the zero has changed by more than  0 010 ppm  it is  recommended that the zero not be adjusted  If an adjustment larger  than this is indicated due to a change in zero reading  a new multipoint  calibration curve should be generated     3  Attach a supply of known concentration of NO and NO   usually  generated via an NIST traceable NO working standard and a GPT  system  to the SAMPLE bulkhead  or SPAN bulkhead for instruments  equipped with the zero span and sample solenoid valve option  on the  rear panel     4  Allow the instrument to sample the calibration gas until a stable  reading is obtained on the NO  NO  and NO  channels  If the  calibration has changed by more than  10   a new multipoint  calibration curve should be generated     5  When the calibration check has been completed  record the NO  NO     and NO  values     6  Reconnect the analyzer sample line to the SAMPLE bulkhead     Model 42  Trace Level Instruction Manual 4 21    Safety Precautions    Thermo Fisher Scientific    A  A    Chapter 5  Preventative Maintenance    This chapter describes the periodic maintenance procedures that should be  performed on the instrument to ensure proper operation  Since usage and  environmental conditions vary greatly  you should inspect the components  frequently until an appropriate maintenance schedule is determined     This chapter includes the following maintenance information and  replacement procedures     e    Safety Precautions    on page 5 1 
    
Download Pdf Manuals
 
 
    
Related Search
    
Related Contents
Samsung Home cinéma blu-ray, HT-D7200WXZF, série 7, SMART TV, 3D Manuel de l'utilisateur  Bryant 312AAV Furnace User Manual    Copyright © All rights reserved. 
   Failed to retrieve file